Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
Sinclair Knight Merz 13th Floor, Cale Cross House 156 Pilgrim Street Newcastle upon Tyne NE1 6SU United Kingdom Tel: +44 191 211 2400 Fax: +44 191 211 2401 Web: www.globalskm.com
COPYRIGHT: The concepts and information contained in this document are the property of Sinclair Knight Merz (Europe) Limited. Use or copying of this document in whole or in part without the written permission of Sinclair Knight Merz constitutes an infringement of copyright. LIMITATION: This report has been prepared on behalf of and for the exclusive use of Sinclair Knight Merz (Europe) Limiteds Client, and is subject to and issued in connection with the provisions of the agreement between Sinclair Knight Merz and its Client. Sinclair Knight Merz accepts no liability or responsibility whatsoever for or in respect of any use of or reliance upon this report by any third party.
The SKM logo trade mark is a registered trade mark of Sinclair Knight Merz Pty Ltd.
Contents
1. Project Description
1.1. 1.2. General Role of Technical Specification
1
1 1
2.
Scope of Work
2.1. 2.2. 2.3. 2.4. 2.5. 2.6. Summary of scope Terminal points Provision of services during construction Related Projects and excluded Work Regulatory approvals Codes and standards
2
2 6 10 11 11 11
3.
13
13 15 16 16 19 19 20 20 24 26 26 27 27
4.
General Specification
4.1. 4.2. 4.3. 4.4. 4.5. 4.6. 4.7. 4.8. 4.9. 4.10. General requirements Hardware and software Access and maintenance Lubrication Corrosion protection Insulation Chemicals Buildings Signage Degree of automation
28
28 29 29 29 30 30 31 31 31 32
PAGE ii
4.11. 4.12. 4.13. 4.14. 4.15. 4.16. 4.17. 4.18. 4.19. 4.20. 4.21. 4.22. 4.23. 4.24. 4.25.
Lay-down areas Design and standardisation Prohibited materials Classification of hazardous areas Hazardous substances and dangerous goods Drawings and documentation Labelling Operations and maintenance manuals Inventory control management system Construction program and progress Places of manufacture and sub-orders Quality assurance and quality control Inspection and test plan Training Special tools
32 32 33 33 34 34 35 35 38 38 39 39 40 42 44
5.
45
45 45 46 46 47 48 49 49
6.
Mechanical Specification
6.1. 6.2. 6.3. 6.4. 6.5. 6.6. 6.7. 6.8. 6.9. 6.10. 6.11. 6.12. 6.13. Dual fuel engines Cooling systems Air starting system Control/instrument air system Inlet and exhaust system Fuel systems Water system Black start and emergency diesel equipment Mechanical building services Maintenance facilities and equipment Spare Parts Fire protection and detection facilities) General mechanical requirements
50
50 54 56 57 58 59 68 71 73 74 75 75 76
PAGE iii
7.
Electrical Specification
7.1. 7.2. 7.3. 7.4. 7.5. 7.6. 7.7. 7.8. 7.9. 7.10. 7.11. 7.12. 7.13. 7.14. 7.15. 7.16. 7.17. 7.18. 7.19. 7.20. 7.21. 7.22. 7.23. 7.24. 7.25. General Cable sizing calculations Auxiliary supplies Load flow and fault studies Transient and dynamic stability studies Earthing studies Protection coordination studies Insulation coordination studies Lightning protection studies Generator and excitation system Generator main connections Transformers Metalclad Switchgear Medium voltage (MV) switchgear Generator voltage switchgear Low voltage switchgear Battery systems Black Start / Emergency Generator Uninterruptible power supply (UPS) systems Protective system Motors Earthing Alarm equipment Cabling Lighting and small power installation
80
80 81 81 82 82 82 82 82 83 83 85 85 87 88 88 89 89 90 90 91 93 94 95 95 99
8.
101
101 101 101 102 103 104 111 112 114 115 116
PAGE iv
8.12. Plant instrumentation and wiring system database 8.13. Communication and security systems
116 116
9.
Civil Requirements
9.1. 9.2. 9.3. 9.4. 9.5. 9.6. General requirements for civil works Scope of civil works Design of the works Specific building and architectural requirements Materials and workmanship Auxiliary transformer compounds
120
120 125 128 137 141 146
148
148 148 149 150 150 151 152 165 165
167
Appendix B Data Sheets Guaranteed Data, Performance Data, Design Data and Inputs into the Bid Evaluation Tool 170 Appendix C Drawings and Documentation Appendix D Specification for Metering System Appendix E Plant System Categories for Spare Parts 248 260 289
PAGE v
D E F
1st Feb 2013 20th Feb 2013 15th March 2013 31st March 2013 13 April 2013 26 April 2013 05 December 2013 12 December 2013 22 December 2013
William Booker/ OOC William Booker/ OOC William Booker/ OOC William Booker/OOC William Booker/OOC William Booker/OOC
OOC
H I J K L
Distribution of copies
Revision 1 A B C D E F G H I J L Copy no Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Electronic Quantity 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Issued to Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil + LGI Oman Oil +LGI+OPWP Oman Oil +LGI+OPWP Oman Oil +LGI+OPWP Oman Oil +LGI+OPWP Oman Oil +LGI Oman Oil +LGI+OPWP
Author: Project Manager: Name of organisation: Name of project: Name of document: Document version:
G Taylor / B Rose / B Littlewood / K Zachariah / I Gillan / D Hackwell A Green Oman Oil Company and LGI Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Rev L
PAGE vi
PAGE vii
Nomenclature
Abbreviations and symbols
AC ACI AG AGC AISC ALARP ANSI API AQG ASTM AVR BS CAD CCR CCTV CD ROM CEMP CFC C&I COD CO2 CPF CTs CV DA dB(A) DC DCS DF DIN e.g. EAF EIA EN ENMP EPC FMS FOF FOH GCF GCPC GCPFC GCPUC GCPUFC GIP GIS GPRS H2 HAZOP HHV HMI HSEC HV Alternating current American Concrete Institute Available generation Automatic generation control American Institute of Steel Construction As low as reasonably practical American Standards Institute American Petroleum Institute Air Quality Guidelines American Society for Testing and Materials Automatic voltage regulator British Standard Computer aided drafting Central control room Closed circuit television Compact disc read only memory Construction environmental management plan Chlorofluorocarbon Control and instrumentation Commercial operation date Carbon dioxide Central processing facility Current transformers Calorific value Degraded airshed decibels (absolute) Direct current Distributed control system Dual fuel Deutsches Institut fur Normung for example Equivalent availability factor Environmental impact assessment EuroNorm Environmental noise management plan Engineer procure and construct Fuel Metering Skid Forced outage factor Forced outage hours Gas connection facilities Guaranteed Contract Power Capacity running on Natural Gas Guaranteed Contract Power Capacity running on Fuel Oil Guaranteed Gross Contract Power Capacity of each Power Unit running on Natural Gas Guaranteed Gross Contract Power Capacity of each Power Unit running on Fuel Oil Good industrial practice Gas insulated substation Gas pressure regulating station Hydrogen Hazard and operability Higher heating value Human machine interface Health safety environmental and community High voltage (132kV)
PAGE viii
Units
C dB(A) GWh kg kJ/kWh kN kPa kt kV kW, kWe Lux m mm 2 m mg ms mg/L MMBTU 3 MJ/Nm MV MVA MVAr MW, MWe MWth pH RH rpm Scf/SCF $, USD t %, % vol Degree Celsius Decibel (A weighted scale) Euro Gigawatt hours kilogram kilojoules per kilowatt hour kilonewton kilopascal kilotonnes kilovolts Power, Power electrical Illuminance metre millimetres metre squared milligram millisecond milligram per litre Million British thermal units Megajoule per normal cubic metre Megavolt Megavolt ampere Megavolt ampere reactive Power, Power electrical Heat flow acidity / basicity Relative humidity revolutions per minute Standard cubic foot United States dollar tonnes percentage, percentage volume
PAGE x
1.
1.1.
Project Description
General
It is the intention of Musandam Power Company S.A.O.C. (hereinafter referred to as The Owner); to install a Natural Gas fuelled, dual fuel reciprocating engine based Plant with a minimum net firm capacity of 100 MW and with Fuel Oil as the alternative fuel. The plant shall supply electricity to the Musandam Electricity Grid owned by the Rural Areas Electricity Company (RAECo). The Site is located approximately 40 km to the south-west of Khasab and approximately 500 metres north of the Ad Darah border between the Sultanate of Oman and the United Arab Emirates in Wilayat Bukha. The closest settlements within a 2 km radius to the Site are Ad Darah, Tibat and Sall Dawrah. The Plant will be deemed phase 1 of a possible two phase development. An area has been identified for the plant layout and provision has been made for future construction of phase 2. The contract shall be carried out in accordance with the requirements of this OTS (hereinafter referred to as "Specification"), which provides for the design, manufacture, factory testing, supply, delivery, off loading at site, erection, painting, site testing, setting to work and attention to defects, compliance with local and national consents, regulations, standards and legislation on a turnkey lump sum contract basis, including all related civil works, and such other works as the Owner may require, for a 100 MW minimum net firm capacity Plant at the Musandam site (hereinafter and in the Conditions of Contract referred to as the Site). The plant shall be optimised to offer a competitive least cost solution and the EPC Contractor shall offer a unit size that takes due regard of all specified functional and operational requirements. The EPC Contractor shall support the Owner in the provision of such supporting information as may be required to demonstrate that the life cycle costs of the plant have been optimised.
1.2.
The role of this Specification is to define the minimum functional requirements of the Works and to provide site-specific data to the EPC Contractor. The Specification also serves to define the environmental and regulatory constraints within which the plant must operate and with which the Works shall comply. It is the intention of this Specification to provide the EPC Contractor the maximum freedom to provide the most competitive offer based on the EPC Contractors standard plant and equipment though with the design optimised for the particular scope of the project and taking the Owners requirements into account. The Works shall be new, modern, proven, and safe and shall be designed for the highest availability factor, start reliability, efficiency and flexibility of starting within an offer that is commercially attractive.
PAGE 1
2.
2.1.
Scope of Work
Summary of scope
The scope of work includes the design, manufacture, supply, factory testing, transporting, installation, commissioning, acceptance testing, and repair during the defects liability period and all work incidental thereto whether specified in detail or not, necessary for the safe and efficient operation of the plant. Generally, the main supply shall include, but not be limited to, the following: 1. Dual fuel reciprocating engines providing a total plant with a minimum net firm capacity of 100 MW at all site ambient conditions on an [N+1] basis where N is the number of engines required to provide the 100 MW net firm capacity. The minimum net firm capacity of 100 MW must be achieved across the gas composition range provided under Appendix A of this OTS. The definition of the number of additional units required may be dependent upon the plant configuration, if engines of different capacities are offered. 2. Synchronous, 3phase, 50 Hz generators driven by the dual fuel engines and complete with all auxiliaries. 3. Induced draft radiator cooling water system for main and auxiliary plant cooling. 4. All necessary auxiliary systems including, but not limited to, the following:
Gas Connection Facilities, Gas Metering Facilities and Metering Systems; Gas conditioning equipment; Fuel Oil unloading facilities, storage tanks, forwarding pumps and metering systems Heating, ventilation and air conditioning equipment and systems; Gas detection systems; Fire detection and protection systems; Compressed air system; Cathodic protection; Painting; Tools and tackle for maintenance including special tools; Workshop and store; Water supply systems; Water treatment plant; Water sampling and dosing systems; and Connections to off-site services.
5. Step up transformers from the generator voltage to the transmission system voltage; the EPC Contractor shall offer a solution which meets the requirements of the RAECo security standards and takes into account the requirement to maintain load in the event of the sudden loss of one generating unit. The transformers and associated connections shall be selected to support two operating conditions as follows: a) b) The maximum net output of the generating plant when operating at the Reference Conditions; and The maximum net output of the generation plant when operating at ISO reference conditions.
PAGE 2
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification 6. Auxiliary transformers to allow the plant to supply its own auxiliaries. 7. Two auxiliary supply transformers, Aux V / 11kV, rated at 1MVA for connection to Tibat Grid 11kV board. 8. HV cabling in concrete trenches from HV terminals of step-up transformer to the Tibat grid substation GIS terminations 9. MV cabling in concrete trenches 10. All necessary auxiliary electrical systems including, but not limited to, the following:
Switchgear; LV and DC auxiliary supplies systems; Batteries, chargers and uninterruptible power supplies (UPS); Emergency/black start diesel generator system; Auxiliary transformers connected to the medium voltage switchboard, and sized to match the requirements of the Plant LV AC supplies; Earthing and lightning protection system; Surge arrestors; Plant auxiliaries supply, including auxiliary transformers, HV/LV transformers, MV switchgear, LV switchgear, MV/LV busducts and cables, DC and UPS systems, lighting, earthing and lightning protection systems; and Protective systems covering all equipment included under this specification
11. An integrated distributed control system including all necessary control and protection instrumentation, site telecommunications and connections to off-site services including, but not limited to the following:
interfacing facilities for interchanging data, including Operating Parameters required as inputs to the Plant model between the Plant and the RDC; I&C, including Plant control and monitoring system, telecommunication, protection systems, environmental monitoring equipment and system , field testing equipment, instrument workshop equipment, metering etc.; control, indication, protection and telephone cables from the Plant to the new Tibat grid substation and associated marshalling cubicles; and security systems including perimeter fence monitoring, CCTV system, access control to site and buildings, building intruder detection, gate intercom.
12. All civil and structural works associated with the above equipment including Site development which includes removal of material from the mountain on the site, filling and compacting the Site to foundation level and then layering and compacting the site to 15 metres above mean sea level, with suitable fill material. . Slope protection between the original ground level to +15m MSL is included by using either rip rap, shotcrete, reinforced concrete retaining walls or a combination of the methods; Approximately 1.5 million cubic metres (the Bidder to confirm volume) of excess material from the Site levelling work shall be used for coastal reclamation. The Base Case shall be the reclamation of land in the area demarcated by the Royal Oman Police and extended area towards sea side, on the western side of the Khasab highway, southern side of the existing jetty,
1
References to Bidder to be amended to Contractor prior to execution of final form EPC Contract
PAGE 3
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification opposite the Plant site. The Option Case shall be area demarcated on the western side of the Khasab highway and the northern side of the existing jetty, . The Bidder shall also be responsible for the relocation of any coral inhabiting the seabed affected by the land reclamation. The size of the coral beds are approximately 0.3 ha in area for the Base Case and 30 ha for the Option Case. The Bidder shall be responsible for the monitoring of the coral during the construction period and shall undertake mathematical modeling to predict any erosion of the coastal strip and topography caused by the land reclamation. The relocation recipient site could be up to 3000 metres from the coral donor site, MECA to decide final area. Monitoring will include daily inspections by divers and bi weekly water sampling. The bidder should include provision for necessary boat rentals & laboratory costs and execution plan. The reclamation areas and the Royal Oman Police requirements, in terms of the Base and Option Cases are detailed in Appendix 6 PART I (g) of the EPC RFP. The Royal Oman Police, the Owner and/or OPWP shall provide the necessary in-principle clearances, including the no objection certificate from the Ministry of Environment and Climate Affairs to the Owner, and/or OPWP for the same, prior to the issuance of the Notice to Proceed. The Owners environmental impact statement shall include the coastal reclamation works as defined in the Base and Option Cases. The Bidder is responsible for all construction related permits for the reclamation works. On completion of the reclamation works, the reclaimed area shall be handed over to the Owner and/or the Royal Oman Police. The Base Case and Option Case should each be quoted for separately and both are identified in Appendix 6. The design of the rock armour revetment and land reclamation is included in the scope of services, as is the relocation of any coral inhabiting the reclamation area seabed and monitoring of the coral during the construction period, adhering to any conditions imposed by MECA. The coral habitat to be translocated is identified in Appendix 6. The Bidder should provide include for the cost of Monitoring Process to the translocate Corals during reclamation phase periodic and till the COD. Monitoring process includes marine water sampling for analysis of TSS;
Any confirmatory Site investigations required (geotechnical, topographical, seismic, hydrogeological, hydrological, contaminated land, meteorological, soil resistivity, bathymetric, etc). Initial surveys by the Owner are provided in Appendix 6 of the RFP for information. The Bidder is to carry out their own surveys; Any confirmatory Site topographical surveys required; Data collection (including verification of design data provided in the Specification including transmission system technical data); Site preparation, including preparation of Phase 1 and 2 areas, Phase 2 laydown area, common gas facilities, RAECo substation area, site drainage and sewage systems. Diversion and permanent drainage of the mountain side rainwater run-off to storm water drains is included in the scope of services. The RAECO substation site area is to be prepared to the same specification as Phase 1 & 2 in section 9.1.1, the location and the dimensions are indicated on PDF Krookie of MIPP in Appendix 6 of the RFP; Modifications to, or the relocation or removal of, existing pipelines, cables, drainage systems or any other facilities, which may be present on the Site; Bunding around Fuel Oil storage tanks; Engine foundations and associated work including power house building housing engines, generators and auxiliary equipment; Auxiliary transformer foundations, steelwork, ground works, slabs, firewalls and finishing works
PAGE 4
Central control room (Control Room); Electrical equipment building; Administration, workshop and stores building(s); Water treatment plant and building; Other ancillary buildings as a specific requirement of the EPC Contractors plant; Miscellaneous plant foundations; Pipe and cable bridges/racks, service ways, ducts and trenches; Oil and water tank foundations, bunds etc.; Fuel unloading facility Fire protection building; Gas reception area and gas pipeline reticulation including the MOG requirement for separate access to Natural Gas fiscal metering system and Natural Gas fiscal metering system building / enclosure from the perimeter road; Galleries, staircases and landings for access to the Plant; Ancillary and temporary buildings (including offices for the EPC Contractor, OPWP and the Owner) and temporary housing camp (as required); Roads and paved areas including construction of permanent access roads on-Site, construction of the primary access road to have a slope of not greater than 5% and connection to the secondary access road and perimeter roads. All roads to include lighting and barriers. Site services including fresh water, general station use water, and fire services water reticulation; Storm water drainage, reject water and chemical process water systems; Site wide effluent collection and reticulation system; Fencing and gates; Any additional site boundary wall/fencing with lighting; Site finishing works trimming, grading, protection, hard landscaping; and Construction of seawater intakes or beach wells (as required) and a water discharge system
13. Temporary fencing, lighting and guarding and all other materials and services necessary for the safety and security of persons and property at the Site or such other areas used for storage during construction; 14. Initial fill of lubricant, greases and other consumables (including initial fill of water treatment chemicals) except fuels (Natural Gas and Fuel Oil) up to handover by the EPC Contractor. 15. Spares as described in this Specification 16. Special Tools as described in this Specification at paragraph 4.25; 17. Factory testing, commissioning and Acceptance Tests 18. Design, procurement, transportation, engineering and project management services 19. HAZOP, safety studies, location risk assessment for air intakes and exhaust stacks in the event of gas release from MGP, etc 20. All plans, approvals, permits, authorisations, licenses etc in order to complete the Works and any costs associated with such approvals, etc. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining all construction and building work permits.
PAGE 5
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification 21. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for submitting all statutory and design code calculations for third party verification, and obtaining such approvals as are required. 22. Comprehensive training of Owners operations and maintenance (O&M) personnel. 23. As-built drawings and comprehensive, fully cross referenced O&M manuals in hard copy and suitable electronic form with suitable software program to allow ease of use. 24. Warranty as described in the Contract.
2.2.
Terminal points
The Plant shall operate as a stand-alone Plant with its own independent systems to ensure security of supply. The Plant shall have the following interfaces:
2.2.1.
The 132kV interface to the transmission connection shall be the 132 kV GIS cable box(es) located in the LTSO GIS substation. Interconnection of the Plant earthing system and the Tibat grid substation earthing ring Terminals in interface marshalling cubicles in interface room in the new Tibat grid substation for the following hardwired signals interchange:
VTs and CTs secondary connections (for step-up transformer protection); inter-tripping signals (for Plant protection); interlocking signals; VT secondary connections (for synchronizing); paralleling device signals for synchronising of the Licensed Transmission System Operators 132 kV circuit breakers at Tibat grid substation; protection signals; control signals; monitoring signals; measurements; metering signals; signals via IEC 60870-5-101 (serial) or IEC 60870-5-104 (TCP/IP) data communication links (protocol to be finalised at the design stage) to multiplex interface provided by the Licensed Transmission System Operator in the interface room of Tibat grid substation (according to the RAEC Code and the Consolidated SCADA List). This should include the signals required by the Licensed Transmission System Operator and the signals required by the Owner from the Licensed Transmission System Operator; and voice communication.
Two cable connections up to the circuit breakers of the 11 kV switchboard in the Tibat grid substation to supply auxiliary power with a capacity up to 1 MVA at 11kV (with (n-1) level of security) to the Tibat grid substation Control and protection terminals at 11 kV switchgear in Tibat grid substation
PAGE 6
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification 11 kV cable differential protections. The EPC Contractor shall provide the necessary fibre optic cable and ensure that his relay will be able to co-ordinate with the relay being provided by the Licensed Transmission System Operator procured for the purpose; and Direct dial and hotline interface.
2.2.2.
Plant synchronisation shall be controlled from the Plant. 132 kV circuit breakers at the Tibat grid substation shall synchronise using the paralleling device. In the Tibat grid substation control building, a separate room will be provided for the accommodation of interface and tariff metering equipment. The room will have direct access from outside the building for access to the interface and metering equipment. All SCADA and metering interfaces from the Plant shall be installed and connected at the interface cubicles / marshalling panels by the EPC Contractor. The hardwired signals interchanged to and from the Licensed Transmission system Operator, at the interface marshalling cubicle shall be exchanged as follows:
4 to 20 mA signals for analogue; and volt-free change over contacts for digital signals.
There shall be a common signal interface panel, to be supplied, installed and connected by the EPC Contractor, located in the new 132 kV Tibat grid substation. For all signals from/to the RDC, the Licensed Transmission System Operator will connect them to the RDC. Bi-directional tariff quality meters shall be supplied and installed by the EPC Contractor in a metering panel located in the Tibat grid substation interface room. (Two (2) sets of meters will be supplied the main tariff metering equipment and back-up tariff metering equipment). All generator transformer protection shall be supplied by the EPC Contractor and shall be located in the Plant area. All connection cable protection shall be supplied by the EPC Contractor and shall be located in the Plant area.
2.2.3.
The Plant shall be incorporated into the Licensed Transmission System Operators SCADA/energy monitoring system (EMS) at the RDC. Necessary multiplexing equipment will be provided by the Licensed Transmission System Operator and located at the Tibat grid substation. The SCADA/EMS interface between the RDC and Plant shall be achieved using two independent gateways for conversion to IEC protocol 60870-5-101 (serial) or IEC 60870-5-104 (TCP/IP), protocol to be finalised during the design stage. Interoperability between the RDC and Plant shall be ensured. The interface shall be communication ports on the multiplexing equipment provided by the Licensed Transmission System Operator. The EPC Contractor shall provide all materials required to establish redundant communication links to the multiplexing equipment, including patch cords, network switches, fibre optic patch panels and fibre optic cable with accessories. The data exchange between the RDC and the Plant as given in the RFP Appendix 6, Part I (f) shall be provided and contain general requirements for different signal categories (measurements, production metering, status indications, controls, indications/ alarms). The Consolidated SCADA List as given in the RFP Appendix 6 Part I (e) contains all signals to be exchanged with the RDC, from/to the Plant as well as from/to the Tibat grid substation:
Section A, substations.
PAGE 7
Section B, Plants: The signals are mainly related to the Plant and shall be exchanged with the DCS supplied by the Owner. However, there are some signals related to the HV side of the step-up transformers, which shall be measured within the substation and they will be exchanged as above.
2.2.4.
The interfaces to the Natural Gas supply system will be in accordance with Section 6 of this Specification. Natural Gas shall be supplied by pipeline from the adjacent gas processing plant to an agreed, metered terminal point at the gas conditioning facilities at the Plant boundary. Remote monitoring interface to adjacent gas processing facility terminal point at a signal terminal cabinet located at the gas pipeline terminal point.
2.2.5.
The following service interfaces shall also be considered by the EPC Contractor: Lube oil and Fuel Oil shall be delivered by road tanker. Loading points shall be provided by the EPC Contractor in close proximity to the inlet to the storage tanks at site Clean water supply from dedicated sea water connection and water treatment plant Clean water drains to seas outfall, after treatment, via site drainage system Sewage connection fitting for trucking offsite Chemicals will be delivered by road tankers and be unloaded at a dedicated unloading station adjacent to the chemical storage tanks within the Plant. The terminal point shall be the inlet flanges on the respective chemical unloading manifolds; Waste oil will be pumped to the waste oil storage tank, where it will be removed by road tanker; Plant access road will be from the existing adjacent public highway.
2.2.6.
The responsibility for the supply and installation of metering shall be as tabled below:
PAGE 8
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Location Energy Input/Output (132 kV level) Main (Pay) Metering Facilities Tibat grid substation metering Room Tibat grid substation Supply Licensed Transmission System Operator (Owner to co-ordinate his requirements) Installation
CT / VT
Meter
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
Gas Metering Facilities Main (Pay) Metering Facilities Fuel Oil Metering Facilities Plant metering room EPC Contractor EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor Supply Licensed Transmission System Operator (Generator to co-ordinate his requirements)
CT / VT
Back-up (Check) Metering Meter Facilities Gas Metering Facilities Back-up (Check) Metering Facilities Fuel Oil Metering Facilities
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
EPC Contractor
2.2.6.1.
Electrical Energy Delivered from the Plant will be measured at the Electrical Delivery Point on the 132 kV system. The metering equipment for the above mentioned supply locations shall be provided installed, maintained, owned and operated by the EPC Contractor according to the Metering and Data Exchange Code (RAEC Code, RMDEC.5 Electricity Meters). The metering equipment will give, for each direction of flow, the following quantities: a continuous automatic record of both MW and MVAr; an automatic record of the MWh and MVArh according to RMDEC.7.4.1 (RAEC Code); and a continuous integrating record of the MWh and MVArh. The system shall have history recording and reporting features. The metering panel shall have a security sealing arrangement.
PAGE 9
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification One (1) set of the meters shall be used to separately measure the Electrical Energy imported and exported by the Plant. The second set of the meters measuring in the same manner as the first set, will be used for verification purposes. Each set of meters shall be connected to a separate set of current transformers. Provisions shall be made for signalling the above data to the RDC. The accuracy of meters, current transformers and voltage transformers shall each be within zero point two per cent (0.2%). All meters shall be sealed.
2.2.6.2.
The EPC Contractor shall supply and install the gas energy metering equipment at the GCF, including an independent access to the metering compound. Independent access provisions shall be provided in the Plant Metering Room supplied for the Ministry of Gas (MOG) to access the fuel gas metering system.
2.2.6.3.
The EPC Contractor shall provide and install all necessary Fuel Oil metering equipment including: flow indication, registration and metering; automatic record of Fuel Oil quantity consumed over time interval; and continuous integration record of Fuel Oil consumed.
2.2.6.4.
The EPC Contractor shall provide and install Ambient Conditions Measurement Facilities for monitoring the ambient conditions at the Site which shall include instrumentation for measuring ambient air temperature (dry bulb), ambient barometric pressure and relative humidity.
2.2.7.
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the design of all its terminal points and the full management of all its interfaces. To ensure adequate coordination, the EPC Contractor shall arrange a dedicated interface meeting with the two other project related contractors (switchyard and gas supply) as soon as possible after the contract is awarded, but not later than 1 month after Limited Notice to Proceed (LNTP) or Notice to Proceed (NTP) whichever occurs earlier.. At this meeting all terminal point locations, design parameters and physical tie-in responsibilities shall be determined and agreed in writing. A point of contact from each contractor shall be nominated to liaise and manage the interfaces between the parties, and the Owner shall be copied on all correspondence.
2.3.
The Owner shall provide the following services during construction: a. Operators and maintenance personnel shall work under the supervision and direction of the EPC Contractor during Plant commissioning. b. Permits, Licenses and Approvals as outlined herein The EPC Contractor shall provide the following services during construction:
PAGE 10
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification a. All electricity supplies b. All construction and potable water It shall be the EPC Contractors responsibility to obtain and treat all water required to ensure it is suitable for concrete production and for use as potable water.
2.4.
The following items are excluded from the scope of the EPC Contractor:
2.4.1.
The construction, operation and maintenance of the Tibat grid substation is outside the scope of the Project with the exception of connection of four (4) connection lines and associated equipment to connect the new Plant incoming circuits to the new 132kV substation. The grid substation equipment installed by the Licensed Transmission System Operator shall be suitable for 3 phase, 50 Hz, 132 kV nominal voltage, and the system shall be a solid neutral earthed system complying with the following: highest system voltage 3 phase symmetrical short circuit current 3 phase asymmetrical short circuit full wave impulse voltage (BIL) phase to earth circuit breaker insulating and interrupting medium isolation 145 kV rms 40 kA rms / 3 seconds. 128 kA peak 650 kV peak SF6 1050 kV
2.5.
Regulatory approvals
The Owner has undertaken a pre-feed environmental assessment and obtained a Preliminary Environmental Permit (PEP) from Ministry of Environment and Climate Affairs (MECA). The Owner is following a comprehensive approval process involving planning and environmental issues. The Owner will complete an Environmental Impact Assessment (EIA) to secure approval for the development based on the selected technology, design and plant configurations. The copy of the pre-feed environmental assessment report will be provided to the EPC Contractor for information. The EPC Contractor shall be required to support the Owner by providing necessary information in the EIA and shall comply with the relevant requirements of the EIA. On completion a copy of the EIA will be provided to the EPC Contractor for information.
2.6.
The codes and standards for the Plant shall be in the following order of precedence: 1. Omani standards e.g. Oman Electrical Standards as defined in the RAEC Code as may be approved by the relevant Competent Authority from time to time; 2. the standards and recommendations of the International Organisation for Standardisation (ISO) and the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC); and 3. other standards and codes which are internationally accepted.
PAGE 11
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The codes, standards and specifications referenced in this Specification shall include addenda and amendments in force at Notice to Proceed (NTP) and shall govern in all cases where references to them are made. Other equivalent international standards may only be used with the written agreement of the Owner. Where specified otherwise, mechanical systems may also be designed, manufactured, constructed and installed according to the following standards, amongst others: Engine Vibrations Mechanical design Stair and platforms ISO 3046 ISO 8528 part 9 EN-ISO 12100 ISO
Dimensional standards for installation materials (pipes, beams, etc.) DIN, ISO, SFS and EN Pipe design calculations Tanks Typical material standards EN 13480 and DIN 2413 API 650 for Design only DIN, SFS and EN
The EPC Contractor shall comply with all laws and regulations of Oman. All apparatus and material supplied, and all work carried out and matters arising in fulfilment of the Contract shall conform, at the EPC Contractor's expense, in all respects to all the laws and regulations, by-laws and requirements of national/local or other authorities which are applicable to the Works. The Works shall be designed, constructed, and commissioned in accordance with the Contract and International Standards. Where no appropriate Standard exists, an alternative Standard may be used, subject to the agreement of the Owner. In the event that a conflict arises between codes and standards of practice nominated in the Contract the more stringent criteria shall govern. Should the difference not be resolved on the criteria of stringency the Owner shall decide which provision shall apply. The EPC Contractor shall be obliged to comply with all such decisions without any variation to the Contract. The EPC Contractor shall not depart from the agreed Standards without the written acceptance of the Owner. The EPC Contractor shall provide information regarding their proposed standards in response to this requirement. All units of measurement and symbols shall conform to the Systeme International dUnites (SI units) for basic and derived units or names of units, unless otherwise agreed in writing by the Owner. SI units shall be used in all correspondence, documentation, calculations, drawings, measurements etc. If reference has to be made to non-standard items, the SI units shall be quoted followed by the non-standard units in brackets.
PAGE 12
3.
3.1.
a)
b)
c)
d)
the largest power loss is limited to the greater of the output of the largest operating generating unit or the sum of the outputs of generating units connected to the same busbar section; that at all times the maximum step load available from the generating units that remain in service after the largest power loss does not exceed the maximum permissible step loading available.
e)
The Plant is required to operate over the entire load range and emissions to air must remain within controlled limits : for the Plant operating above [22 MW], each generating unit shall not be operated at a load less than fifty (50) per cent of its MCR rating within the guaranteed emission limits. for the Plant operating below [22MW], each generating unit shall not be operated at a load less than thirty (30) per cent MCR rating within the guaranteed emission limits.
f)
Each Reciprocating Engine power unit shall be capable of independently operating on either Natural Gas or Fuel Oil. Individual Power Units or Power Unit Blocks should be able to operate on Fuel Oil with the remaining Power Units or Power Unit Blocks operating on Natural Gas;
g)
Fuel Oil operation is permissible to meet primary response requirements provided the generating units change back to gas once stable operation is achieved. The maximum recovery time for a step load increase shall be 5 seconds. Change to Fuel Oil operation shall be automatic, immediate and with no interruption to load.
PAGE 13
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification h) The primary response of generating units governor system shall increase power output to restore the generation/demand power balance without the system frequency falling below 45.0Hz. Generating units shall not be dispatched at levels below the minimum output necessary for stable operation and with no restrictions on subsequent loadings within the permissible step loading. Bidder is required to provide evidence that the primary response capability is acceptable taking into account prime mover speed controllers, air/fuel system dynamics, prime mover dynamics and generating unit rotating mass inertia. Tenderers may optimise the design of generating units to enhance their ability to accept larger step load increases in order to meet primary response requirements. The Plant shall have the ability to deliver the minimum net firm power capacity of 100 MW at the Reference Conditions within the Natural Gas Maximum Daily Quantity of 21,125 MMBTUs (equivalent to 25 million standard cubic foot per day at a minimum LHV of 845 BTU/scf) across the gas composition range provided in Appendix A of this OTS. Normal operation shall be on Natural Gas with Fuel Oil providing the alternative fuel. Generating unit switchboards shall be provided such that following a forced outage of any single generation circuit or single section of busbar, the loss of power In-feed shall not exceed the largest power in-feed loss. A "single section of busbar" is defined as a section of the switchboard that is either stand alone or connected via busbar section circuit breakers. Generating unit switchboards shall be provided with step-up transformers to the RAECo 132kV transmission system. The number and ratings of step up transformer shall be such that with the forced outage of a transformer the loss of generation in-feed shall not be greater than the largest power in-feed loss and all remaining transformers shall not be overloaded. Generating unit switchboards shall be equipped with switchgear with short circuit ratings capable withstanding short circuit levels with all generating units synchronised when operating at rated power output at lagging power factor. To meet this requirement tenderers can provide more than one power block connected to the RAECo 132kV system in which case the contribution to short circuit levels from the other power blocks shall be taken into account. An allowance shall also be made for increased short circuit contributions from the RAECo 132kV network when further power plants are connected to the 132kV network to the extent that the 132kV switchgear short circuit level is 40kA. The RAEC System load growth over the Contract Years as defined in the LTSA together with the seasonal requirements, the daily load cycling and the spinning reserve requirements shall be taken into consideration when selecting the Power Unit capacity for the Plant. The Bidder shall select the Power Unit capacity for the Plant such that the selected Power Units result in the lowest Plant life cycle and security of supply requirements of RAEC are complied with. Bidder shall use the bid evaluation tool ((herein referred to as BET) as a basis to select a Power Unit configuration which is considered optimum. It is envisaged that the Plant will be required to operate at a high load factor during the Summer Period as defined in the LTSA and is likely to run at a lower load factor during the Winter Period as defined in the LTSA. The Plant shall have the flexibility to run with part of the Plant shutdown. The Plant must be designed, manufactured, installed and be suitable in every respect for continuous operation at the GCPC, as well as at part loads and cyclic duty to meet daily peak loads. The Plant shall be designed for an operating life of at least 25 years. The Plant shall be designed to permit unconstrained operation over the full range of ambient conditions.
PAGE 14
i)
j)
k)
l)
m)
n)
o)
p)
q)
r)
s)
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification t) The Plant shall, as a minimum, meet the following technical criteria: All equipment offered shall be of proven design and new manufacture which can meet the requirements of performance, reliability and availability specified in this document. The Plant shall be designed such that the impact of a failure of any single piece of auxiliary equipment will cause no reduction in the output of the Plant. The Plant shall be designed such that the impact of a failure of any single piece of Main Equipment will result in a loss of output of not more than the largest single power loss.
u)
The control system shall be designed and set up to ensure that one generating unit shall remain onload in the event of the loss of the 132 kV transmission grid. This is to ensure that a supply is maintained for house loads and local loads. The electrical generators shall be capable of supplying their rated real output power at rated frequency and rated power factor over the range 0.8 power factor lag to 0.95 lead for a voltage range of plus or minus 10 per cent from rated voltage at the generator transformer HV terminals. Each generator shall also be capable of supplying its rated output at rated voltage and rated power factor at a frequency which may vary between 48 Hz and 51 Hz. The electrical generators shall be capable of continuous operation without injurious effects with an output over the range 0.8 power factor lag to 0.95 power factor lead and capable of generating rated active power over the above power factor range. The plant shall be designed for automatic, immediate switchover to alternative fuel with no interruption to load in the event of a disruption to the primary Natural Gas fuel supply and the Bidder shall carry out and provide a design study to ensure that a successful fuel changeover may be achieved together with a changeover back to Fuel Oil.
v)
w)
x)
= , and =
and,
AG = Available generation MG = maximum theoretical generation FOH = forced outage hours PH = period hours. The design shall incorporate sufficient redundancy to achieve these goals and where necessary incorporate automatic start-up of the standby plant in the event of failure of the duty item.
PAGE 15
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Bidder shall provide details and references of the recorded operational reliability of the main equipment and systems to be provided.
3.3.
The Site area, location and coordinates of the Site including temporary areas that may be used for construction laydown and area allocated for the future, Phase 2, expansion of the facility are shown diagrammatically in the RfP. The entire site, as defined by the krookie, shall be levelled and compacted to the final elevation of +15m MSL with the exception of access roads. The EPC Contractor may propose a different site elevation provided that it is able to present solutions to retention of the site surface area, road slope and spoil removal. The EPC Contractor shall note that OOCEP is constructing the Musandam Gas Plant (MGP) in very close proximity to this Plant. MGP will process 20,000 bpd of crude oil and 45 MMSCFD of associated gas from the West Bukha field. MGP will include process units for separation of the well fluids, gas compression, gas dehydration, dew pointing, desalting, crude stabilisation, gas sweetening, a sulphur recovery unit, LPG bottling area, nitrogen plant, flares, produced water treatment, fuel and chemical storages, etc. The MGP off-plot facilities include a jetty, well fluid import pipelines, seawater intake pipelines, outfall systems, crude and gas export pipeline and a single buoy mooring for crude export. The MGP industrial facility presents potential operational safety hazards that the EPC Contractor must understand and consider in its proposal and its site arrangement. The EPC Contractor shall offer its optimised standard design taking into account the conceptual layout and the parameters detailed below: the Owners requirement to allow space for expansion of the Plant in the future; the topographical nature of the Site; the adjacent MGP, switchyard and incoming gas supply pipeline. The final layout shall allow sufficient space for equipment accessibility and laydown during maintenance activities such that outages can be completed within the times allowed in the overhaul schedule. The EPC Contractor shall demonstrate in the layout plan and the design of systems how these goals have been achieved, to the Owner's satisfaction and agreement. The final layout shall be to the approval of the Owner.
3.4.
Site conditions
The Plant item shall be designed to withstand the most extreme ambient conditions to which it may be subjected and to continue to function normally whilst operated at its maximum rating. The Site elevation is approximately 15 m above sea level and the following ambient conditions are provided for guidance:
PAGE 16
PAGE 17
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Temperatures maximum ambient temperature in the shade, to be taken as air inlet temperature for air-conditioning and ventilation minimum ambient temperature C (dry bulb) 50
C (dry bulb) C
average annual ambient air temperature maximum metal temperature in the sun Barometric pressure maximum barometric pressure minimum barometric pressure Humidity maximum ambient relative humidity average annual ambient relative humidity minimum ambient relative humidity Annual rainfall maximum annual rainfall minimum annual rainfall maximum rate of rainfall average annual rainfall Wind maximum wind velocity design wind velocity Dust concentration dust concentration in the air under
30
85
Mbar Mbar
1030 970
% %
100 70
10
mm mm mm/min mm
1000 5 0.8 50
km/h km/h
160 200
mg/m3
1.02.0
PAGE 18
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification normal conditions dust concentration in the air approx. under sandstorm conditions mg/m3 100
The environment shall also be considered as coastal with a salt laden atmosphere. Materials used shall be suitably selected to resist the environment. The EPC Contractor shall carry out any air sampling necessary to determine the quality of the ambient air and use this information in the design of the filtration system for the dual fuel engines and elsewhere in the design of the plant as required. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for confirming the accuracy of all data on climatic conditions at the site. Attention is drawn to prevailing severe climatic conditions, such as high ambient humidity at high air temperatures. A considerable amount of salt is contained in the atmosphere, giving rise to severe corrosion attack. Protection against dust and sand for outdoor equipment requires special attention. Rainfall is very erratic but attention must be paid to the fact that sudden heavy downpours can occur. Strong winds are common. Sand and dust storms are frequent. Sandstorms can be severe and can continue for days with the atmosphere heavily laden with dust particles. Fine dust in these sandstorms can be as small as 2 microns. Extreme wind and rainfall conditions have been experienced on a number of occasions in recent years, cyclone Gonu (2007) and cyclone Phet (2010) being the most notable extreme weather events. If the EPC Contractor requires seawater, it shall conduct its own investigations to verify the composition of the seawater and also determine additional water quality parameters such as sulphate, suspended solids (or turbidity) and boron at the Site for its design purposes. If seawater is required, the Plant must be capable of operation at a seawater temperature of 36oC.
3.5.
Fuel
Information regarding the Natural Gas and Fuel Oil to be consumed on site is included in Appendix A. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for providing the complete installation of Gas Connection Facilities and Metering Facilities to conform to the specifications and connection arrangements as detailed in Appendix D and shall provide appropriate fuel conditioning equipment consistent with the engine manufacturers requirements. The EPC Contractor will also be responsible for providing the complete installation on the Plant side of the Gas Delivery Point, downstream of the Gas Connection Facilities, Gas Metering Facilities and the Metering Systems, including but not limited to, the emergency shutdown system, equipment for the provision of Natural Gas pressure, conditioning and quality control as required by the reciprocating dual fuel gas engine generators.
3.6.
The EPC Contractor shall design the Works to minimise the use of water. Effluent streams shall be reused wherever practical. Maximum emission levels of effluent discharges from the works shall not exceed the limits stated by the MECA Ministerial Decisions and/or the IFC 2008 Environmental Health and Safety Guidelines for Thermal Power Plants. The EPC Contractor shall provide a preliminary water balance for various operating conditions in its tender.
PAGE 19
3.6.1.
Water supply
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the design and installation of the complete water treatment and reticulation system for the Works.
3.6.2.
Clean, non-contaminated storm water shall be discharged to an agreed nearby location outside the plant boundary (likely to be the sea) as per the environmental permit. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the design and installation of the complete storm water system for the Works.
3.6.3.
Reject water
The EPC Contractor shall design and install a complete reject water system for the Works, including a collection pit system to collect the reject water runoff. The design shall be complete with an interception system capable of separating any oil contained in the reject water prior to the water being discharged offsite. The collection pit system shall also be sized to capture, retain and process a total oil spill from the largest oil containing vessel from within the Plant facility and any associated fire protection or storm water captured with the oil.
3.6.4.
Sewage
All sewage from the Works shall be directed by underground pipe work to an on-site sewage treatment system. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the design and installation of the complete sewage system for the Works and shall provide any additional sewage handling and/or treatment necessary during construction.
3.6.5.
Potable water produced for the Works shall meet current World Health Organisation (WHO), PAEW and the Musandam Govenorate Drinking Water Guidelines.
3.7.
Cooling water
The plant shall be cooled using fin fan radiators and water for make-up purposes shall be supplied from the treatment plant designed and installed by the EPC Contractor.
3.8. 3.8.1.
The EPC Contractor shall design and construct the Works such that it complies with all applicable environmental laws and regulations and meets the requirements of the Ministry of Environment and Climate Affairs (MECA). All practicable measures shall be taken to prevent harm to the environment as a result of the construction and operation of the Works. This shall include all relevant Omani standards and guidelines. An illustrative, non-exhaustive list of regulations is listed below: Ministerial Decision 17/93 Regulations for the Management of Solid Non-Hazardous Waste; Ministerial Decision 18/93 Regulations for the Management of Hazardous Waste; Ministerial Decision 79/94 Issuing Regulations for Noise Pollution Control in Public Environment;
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 20
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Ministerial Decision 80/94 Issuing Regulations for Noise Pollution Control in Working Environment; Ministerial Decision 145/93 Regulations for Wastewater Re-use and Discharge (under Review); Ministerial Decision 140/93 Regulations for Chemical Materials Registration and Related Permits; Ministerial Decision 248/97 Regulations for Handling of Toxic Substances; Ministerial Decision 421/98 Regulations for Design of Septic Tanks Ministerial Decision 281/2003 Regulation for the Control and Management of Radioactive Materials; Ministerial Decision 118/2004 Regulations for Air Pollution; Ministerial Decision 316/2001 Barring of Circulation and Usage of Some Hazardous Chemical Substances including Polychlorinated Biphenyls (PCBs); Ministerial Decision 286/2008 Occupational Health and Safety Precautions; Ministerial Decision 243/2005 Regulation for the Control and management of Ozone Depleting Substances; Ministerial Decision 187/2001 Regulation Organising Issuance of Environmental Approvals and the Final Environmental Permit; Ministerial Decision 18/2012 Regulations on Management of the Climate Affairs; Ministerial Decision 68/2004 Amendment to Articles of Regulation Organising Issuance of Environmental Approvals and the Final Environmental Permit; and Royal Decision114/2001 - Law on Conservation of the Environment and Prevention of Pollution. The EPC Contractor shall design the plant and provide all environmental monitoring plant, equipment and systems such that, when operational, it shall be possible to confirm that the Works meet the requirements of this Specification Specific requirements are identified below.
3.8.2.
Emissions to air
a. Reciprocating Engines (REs) specified for the Plant shall employ the best available technology (BAT) not entailing excessive cost to minimise air emissions including lean burn technology. b. A Preliminary Environmental Approval has been obtained from MECA for the Plant subject to the approval/ detailed findings of the Owners EIA. With respect to air emissions, the Preliminary Environmental Approval is contingent on the Plant design meeting/ Owners EIA demonstrating that resulting ground level concentrations of pollutants do not exceed the provisional Omani Ambient Air Quality Standards (OAAQS). An Air Dispersion Modelling Study provided to MECA has demonstrated the OAAQS are achieved, provided the requirements (c) to (e) are fulfilled. c. The Bidder shall ensure stacks are designed to aid efficient plume rise. Stacks from individual engines are to be collected into two clusters (segmented stacks). The stacks are to be located as close to each other as practically possible and in essence form one-a single stack cluster for the purposes of plume rise. d. Stacks shall be not less than 50 meters above ground level. e. Bidder shall provide an online flue gas monitoring system (Continuous Emissions Monitoring System (CEMS)) to MECA requirements f. The Bidder shall provide guarantees with respect to emissions to air from each engine stack after the engine. Table A provides data derived from the Air Dispersion Modelling Study that ensures the OAAQS are achieved Table A: Emissions Concentrations meeting OAAQS using Natural Gas with Reciprocating Engines:
30% MCR
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ
50% MCR
100% MCR
PAGE 21
mg/Nm mg/Nm
3 3 3
150 715
150 365
150 220
Particulates (PM10) mg/Nm 50 50 50 For Natural Gas the concentration of propane may be assumed at max 3.03 mol %, butane & higher hydrocarbons at max 0.11 mol% and silicon and aromatic hydrocarbons absent. 3 Note: all emissions concentrations are expressed as Nm @15% O2, dry, 0 deg C, 1 atm
The Bidder shall provide manufacturers information on all emissions details at given site reference conditions and fuel specification from the stacks so that the Owner may complete any further air dispersion modelling required. Such information may include typical VOC (NMNEHC)/NMHC emission concentrations and mass flow rates such that the Owner may confirm that the stack height is adequate.
3.8.3.
All other emissions to air shall be minimised if it is not possible to contain them completely. The following minor air emissions are permissible: Natural Gas combustion products from gas heating units; Combustion products from the emergency/black start diesel generator The use of ozone depleting substances shall only be permitted with the agreement of the Owner, again subject to any required regulatory approval. The emission of greenhouse gases shall be minimised. No offensive odours shall be emitted from the Works. A Project Surrounding Air Quality Monitoring Station shall be provided in order to monitor the components of carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide, Nitrogen dioxides (Nitrogen dioxide and Nitrogen dioxide), hydrocarbons (methane and non-methane hydrocarbons) and suspended particles (PM 10 & PM 2.5) in addition to weather forecasting elements (i.e. wind speed, wind direction, air temperature and humidity ratio); The information obtained including the results of such monitoring shall be submitted monthly to the Ministry. Selective catalytic reduction (SCR) (Option) The Contractor shall review the project requirement to comply with the Oman regulatory requirements and IFC guidance limits for emissions of pollutants to air, as outlined in section 3.8.2 of this specification, and if appropriate provide a selective catalytic reduction (SCR) system to reduce NOx emissions below the applicable limits. The Contractor shall also take into consideration the range of main and pilot fuel compositions, engine loads, and operating conditions when considering the requirement for such SCR equipment. The Bidder shall supply an optional price for the provision of the SCR system. The SCR equipment shall include the complete operating system, including the covered storage for dry materials, all materials handling requirements, mixing tanks (if required), forwarding and dosing pumps, reagent bulk tank, catalyst, controls, instrumentation, air compressor plant (if required), interconnecting pipework and safety related equipment.
PAGE 22
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The contractor shall include for a 90 days supply of all reagents in his offer, based on the continuous operation of all reciprocating engines station at full load.
3.8.4.
Emissions of dust
The EPC Contractor shall control and monitor the emissions of dust during construction activities. The EPC Contractor shall provide a plan detailing the measures it intends to implement in order to achieve zero visible dust emissions from the Site. The Work shall be undertaken in such a way as to prevent the release of dust from the Site and shall be monitored using an agreed localised dust monitoring program, and the dust concentrations shall be compared with OAAQS. The area of disturbance shall be minimised. Mobile water carts shall be used to dampen any areas of exposed soil.
3.8.5.
Emissions to water
The Works shall be designed such that they comply with the recommendations of the EIA and IFC 2008 Environmental Health and Safety Guidelines for Thermal Power Plants. Reject water shall be free of oils and solids and drainage systems shall be designed such that no flooding of the Project or adjacent facilities will result from Construction or operation of the Project. Oily wastes shall be led to a treatment system prior to discharge. Contaminated, or potentially contaminated, waste streams shall be collected and treated prior to discharge. Contaminated waste water shall be treated so that the effluent emissions do not exceed the limits specified by the IFC 2008 Environmental Health and Safety Guidelines for Thermal Power Plants, as listed: are met
Parameter pH Total Suspended Solids Oil and grease Total residual chlorine Chromium (Total) Copper Iron Zinc Lead Cadmium Mercury Arsenic Temperature increase Maximum concentration mg/L 6-9 50 10 0.2 0.5 0.5 1.0 1.0 0.5 0.1 0.005 0.5 Not more than 1C within 300 m eters of the discharge(as per MECA requirement 159/2005)
The EPC Contractor shall provide a suitable testing kit which will allow the Owner to regularly take samples and test the quality of all discharges. Facilities shall be provided where necessary to prevent the discharge of liquid effluents not meeting the requirements of this specification.
PAGE 23
3.8.6.
The entire Plant must be designed, operated and maintained in such a way to prevent any soil contamination. Hazardous or industrial waste shall be stored and disposed of in a manner to minimize its impact on the environment including appropriate segregation for storage and separate disposal by a waste transporter agreed by the Owner. Hazardous or industrial waste shall not be buried on site. A comprehensive plan shall be prepared and submitted to Hazardous and Non-Hazardous Waste Department of Different Types (i.e. liquid and solid wastes) of the Ministry, including full details about procedures taken in order to decrease, recycle and treat such wastes, compliance with the correct environmental management with regard to the storage and handling of raw material, The plan shall include non-storage of raw material and wastes in open places or on grounds that are not lined with leakageprevention materials. Environmental license applications related to the same shall be submitted to the component departments of the Ministry.
3.9. 3.9.1.
Noise General
The EPC Contractor shall design the Works such that the specified noise criteria are met under all operating conditions including start-up, shutdown, and normal operation and unit trips. The sound levels shall be measured according to ISO standards and warning notices shall be provided at all entrances to rooms or areas where the noise level may exceed 75 dB (A). The wording of these notices shall be subject to the agreement of the Owner. All single frequencies generated may be significant and require abatement. Noise shall be free of tones, special audible characteristics or impulsiveness. Subjective assessment of such characteristics shall be supported by objective evidence (e.g. frequency analyses), where appropriate. When any noise has such special audible characteristics a minimum 5 dB penalty shall be applied. To meet the noise level requirements, the Plant is required to be equipped with standard noise attenuation features. All machinery which exceeds the permissible noise limits shall be equipped with silencers or with lagging or specially designed acoustic enclosures.
3.9.2.
Noise impact
The limits of noise emitted from the Plant shall not exceed the relevant limits of the Oman regulation MD 79/94; Regulations for the control of noise pollution control in public environment: Article 2(b): industrial plants and public works - power plants:
Leq, T, dB(A) type of district A Rural residential recreational Suburban residential Urban residential Urban residential with some workshops or business; city hub 60 65 65 65 Over time period B 55 60 60 60 C 50 55 55 55
PAGE 24
The applicable time periods are defined in the regulations as; A - workdays - daytime; after seven a.m. up to six p.m. LMT B - evenings - evenings; after six p.m. up to eleven p.m. LMT C - holidays and nights; after eleven p.m. up to seven a.m. LMT For noise of tonal or impulse character, an adjustment shall be made to the measured or calculated value of the equivalent continuous A -Weighted sound pressure level of the noise. This shall be as follows: For tonal noise, the adjustment shall be 5 dB (A). For impulse noise, the adjustment shall be 5dB (A). For the noise of combined tonal and impulse character the adjustment shall be 7 dB (A).
3.9.3.
The noise levels in the following rooms shall not exceed: Offices, cafeteria, rest rooms, and any other area of common personnel use - 60 dB(A); Control room - 55dB(A); Workshops, maintenance garages, and inside all other buildings with extended occupancy by operation and maintenance staff - 55 dB(A).
3.9.4.
The EPC Contractor shall submit to the Owner interim noise design reports within three months of Notice to Proceed (NTP) demonstrating compliance with the MECA requirements and as to how the specified noise limits shall be met. Reporting shall include equipment noise levels, details of noise control measures and preliminary calculations for environmental and on-site noise. The use of engineering controls to reduce workplace noise shall be used as the primary control mechanism wherever it reasonably possible to do so. A final noise design report shall be submitted to the Owner within 6 months of Notice to Proceed. This report shall include but not be limited to the following: All equipment suppliers noise guarantees and supporting data. Details of all noise control measures. Calculations of in-plant and environmental noise level to demonstrate compliance with the specified limits. Provision shall be made in the Plant facilities for monitoring and control over the noise resulting from the operation of the different units and facilities of the Plant subject to regulations regulating Noise Pollution issued as per Ministerial Decrees Nos. (79 and 80 / 94) on the Control of Noise Pollution Existing in the Public and Workplace Environments.
PAGE 25
3.10.
Risk assessment
The EPC Contractor shall note that a Location Risk Assessment (LRA) has been undertaken for the Site and this assessment has identified potential risks arising from the proximity of this site to the nearby Musandam Gas Plant and most specifically the risks associated with releases of potentially flammable or toxic gases. The EPC Contractor must be able to demonstrate compliance with all safety requirements to address possible hazards. The potential safety hazards may include, but not necessarily be limited to, release of explosive gases, release of toxic gases and proximity risk in case of explosion from MGP. The EPC Contractor shall demonstrate that its designs take due account of these and any other identified Site specific hazards and shall include risk assessments and provisions for avoidance of unnecessary evacuation of essential facilities such as control rooms following an unplanned event on the neighbouring site. The design shall ensure safety of personnel and plant is paramount and shall include appropriate gas detection and protection facilities. To the maximum extent practical, and without comprising safety, the plant shall be designed also to avoid unnecessary and spurious shutdowns.
3.11.
HAZOP studies
The EPC Contractor shall run HAZOP studies once the preliminary designs (including P&IDs, PFDs and SLDs) for all systems are complete. These studies shall examine the design of the Works and determine whether the design during operation, including abnormal modes of Works operation, complies with this Specification and GIP in terms of hazards and operability. Drawings and documents for HAZOPs shall be issued no later than six weeks prior to the date of the HAZOP. The scope of the studies shall include the configuration of the control system and the provision of adequate safeguards to permit safe operation. The EPC Contractor shall give due consideration also to MGP requirements during the construction and operation of the Plant. The design of the seawater intake/outfall, if required by Owner, must take into consideration potential marine movements, the off-shore gas export pipeline from MGP as well as any impact on the seawater intake of the MGP facility. The layout of plant and equipment within the Site boundary will be an important factor in ensuring compliance with safety hazard management. The EPC Contractor must satisfy itself that adequate information is gathered to address any potential land and marine exclusion zone requirements.
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Owner may participate in these remaining plant HAZOP studies and the designs shall be modified at the EPC Contractors cost to incorporate the recommendations of the studies. The EPC Contractor shall track and report on progress associated with resolving actions raised during the HAZOP studies and present the Owner with a complete dossier showing the original minutes and the actions taken to resolve issues raised.
3.12.
The key dates for the submission of plans, drawings, O&M manuals, general information, training etc are set out in Schedule B.
3.13.
Concurrent work
The EPC Contractor shall acknowledge that in parallel with the Works, the Owner has, or shall have, engaged third parties to perform other work, including, for example, work associated with the switchyard (RAECo) and gas processing facility (MGP). The EPC Contractor shall allow the Owner such access to the Site as may be necessary to perform all such other work and shall agree a coordination and construction protocol with the Owner, RAECo, MGP and other owner-engaged third parties for the performance of such Works .
PAGE 27
4.
4.1.
General Specification
General requirements
All equipment supplied shall meet the Specification and shall conform to current prudent industry power plant practice. Notwithstanding any requirement specified herein with regard to material, design or other matters, it shall be the EPC Contractors responsibility to supply equipment which shall be fit for the purpose and entirely satisfactory for all operating conditions. The design and materials of major Plant items must be proven by evidence of the 3 years operational experience of 2 units in base load generating service in comparable ambient/climatic conditions, seawater temperature and salinity: The Works shall be capable of withstanding without damage, undue heat, strain, vibration, noise, corrosion or other operating difficulties, all stresses which may be experienced during normal operation, cyclic load operation, part loading, overspeed, sudden load swings and under all specified test conditions. All materials, plant and other supplies to be incorporated in the works shall be new and of a standard proven design. The EPC Contractor shall not propose nor provide equipment from any manufacturer, which the manufacturer proposes, for the duration of this Contract, to be superseded or outdated by a later generation of equipment. The EPC Contractor shall provide equipment which is proven and in regular commercial use and service in installations of scope and magnitude similar to this contract and for which local support and/or services in the Middle East are currently available. The Power Unit Block and all other components of the Plant, including (but not limited to) the step-up transformers, shall be selected and sized such that, in the case of failure (trip) of any Power Unit or component of the Plant or a step-up transformer, there is no loss of net output of the Plant while continuing to supply the RAEC System within the RAEC Code limits without resorting to any load shedding of the RAEC system. The design needs to take into account the step-load limits of the Power Units when operating with adequate spinning reserve. Bypasses shall be installed so that instrumentation, equipment and critical control valves can be repaired online. All equipment and systems shall have sufficient margin to cater for equipment and system wear and tear and deterioration. The EPC Contractor shall identify and justify all margins during engineering submission including margins for sizing/design of cooling water pumps, heat exchangers, HVAC systems, fire protection systems, transformer ratings, safety features, isolated phase bus rating, generator breaker rating, battery and UPS systems and the emergency/black start diesel generator. All electrical and control and instrumentation (C&I) equipment (e.g. the 400V power centre, motor control centre, UPS and DC systems, DCS, wiring cabinets, balance of plant MCCs and PLCs etc) shall be housed in air-conditioned rooms or cubicles. The Works shall be designed so that, in the event of a trip, it and its associated systems shall shutdown in a safe manner without damage to equipment. All equipment shall be designed to permit safe shutdown on loss of electrical power supply or on loss of control system. The detailed design of all buildings shall include consideration of energy efficiency. The architectural treatment shall be consistent with the overall site landscape plan.
PAGE 28
4.2.
All hardware, software and firmware supplied including any embedded systems shall be insensitive to any date change such that no value for current date shall cause any interruption in operation. The EPC Contractor shall certify that the complete Works are compliant. The EPC Contractor shall provide any standard software, firmware, and operating system developed for and applicable to the control and monitoring systems being provided by the EPC Contractor on this project. Such software shall be provided without any reservations as to its use by the Owner, except, if applicable that it be used in systems provided for this project. The EPC Contractor shall provide two sets of software backup, as applicable, in the form of CDs, ROM modules or other means of replacing or repairing damaged software. The software shall be completely documented by the EPC Contractor. The EPC Contractor shall develop and provide any custom software needed to adapt or customise the control and monitoring systems being provided by the EPC Contractor to perform the various tasks and provide the various functions required by this Specification. It is the intent of this Specification that such software development utilises routines developed by the systems manufacturers to serve as a framework for such custom software development. Customised software shall be menu driven with multi-window capabilities to the maximum extent possible, and shall utilise other guidance routines to permit personnel not trained as programmers to conveniently alter or supplement the contents of the various routines. The reservations as to the use of custom software, and the backup and documentation for such software shall be described for standard software.
4.3.
The Works shall be designed with provision for good maintenance access and for ease of operation and maintenance. All routine operation and maintenance activities shall be achievable from permanent work platforms with suitable access and safety devices (such as handrails, thermal insulation from hot parts, etc). Where it is safe to do so, it shall be possible to complete maintenance of redundant plant items, or items not essential for maintaining continuous operation of the Plant, (e.g. pumps, thermocouples, sensors) without reducing output from full load. All such maintenance activities must be planned by the EPC Contractor to be in accordance with safety requirements and applicable laws and standards, and described in the maintenance manuals. Access ways, walkways etc shall be free from cable ways, conduits, pipework etc which could cause tripping hazards or impede the normal progress of operations and maintenance staff around the Works. The EPC Contractor shall provide also a computerised maintenance management system for use by the plant operators and information shall be provided with the proposal on how the O&M of the Plant is to be supported by computerised business management tools for operation, maintenance (predictive, preventive and corrective maintenance) and plant history and inventory management.
4.4.
Lubrication
Any components requiring manual lubrication shall be provided with easily accessible greasing nipples such that lubrication can be achieved without the disassembly of any covers, guards or any other equipment. A remotely mounted electrically operated lubricator of agreed type shall be provided to serve components, if any, requiring continuous lubrication by external mechanical means.
PAGE 29
4.5.
Corrosion protection
All materials shall be selected to minimise the potential for corrosion under their service conditions. Where dissimilar metals are in contact or close proximity and corrosion may occur through electrolytic action or differences in electric potential, protection shall be afforded by electroplating, suitable gaskets, cathodic protection or other means. All surfaces shall be adequately protected in transit and any damage shall be renovated immediately on offloading and on completion of erection. Materials subject to corrosion, including all exterior equipment surfaces and structural steelwork, shall be protected with coatings systems which are suitable for exposure to a marine coastal environment. Corrosion protection for steelwork shall generally be in accordance with ISO 12944 standard, with atmospheric corrosivity classed as high and a medium design durability of 5-15 years as indicated in ISO 12944-5.
4.6.
Insulation
Thermal insulation shall be applied to all pipes having a surface temperature exceeding 60C, which are accessible to plant personnel and within 2 metres of any floor or access way. The surfaces shall be insulated with an agreed material covered by stainless steel cladding or provided with stand-off protection so that the temperature of the outside of the cladding or protection does not exceed 60C when the ambient temperature is 28C and, assum ing a wind speed of no more than 0.25 m/s and, the surface in question is not in direct sunlight. Where regular inspection of the equipment is required, the insulation and/or protection shall be readily removable. Where access across pipework or insulation is required, the insulation shall be protected by checker-plating or other suitable protection. All thermal insulation shall meet the requirements of one or more of the following Standards or its international equivalent if agreed by the Owner: BS 3708 - Thermal Insulating Materials between 230C - 650C; BS 3958 - Thermal Insulating Materials
Part 2 - Calcium Silicate Preformed Insulation Part 3 - Metal Mesh Faced Mineral Wool Mats and Mattresses Part 4 - Bonded Preformed mineral Wool Pipe Sections Part 5 - Bonded Mineral Wool Slabs (for use above 50C);
BS 5422 - Thermal Insulation in the Range 95C - 230 C No asbestos - containing insulation shall be used. Cladding shall be not less than 0.7mm (22 SWG) in thickness and shall be adequately supported to prevent sagging or excessive deflection. In the case of exterior surfaces, it shall be designed to resist wind loadings. Due allowance shall be made in the design and fixing of the cladding for thermal expansion of the lagged surface. Where necessary, expansion joints shall be provided in insulating materials. All joints in cladding shall be waterproof.
PAGE 30
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Insulation of large flat or curved surfaces shall be by means of blankets or preformed slabs retained by pins and wired into position as necessary. The insulation for piping systems shall be of the moulded pre-formed type. Pipework insulation shall be terminated at a distance equal to the length of the flange bolts from the flange in the case of flanged joints or at point which permits preparation of the pipe end for welding without disturbing the insulation in the case of welded-in valves. The joint or valve shall be insulated independently of the pipe by preformed blocks or blanket type material of thickness at least equal to that of the adjacent pipe insulation. Valves shall be insulated up to and including the bonnet but not the bonnet joints. Insulation and lagging over all flanges and valves shall be easily removable and replaceable without disturbing the surrounding insulation. The separate portion of the lagging shall extend sufficiently far along the pipe to allow the joint bolts and nuts to be withdrawn without disturbing the lagging on the pipe. The casing over flanges shall have a drain hole to indicate the presence of a leak. Insulation shall be continuous through floors, walls, pipe supports, anchors, guides and hangers. The insulation shall be sealed at all interruptions due to hangers etc. and the cladding shall be flashed and sealed to make it weather tight. Insulation shall be installed only after the completion of any hydrostatic or NDT testing or examination of the pipework system or equipment has been completed.
4.7.
Chemicals
Chemical storage areas and facilities shall be sized to store up to three months supply of chemicals assuming the Works operates at full load. All such storage facilities shall comply with statutory requirements and relevant Codes and Standards. Eyewashes and emergency showers using potable water shall be provided wherever chemicals are to be handled. The flooring in areas where chemicals are in use, handled or stored shall be suitably prepared/coated to protection them in the event of a spill. Where any supporting slab or platform may be subject to contamination by any corrosive agent or wetness due to liquid spillage, the EPC Contractor shall provide appropriate surface protection by means of chemical resisting coating/tiles or anti-slip coating/tiles, to be agreed by the Owner. Road tanker unloading areas shall be lowered relative to the surrounding areas and shall be designed to contain spills and direct drainage from these areas to the reject water system.
4.8.
Buildings
The dual fuel engines, generators and associated auxiliary equipment shall be located indoors and shall include an overhead crane system. The arrangement of the major equipment within the building shall allow access for the overhead crane for maintenance. The major outdoor equipment and facilities shall include the inlet filter house, radiators, exhaust stack and bulk liquid storage area(s).
4.9.
Signage
Wall mounted signs shall be provided at all floors, platforms, etc. to indicate reduced headroom clearance, hazardous areas, hearing protection zones, warning signs and others as required by the design review, HAZOP, and applicable codes and standards.
PAGE 31
4.10.
Degree of automation
The plant shall be automated as far as possible and require minimum operator intervention for normal operation. Local control facilities shall be provided for each gas engine and associated auxiliary equipment at their local control panels. The controls provided at the panels shall allow starting, stopping and emergency tripping of the dual fuel engines and auxiliaries. All motors, valves etc. which must be operated during start-up, shutdown, normal, emergency or special operations of the plant and auxiliaries shall be automatically operable from the central control room. Notwithstanding this, it shall also be possible for the operator to interrupt the automatic, programmed sequences and control the plant manually. The degree of automation provided shall ensure the plant can be safely and reliably started, shut down, controlled and monitored from a remote control room location.
4.11.
Lay-down areas
The engine building design shall provide the necessary access and lay-down area to operate and maintain the Works. A truck access aisle into the area shall provide free passage of a trailer loaded with the largest component or sub-assembly to be handled. The lay-down areas shall be large enough to accommodate the full disassembly of the complete power train at one time. Space shall also be provided for free access to components by maintenance personnel, in order to perform required service operations and accommodate use of appropriate tools. The lay-down areas shall be arranged and located to permit X and Y horizontal movement, in addition to vertical access by the overhead crane hooks. The need to pass major components over operating units shall be minimised.
4.12.
The EPC Contractor and subcontractors shall make every effort to standardise mechanical and electrical equipment as well as instrumentation. Consumable items such as indicating lamps, recorder charts, printer papers, ink cartridges and ribbons etc. shall be standardised so as to reduce to a minimum the types and sizes to be held in stock. The Works shall be designed to permit interchange ability of parts and ease of access during inspection, maintenance and repair. A KKS (Kraftwerk Kennzeichnungs System) or agreed equivalent Plant Identification System comprising of alphanumerical characters shall be used to identify all equipment and components of the Works. The Plant Identification System shall be integrated into the DCS, main plant and all auxiliaries. The EPC Contractor shall provide detailed training sessions and full documentation for the supplied Plant Identification System prior to commissioning work. The EPC Contractor shall supply soft and hard copies of the KKS (or equivalent) component list for the plant and for all components on which maintenance must be carried out. The list shall include: KKS, Plant Item, Reference Drawings, O&M Manual Reference and Spares Reference. The EPC Contractor shall provide details of the proposed Plant Identification System in its tender.
PAGE 32
4.13.
Prohibited materials
The Works shall not incorporate: Asbestos or asbestos-containing materials; naturally occurring aggregates for use in reinforced concrete and/or naturally occurring aggregates for use in concrete which do not comply with the appropriate Standards; cast iron piping materials for any oil service; PCBs; Askerals; CFCs or other ozone depleting substances except (with Owners consent in writing) in applications where their use cannot reasonably be avoided, and is generally accepted for the specific application; carcinogenic materials; and any other materials generally known in the construction industry at the time of use to be deleterious to health or the environment if used or incorporated in such Works.
4.14.
The Plant is located adjacent to hazardous installation, MGP. The Owner is required to demonstrate via a Quantitative Risk Analysis (QRA) that the proposed plant does not present unacceptable risks to the public or to the operation of adjacent facilities. The QRA is also to address the risks from adjacent facilities to the Plant and demonstrate that the risks to both the workforce and operation and reliability of the Plant are acceptable. The EPC Contractor shall prepare his own QRA in consideration of these requirements and support the Owner by providing mitigation measures in the Plant design in accordance with the 'as low as reasonably practical' (ALARP) principle. The EPC Contractor shall carry out a thorough, comprehensive plant-wide assessment of all areas which could be deemed hazardous in accordance with IEC 60079 and shall complete the Works to meet all the requirements of the Codes and Standards. The assessment shall consider the fuel supply systems, power house building and any other area where an explosion risk may occur. The EPC Contractor shall take all practical steps to eliminate, by design, all potential leak points and all gas traps and this shall be supplemented by adequate and appropriate ventilation. The EPC Contractor will be required also to demonstrate adequate segregation of electrical equipment from hazardous areas and that no hazardous area extends beyond the Plant boundary fencing The EPC Contractor shall assess and define the areas of the installation where dangerous concentrations of flammable gas or vapour are likely to occur, and shall incorporate all necessary controls to prevent the risk of explosions, in accordance with IEC 60079. The EPC Contractor shall submit the relevant information to show that the ventilation system design and gas detection system meets the requirements of the applicable standard. The EPC Contractor shall ensure that potential sources of ignition within the above areas are eliminated or suitably protected to the relevant International Standard. Notwithstanding any of the above, the EPC Contractor shall be ultimately responsible for ensuring the zoning classifications as defined by the requirements of IEC 60079 are met and that the final installation complies with all personal safety and plant protection requirements.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 33
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The EPC Contractor shall prepare a dossier providing complete installation, operations and maintenance information for all equipment installed in hazardous areas and any circuitry designed to provide protection to that equipment. The dossier shall incorporate a test and maintenance plan to ensure the integrity of the installed protective systems can be monitored, recorded and maintained over the life of the plant. It shall also include details of the certification of all equipment supplied.
4.15.
The EPC Contractor shall minimise wherever possible the use of: Hazardous substances; and Dangerous goods The Works shall incorporate all safety precautions such that the transport, storage, care and use of these hazardous substances or dangerous goods shall comply with any relevant Acts and Regulations.
4.16.
All legends and notes on drawings provided by the EPC Contractor shall be in the English language. All drawings shall be dimensioned in millimetres (or metres) and drawn to one of the preferred scales quoted in ISO 5457 and on paper of the appropriate size from the International series of A sizes. A list of the drawings and documents to be submitted by the EPC Contractor is included in the Schedules. The EPC Contractor shall submit any additional drawings and/or documentation necessary to meet the requirements of the Specification. Also, the EPC Contractor shall provide a copy of any documentation submitted to third parties to satisfy any regulatory or legal requirements. Drawings showing the physical location of all devices and a plot plan showing the location of all equipment shall be provided. Plans shall be oriented so that North is at the top of the page. All drawings and lists, schedules etc., generated in conjunction with the plant, e.g. instrument lists, circuit lists, alarm lists, valve schedules etc., shall be provided in electronic as well as hard copy format. Drawings shall not be typical but shall actually represent the equipment provided. All drawings shall be corrected to as built. Proprietary drawings may be generated in PDF if they are not available in AutoCAD. The scope of potential drawings not in AutoCAD shall be limited to general arrangements, proprietary drawings and some standard drawings from sub-suppliers and shall be subject to the acceptance of the Owner. Notwithstanding this, all submittals shall include a PDF copy of each drawing, report or document. A logic diagram and a detailed list of all switches, contacts, and relays used in a normal start-up shall be provided. The logic diagram shall show the sequence of operation and typical allowance windows in which a device should operate. Before Plant Provisional Acceptance, the EPC Contractor shall provide a complete set of hand marked asbuilt drawings including all P&IDs, wiring diagrams, lists of set points and calibration data. On Plant Provisional Acceptance the EPC Contractor shall furnish to the Owner for record purposes, two sets of as-built drawings and documentation on CD Rom (one set in AutoCAD release 14 or higher format and one set as PDF) and five sets of as-built drawings and documentation in hard copy format. A minimum
PAGE 34
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification of five copies of O & M manuals shall be provided extent of Arabic language translation to be agreed between the Owner and EPC Contractor.
4.17.
Labelling
Each item of plant including, field devices and drives shall be durably and legibly labelled, indicating the purpose, plant identification number and where necessary any operating position functions. Each shall have its unique plant identification system number. Equipment descriptions shall be agreed with the Owner. All labels shall be in English but safety related labels and notices shall be in English and Arabic. The description and number of each item of plant shall be consistently applied throughout all drawings, manuals, documents and labels. The labels shall facilitate effective operation and maintenance of equipment. Labels shall be conspicuous without being obtrusive and should be capable of being read by the user when viewed from a normal working position. All labels shall be firmly fixed by means of suitable attachments to non-detachable parts of equipment, wherever possible, by using not less than two fastenings. Label fixings shall be such as to allow ready replacement without damage to the label or the fixing. All interconnecting pipes including those in trenches and all pipes carrying potentially hazardous substances shall be colour coded and have pipe markings on the outer surfaces, in accordance with an internationally recognised standard. Where pipe work and/or cables are installed underground the EPC Contractor shall supply and install reinforced concrete marker posts at each change of direction point and at intervals of no greater than 30m along the route. These marker posts shall indicate the directions and functions of the services involved. Labels shall be provided on front and rear access doors of all cubicles. Labels shall also be provided inside cubicles to assist the identification of apparatus and terminals. Labels in outdoor areas shall be metallic and corrosion resistant.
4.18.
4.18.1. General
Plant manuals shall be in the form of A4 sized books with loose leafed pages to permit the insertion of additional information or revised pages as necessary. Drawings and diagrams shall, where practicable, be reduced to no greater than A3 size to be bound into the manual as fold-out sheets. However, in the reduced size they must be completely legible and suitable for reproduction. Where a drawing cannot be reduced to a suitable size for the manual, it shall be folded to A4 size and inserted into a pocket which is to be bound into the rear of the relevant section of the manual. It is a condition of the Contract that the Owner shall be free to reproduce any part of the manuals without restriction for the purposes of the business.
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification may be appended to the text provided they are specific to the as installed equipment and free of matter applicable to other equipment or operating circumstances. Two copies of the manuals in draft form shall be submitted to the Owner for agreement. The manuals shall have the following format: i. Index The index shall provide rapid and easy access to particular subjects, drawings and illustrations. It should consist of a master index plus a sub-index to each section. ii. Description The manual shall provide descriptive information on both the major plant systems and on the components of those systems. It shall include: Drawings sufficient for understanding the descriptive information; Flow sheets or single line block diagrams which explain the function or logic of the system; Schedules such as valve schedules, materials schedules, operational limits schedules etc.; Data sheets which provide in a concise format all relevant technical details of a plant system or an individual item. (The purpose of a data sheet is to provide a quick reference to the essential details, omitting all general descriptive information.) iii. Operation This section shall include basic step by step instructions on how to operate the plant, beginning with the plant system and then proceeding to the individual items of equipment within that system. The instructions shall include references to relevant safe operating procedures and operational limits for that system or item. Details of appropriate shut-down and plant preservation procedures for extended outage periods shall also be provided. iv. Maintenance This section shall include all information necessary for the safe and effective maintenance of the plant. It shall include: A schedule of routine maintenance requirements including details of limited-life components; Details of plant checking procedures, including the allowable tolerances; Step by step maintenance procedures for the equipment, including details of the spares and special tools required to carry out the work; Fault diagnosis guidelines; Drawings sufficient to illustrate the maintenance procedures; Schedule of lubricants with details of approved suppliers and trade names; Schedule of ball and roller bearings v. Spare Parts This section shall provide information about the Spare Parts required for the plant including details of their dimensions, manufacturing standards and materials as well as ordering details for both OEM and vendor-supplied items. It shall consist of:
PAGE 36
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Recommended Spare Parts List and Consumables List together with referenced sectional drawings from which the descriptive name and part number can be identified for ordering purposes; Contact details for Spare Parts and Consumables suppliers including address, e-mail address, telephone and fax numbers. (In this context, spare parts suppliers are to be the original component or equipment manufacturer. It shall not be acceptable for the EPC Contractor to nominate himself as the supplier of bought in items unless they are manufactured by a third party in accordance with the EPC Contractor's own manufacturing drawings.); A list of spare/replacement parts required for each type of inspection/overhaul nominated in the Maintenance Section of the manual. All descriptive information and part numbers given in the manual shall be consistent with the corresponding information provided in the spare parts recommendations submitted with the Tender.
Logic Block Diagrams; Logic Flow Diagrams; SAMA Drawings of Modulating Control Configuration; Written Text description of control functions, including algorithms
Field Instrument location drawings and tapping point details; Instrument Arrangement Drawings; Safety Shutdown Systems Documentation; Instrumentation and wiring system database;
PAGE 37
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification DCS Software Register; DCS Hardware Register; The Recommended Spare Parts List; Consumables List
4.19.
The EPC Contractor shall provide an electronic system to facilitate: Spare part inventory control and ordering Access to parts catalogues and manuals Overhaul and maintenance scheduling Access to OEM service bulletins, notices etc The EPC Contractor shall provide full training on the use of the system to the Owners personnel.
4.20.
The EPC Contractor shall prepare a Construction Program using critical path network analysis. The work shall be broken down into sufficient detail to enable a correct logical sequence of activities to be established. The issue of drawings shall be covered in detail with appropriate check points to cover design information interface events. With the exception of procurement activities, activity durations shall not exceed four working weeks. Activities shall cover all aspects for which the EPC Contractor and his subcontractors are responsible. Following the initial submission the Construction Program shall be analysed monthly or at such intervals as may be determined by the Owner. The Construction Program shall not be altered without the Owners agreement. All programmes and progress reports shall be in Microsoft Project format. Hard and electronic copies shall be supplied; monthly progress reports shall be submitted. Erection schedules shall be submitted on the Monday morning of every week. The schedules shall indicate activities actually completed the previous week in relation to those scheduled, activities proposed for the current week and activities proposed for the following week. The schedules shall differentiate between the major equipment and auxiliary systems and indicate details of activities e.g. position equipment, grout anchor bolts, coupling alignment, journal and shaft levels and inspection works etc. The overall commissioning schedule showing the commencement and completion of commissioning activities including tests of each systems and plant shall be submitted to the Owner for agreement before commencement of commissioning activities. The EPC Contractor shall submit weekly commissioning schedules to the Owner on every Monday morning. These shall include details of expected fuel use and generation. In addition, daily commissioning schedules and reports shall be submitted to the Owner. These shall detail all activities carried out the previous day and all activities programmed for that day and the day after, along with updated fuel use and generation schedules.
PAGE 38
4.21.
The EPC Contractor shall identify the manufacturers and places of manufacture, testing and inspection before despatch to Site for the various portions of the Works. There shall be no departures from this list without the prior written agreement of the Owner. Selected subcontractors shall not further subcontract any section of the Works without the prior written agreement of the Owner. The Owner shall have access to the EPC Contractor's and subcontractor's Works to verify the status of design and manufacture.
4.22.
The EPC Contractor, all subcontractors and testing companies shall have Quality Systems that meet the requirements of the ISO 9001 standard or equivalent. Within the time specified, the EPC Contractor shall prepare a preliminary version of the Quality Plan containing or referencing the applicable procedures, design verification plans and inspection and test plans required for the Work. After incorporation of the Owners comments, the preliminary version of the Quality Plan shall be updated and compliance with the Quality Plan shall be considered a requirement of the Contract. The Quality Plan shall set out, or reference, all quality practices and policies to be applied to the project so as to comply with the intent of ISO 9001. It shall form the base reference document for all project specific procedures and policies as required under the Contract. Supporting procedures need not physically form part of the Quality Plan, but shall be referenced from it. The Quality Plan shall address all quality issues including, but not necessarily limited to, the following: a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) l) Responsibilities and authorities Document control Design verifications Subcontractor assessment and control Calibration requirements Traceability Non-conformance control Construction method statements Inspection and test plans Internal audits Records References to supporting project manuals (e.g. safety manual, start-up manual)
m) Storage and maintenance of equipment n) Reference to project specific procedures encompassing but not limited to; i. ii. iii. iv. Compliance programme for Applicable Permits and Applicable Laws Public relation programme and procedures Emergency preparedness & contingency plans Environmental programmes (e.g. oil interception)
PAGE 39
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification v. vi. Hazardous material handling Waste disposal
vii. Reporting of accidents, including environmental accidents, and incidents viii. Safety tagging, lockout and release procedures ix. x. xi. Foundation acceptance criteria Tool certification programme Instrument calibration programme and procedures
Two copies of the final Quality Plan for the Contract shall be submitted to the Owner for review and comment within the time specified. Prior to the start of any work affected by the procedures, the EPC Contractor shall revise all or any portion of the documentation not yet agreed to by the Owner as required by the Owner and shall submit the amended documents for review. In all cases detailed procedures and plans identified shall be produced before the relevant work commences. The Owner reserves the right to examine any procedures, records, or results of audits referred to in the Quality Plan and to audit the EPC Contractor and/or subcontractors against the requirements of the Quality Plan at any time. The Quality Plan shall include the measures to be taken for storage and maintenance for the Works and EPC Contractor's equipment prior to installation, as well as for the period between the completion of the installation and Handover. The EPC Contractor shall provide within the Quality Plan a Site Quality Control program including requirements for Site Quality Control surveillance. In addition the EPC Contractor shall provide to the Owner such assistance as may be required by the Owner in developing a Quality System to allow the Owner to acquire ISO 14001 Certificate as related to the environmental management of the Plant facilities. The EPC Contractor shall also provide assistance to the Owner in cooperation with environmental consulting companies registered in the Ministry for the purposes of compliance with environmental audits being undertaken by certified auditors related to environmental management pursuant to ISO 14001 certification
4.23.
Within the time specified in the Table of Key Dates in Schedule B, the EPC Contractor shall submit to the Owner a plan (an Inspection and Test Plan) which shall include pertinent manufacture and inspection operations including test and inspection procedures. The scope of the Inspection and Test Plan shall generally follow the sample plans described below. The Owner shall select from these the nominated mandatory hold points for surveillance. Notwithstanding this, the Owner shall have access at all times to all places where materials or equipment are being prepared or manufactured for the Works, including the works of the EPC Contractor, subcontractors or suppliers of raw materials. The Inspection and Test Plan shall include specific criteria for acceptance or rejection, including criteria for any non-destructive testing inspections. The Inspection and Test Plan may be of any form to suit the EPC Contractor's system, but it shall as a minimum:
PAGE 40
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Indicate each inspection and test point and its relative location in the production cycle including incoming, packing and site inspections; Indicate where subcontractors' services shall be employed (e.g. subcontractor NDT or heat treatment); Identify the characteristics to be inspected, examined, and tested at each point and specify procedures and acceptance criteria to be used; Indicate mandatory hold points established by the Owner which require his verification of selected characteristics of an item or process before this work can proceed; Define or refer to sampling plans if proposed and where they shall be used; Where applicable, specify where lots or batches shall be used. The EPC Contractor shall provide to the Owner at least 10 working days notice in advance of reaching a nominated witness or hold point. Work shall not proceed beyond a hold point without the written agreement of the Owner. Works inspections by the Owner may include the following activities: Monitoring to confirm the effectiveness of and the EPC Contractor's compliance with the established system procedures, quality plan and inspection of test instructions; Witnessing of inspections and tests and/or verification of inspection records to be carried out at the Owner's discretion covering:
Compliance of raw material with specified requirements. Compliance of manufactured parts, assemblies and final items with the Specification, drawings, standards and good engineering practice. Inspection of EPC Contractor's design, manufacturing, installation work and the production of progress reports. Witnessing of inspections and tests. Packing for shipment including check for completeness of shipment, handling requirements, and case markings and identification.
The Owner shall endeavour to schedule the performance of inspection and tests so as to avoid undue risk of delaying the work. In the event of postponement, by the EPC Contractor, of tests previously scheduled or of the necessity to make tests due to unsatisfactory results of the original tests, or other reasons attributable to the EPC Contractor, the EPC Contractor shall bear all costs for new tests and the costs incurred by the Owner in re-inspecting the nonconforming item or its replacement. Acceptance or rejection of the equipment and/or components shall be made as promptly as practicable following any inspection or test involvement by the Owner. However, failure to inspect and accept or reject equipment and/or components shall neither relieve the EPC Contractor from responsibility for such items which may not be in accordance with the specified requirements, nor impose liability for them on the Owner. Three hard copies and an electronic copy of all appropriate quality records, as specified in this Specification and/or as required by applicable codes and standards, shall be submitted to the Owner for review and acceptability prior to, or concurrent with, shipment or as otherwise agreed to by special arrangement with the Owner. The EPC Contractor shall implement a system to be accepted by the Owner which ensures traceability of all critical parts and components of the supplied plant and equipment and the associated quality records.
PAGE 41
4.24.
Training
The Owners plant operators and engineers are unfamiliar with dual fuel engine plants and a comprehensive training program shall therefore be provided by the EPC Contractor. The EPC Contractor shall provide all operations and maintenance training necessary to instruct the Owners staff on the safe, reliable, and efficient operation of the Works. All operators training for major plant systems (dual fuel engines, generators, MV systems) shall be complete to support commissioning. The EPC Contractor shall certify that the trainees have accomplished the goals of the training programme. Training shall address at least the following topics: Gas engine package; Generator; Transformer; Cooling system; Control system; Fuel supply systems; Hazardous areas; High voltage systems; Water treatment systems; All auxiliary systems; Electrical system and utility interface; Interfaces; Routine operational checks; Preventive maintenance; Major Plant Outages; Environmental Protection; Power Plant Safety; Plant Control System; Metering power, fuel, water etc; Spares control/inventory; Safety; Management Reverse Osmosis Desalination Natural Gas Facilities connection system The training course shall include detailed instruction on maintenance and system administration of the plant control system. Training for all major mechanical, electrical and control equipment shall be performed by representatives of the OEM.
PAGE 42
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Training shall include classroom and hands-on sessions. The classroom phase shall consist of at least two consecutive weeks of instruction in the project design, capabilities, component operation and procedures, and shall include a program for certifying operating personnel training. The EPC Contractor shall complete the start-up/testing/operational portion of the training program so the daily operation and control of the Plant can be assumed by the Owners operators in good time to support the testing and commissioning program. Each trainee shall receive a full set of all training materials prepared by the EPC Contractor. The EPC Contractor shall provide informal, hands on operations and maintenance training during the classroom training and the construction and commissioning phase. In addition, a minimum of one days hands-on training shall be provided for each system as it is being commissioned. Where plant or equipment is supplied by a sub-contractor, then training on that equipment shall be provided by the sub-contractors staff. Operators, maintenance personnel, instrument technicians and supervisors shall attend the training program. Trainees will have relevant background knowledge in power generation processes. All training shall be conducted in English and by instructors fluent in the English language who are experienced instructors on equipment identical to the systems supplied, using materials (including video presentation) prepared by the EPC Contractor that specifically have been prepared for the Works. The EPC Contractor shall allow for each trainee to receive a full set of all material used in the classroom as personal equipment to be used by the trainee. Five additional sets shall be provided. All manuals and training materials shall be in English. The various courses required shall be staggered (or repeated) in order to allow one person to attend all of them. Training manuals and supplies shall consist of four-ring binders to which material can be added as course material is presented. For each lecture or presentation, each trainee shall receive a copy of the applicable operations procedures, a lesson plan, and copies of any drawings, overhead projections, etc. used in the training session. Lesson plans shall describe the objective of the lecture and tell trainees what they are expected to do or be able to do after applicable technical references and training aids to be used and include a detailed breakdown of the points of discussion to be addressed in the training presentation. Each presentation on a plant system shall be accompanied by an in-plant inspection of the applicable system. Lesson plans shall be prepared for each system inspection that detail the key components to be viewed and the inter-system relationships to be emphasised during the inspection. Lesson content shall be based on the actual plant and equipment being supplied. The Owner shall be allowed to record the classroom training presentations. Within four weeks of the conclusion of the classroom training, the EPC Contractor shall provide the Owner a course summary manual that includes the schedule employed in the conduct of the training, copies of the training materials (lesson plans, drawing, overheads, etc.) used in each session, and copies of the examinations (with answer keys) used to evaluate student performance during and after the training.
PAGE 43
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification In general, training shall be conducted at a location in Musandam, to be determined by the Owner. Specific training courses for the dual fuel engine and control systems may be conducted at the OEMs premises. The EPC Contractor shall provide full details of its training program with the tender. The EPC Contractor shall arrange for the hiring of suitable training rooms, to the satisfaction of the Owner. The EPC Contractor shall furnish the training rooms with all equipment necessary to complete the training. All transport, meal and accommodation costs for the trainees will be paid by the Owner.
4.25.
Special tools
The EPC Contractor shall supply a complete set of any special tools and other equipment necessary for the dismantling, inspection re-erection and adjustment of the plant. This shall include any special lift jigs, frames and stands necessary to remove and support the major items of plant. All interrogation and testing software required to maintain plant and software shall be provided. If these special tools include application software, the EPC Contractor shall provide an unrestricted license to the Owner for the use of such software in relation to the Works. These special tools shall include special interface equipment and/or special interface cabling. Wherever hardware or software keys are necessary to perform maintenance for electrical and control and instrumentation equipment the EPC Contractor shall provide the software password and two sets of hardware keys. Where any of the control system is microprocessor-based, all hardware and software for monitoring, setting, tuning, testing, trouble-shooting, graphic displays, simulation and modification shall be provided. The tools provided shall be in new condition, adequately labelled as to their use and contained in stout and suitable padlocked boxes. Any special slings required shall be provided and clearly marked by embossed labels to show safe working loads. Test certificates shall be provided where applicable.
PAGE 44
5.
5.1.
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for undertaking all survey work required to determine existing site levels and features to establish a site bench mark, to set out the works to be constructed and to determine the as-constructed location of the work. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for surveying all routes to ensure that abnormal loads can be transported to their required destination. The Owner will accept no responsibility for damage, congestion or delays which may result due to inadequate route surveys or to the common use of available road connections and entrances by other vehicles using the Site. The EPC Contractor shall confine his labour, material plant and equipment to within the designated areas of the Site to which he has been given possession. Certain areas of the Site have been designated for given purposes. The EPC Contractor may use these areas for other purposes only after receiving the agreement of the Owner.
5.2.
Site facilities
The EPC Contractor shall provide, in the area(s) allocated by the Owner, any necessary temporary structures and all sanitary and other accommodation for the personnel employed by the EPC Contractor and subcontractors. The use of other areas requires special agreement. The EPC Contractor shall provide portable site offices for his own and subcontractors staff, for the Owner and operations staff. The Owners site accommodation shall be complete with furnishings which shall include four desks and chairs, filing cabinets, one photocopier, four telephones, one fax machine, shelving, toilet facilities, kitchen facilities, air conditioning and lighting. All facilities shall be regularly and systematically maintained and cleaned throughout the Works to ensure proper and efficient operation. The office shall be equipped with a sufficient number of fire extinguishers of suitable size and type. The EPC Contractor shall provide a phone and e-mail system for which it shall be responsible for all associated charges and costs. A desktop computer and colour printer shall be provided to a specification which is acceptable to the Owner. The EPC Contractor shall supply, erect, maintain and remove any and all temporary structures such as the EPC Contractor's and Owners site offices, storage sheds, workshops, tool sheds and employees' amenities sheds, change room and sanitary accommodation, etc. The buildings and associated services shall be maintained in a clean and sanitary condition. All shall be subject to the agreement of the Owner. On completion of the works the EPC Contractor shall remove from Site all temporary structures including sanitary arrangements from the Site. No residential accommodation shall be allowed on the Site or in the vicinity of the Site (unless located in a commercially run development.) The EPC Contractor shall provide all drainage and surface preparation required in the area allocated. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the maintenance of the allocated area, road access and other installed services.
PAGE 45
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Should the storage facilities or area allocated for Site accommodation and storage be inadequate, then the EPC Contractor shall make whatever arrangements are necessary to provide additional storage space.
5.3.
Security system
The EPC Contractor shall establish and operate a Site security system. All staff employed at Site shall be issued with security passes by the EPC Contractor to permit access to and from the Site. The EPC Contractor shall ensure that security rules are complied with. Access to the Site shall be via a single, controlled security gate which shall be manned at all times once work has begun on Site. A register shall be maintained to record the names of all personnel on Site at any given time. Each of the EPC Contractors or subcontractors employees working on or visiting the Site shall be identified as being employed by or responsible to the EPC Contractor by displaying suitable identification. The EPC Contractor, the EPC Contractors subcontractors and their employees shall comply with the requirements of the Owner as regards entry to and exit from the Site. No vehicles shall be allowed on Site except those carrying materials or equipment necessary for execution of the Works. Each vehicle entering or leaving the Site may be subject to inspection of both the vehicle and its contents. Private vehicles, except for permit holders, may be barred from entering the Site. Each container, including personal bags, cases and the like being brought onto or taken from the Site may be subject to inspection. The EPC Contractor shall supply, erect and maintain temporary fencing, lighting and guarding and all other materials and services necessary for the safety and security of persons and property at the Site or such other areas used for storage or accommodations. The temporary fencing shall be removed when the EPC Contractor removes all other temporary facilities.
5.4.
Safety
The complete Works shall be undertaken and be operable and maintainable in full compliance with all relevant international and local standards, acts, regulations, codes and statutory instructions with respect to Health and Safety. The EPC Contractor shall also comply with the HSEC procedures of the Owner. The Laws of Oman shall apply to all aspects of Health and Safety. Halon, Freon, hydrazine, asbestos and PCBs shall not be used in any part of the Works. The consumption of intoxicating substances on Site is strictly prohibited. Safety management is of primary importance. The EPC Contractor shall be deemed to have made itself aware of all current safety legislation and the Specifications. The EPC Contractor shall provide qualified first aid cover for minor treatment and shall ensure that at least two persons amongst the site staff are trained in first aid. A suitable facility shall be maintained to cater for first aid requirements. The first aid equipment shall include a defibrillator, and two members of site staff shall be trained in its correct use. The EPC Contractor shall submit a detailed health and safety plan relating specifically to this project in due course before any construction activity starts on Site. Start of construction at Site shall not be permitted
PAGE 46
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification unless this document is in place and agreed by the Owner and no consideration shall be given to any claim that may devolve from this Plan not being in place. Method statements shall support the health and safety plan and systems of work to be employed during the contract works. These shall be provided before any Site construction work begins. The EPC Contractor shall input to this plan all relevant health and safety documentation and shall: a. Ensure that contractors and workers comply with the health and safety plan; b. Monitor health and safety performance of contractors and give directions as appropriate; c. Arrange for competent and adequately resourced contractors to carry out the work where it is subcontracted;
d. Ensure the co-ordination and co-operation of contractors; e. Obtain from contractors the main findings of their risk assessments, the steps to be taken to control and manage the risks, including method statements for all aspects of the work; f. Ensure that contractors and workers have information about risks on site and that there are co-ordinated arrangements for workers to discuss health and safety and offer advice to the EPC Contractor;
g. Ensure that all workers are properly informed, consulted and trained on health and safety issues, and adequately protected against all prevalent diseases; h. Incident reporting scheme to include incident investigation and the publication of statistics including near misses, injuries by category with frequency rate and lost time accidents; and i. Ensure only authorized people are allowed onto the Site.
For the control of substances hazardous to health, no dangerous or noxious waste products, chemicals or materials shall be disposed of, on or off the Site, without the agreement of the appropriate authorities. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the disposal of all normal, hazardous or controlled waste in a manner strictly in accordance with current legislation and any consent given to the Owner or EPC Contractor by the relevant authority. The EPC Contractor shall ensure that scaffolding conforms to internationally acceptable standards of construction and safety.
5.5.
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the fire protection on Site. The method of complying with this requirement shall be detailed in the project health and safety plan. The EPC Contractor shall ensure adequate fire fighting equipment is appropriately positioned whilst carrying out work at the Site. This shall include the positioning of portable fire fighting equipment close by to where hot cutting or welding work is being carried out. The EPC Contractor shall ensure its supervisors, employees and subcontractors employees, who may be required to carry out or be involved with hot cutting or weld work, are trained in the use of fire fighting equipment. The EPC Contractor shall maintain and regularly service its fire fighting equipment in a condition satisfactory to the Owner and shall recharge its extinguishers after use regardless of how they were discharged. Provision for the maintenance and servicing of the EPC Contractors fire fighting equipment shall be included in the Site fire protection and fire fighting procedures of the health and safety plan.
PAGE 47
5.6.
The EPC Contractor shall be environmentally conscious and minimise where possible and economically acceptable the impact of the Works on the environment. As a minimum the EPC Contractor shall comply with the requirements of this Specification and all relevant environmental legislation and community expectations. The EPC Contractor shall prepare and implement the following plans: A Construction Environmental Management Plan (CEMP); A soil and water management plan (SWMP), including details of a dust management plan; An environmental noise management plan for construction and commissioning Specific requirements for some of the plans are included below: The Construction CEMP shall be subject to acceptance of the Owner and the environmental aspects of the construction work shall be managed in accordance with the plan. The principal items to be addressed in the plan shall include: Management roles EPC Contractors induction Emergency procedures Noise control Earthworks Dust control Groundwater management Erosion and sediment control Waste management and disposal (including spoil) Dangerous goods Heritage management Clearing Management of fuels, oils and chemicals, including bunding Management of contaminated and potentially contaminated material Traffic management Legislative compliance Compliance with approvals and licences. The EPC Contractor shall prepare and implement a SWMP. The SWMP shall describe the measures to be employed to minimise soil erosion and the discharge of sediment and other pollutants to lands and/or waters during construction activities. The environmental objective for the SWMP shall be to prevent any adverse environmental impact from the construction of the Works and shall include an accidental spill contingency plan. The SWMP shall be submitted to the Owner for agreement 30 days prior to the commencement of construction on Site. Work shall be undertaken in such a way as to prevent the release of dust from the site. The plan shall include an agreed localised dust monitoring program to be carried out by the EPC Contractor.
PAGE 48
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The EPC Contractor shall prepare and implement an Environmental Noise Management Plan (ENMP) that addresses all construction noise impacts. This plan shall identify: compliance standards; community consultations; complaints handling monitoring system; site contact person to follow up complaints; mitigation measures; the design/orientation of the proposed mitigation methods demonstrating best practice; construction times; monitoring methods and program; management strategies for construction activities that might produce high level intermittent noise such as pile driving or blasting; management strategies for any impulsive or tonal noise sources; a clearly described construction schedule for all construction works with the aim of achieving an environmental objective of no offensive noise being transmitted past the premises boundary. In addition, to cover the period of commissioning, the ENMP shall include contingency measures where noise complaints are received; monitoring methods and program including a noise audit to verify noise levels produced by the Plant. As regards traffic management, insofar as possible: The transport of construction materials shall be restricted to daylight hours and via major roads; The EPC Contractor shall provide a wheel wash facility to ensure the tracks of all vehicles leaving the Site are clean, if required Compliance with all of the above shall be subject to audit by the Owner.
5.7.
Construction certificates
The EPC Contractor shall obtain Construction Certificates from the Owner prior to work commencing on Site. No temporary buildings may be placed on the site and no site excavation, filling, removal of trees or other site preparation may be carried out prior to the issue of an appropriate Construction Certificate.
5.8.
During construction, the EPC Contractor shall keep the Site clean and tidy and remove and dispose off Site all waste material as it accumulates and as directed, to the satisfaction of the Owner. On completion of the work the Site shall be left clean and tidy and surface areas shall be restored to the satisfaction of the Owner. The burning of waste shall not be permitted. All costs for the disposal and transport of waste shall be to the EPC Contractors account. The EPC Contractor shall provide to the Owner details of where any wastes are to be disposed. The waste disposal facilities used by the EPC Contractor shall be suitably licensed to receive the type(s) of waste generated by the Site. The EPC Contractor shall on request provide copies of waste disposal operators licences and waste disposal chain of custody records to the Owner.
PAGE 49
6.
6.1. 6.1.1.
Mechanical Specification
Dual fuel engines General
Dual fuel engines, plant and equipment shall be provided to supply power to meet the Specifications. The dual fuel reciprocating engine generator sets shall have sufficient capacity to fulfil the specified requirements, taking into account all mechanical and electrical losses and power needed for station auxiliaries, running on full load conditions, and be suitable for the combustion of Natural Gas and Fuel Oil. The dual fuel engines shall conform to the relevant parts of ISO 8528 and ISO 3046. In the case of any conflicting requirements between the two standards, those of ISO 8528 shall take precedence. The engine fuel system shall be such that leakage from any part of the system cannot contaminate the engine lubricating oil. The engine mounted pilot fuel injector pipes shall be twin wall construction, complete with collection tank and leak detection instrument to provide an alarm signal.
6.1.2.
The dual fuel engines shall be of the turbo-charged, charge-air cooled four-stroke compression ignition and heavy-duty type. The total net continuous power of the generating sets as installed shall be measured at the Electrical Delivery Point. The Plant capacity must be clearly stated in the EPC Contractors preliminary technical details, taking into consideration: The pressure drop in the inlet air system with filter and inlet silencer; The overall resistance in the exhaust gas system, including ducting, silencer, and stack. The engines shall be from the manufacturer's existing range, of proven design and ample operating experience under similar ambient conditions and of a similar environment to that specified. Evidence shall be required to show that the engines offered are capable of performing the duty specified in a reliable manner and with a minimum of routine or periodic maintenance. Proven design and ample operating experience is defined as an engine which has been in base load generating service for a minimum of 3 years in two different utilities or companies in similar climatic conditions Each engine shall be continuously rated to give the stated generator output throughout the range of ambient conditions specified. Each engine shall be capable of stable operation from 10% load on Natural Gas and 20% load on Fuel Oil.
The engine shall be capable of producing 110 per cent of the continuous power rating when operating in liquid fuel mode. . This capability shall be demonstrated during the factory acceptance tests operating on diesel, but thereafter will be electronically blocked for 100% load during normal operation.
PAGE 50
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Plant is to be capable of high availability under both base and peak load operating conditions. Reliability will be of prime importance. The engines shall be capable of being started multiple times per day and be regulated from no load to full load. Start-up of the engines shall be possible locally and from the control room. Synchronization of each generator set shall be carried out in the control room. During this operation the set is brought up to nominal speed and nominal voltage first and if necessary, connected in parallel to the network. Subsequently, the load will be connected. The set shall operate satisfactorily over the full load range in Natural Gas mode or Fuel Oil mode operation. In case of loss of the Natural Gas supply, the engine shall automatically switch over to operation on Fuel Oil. The transition must be executed without any noticeable load, frequency or voltage drop, even during part load operation. A description of the changeover process shall be supplied, detailing the process and time taken to implement a complete switchover, The step load characteristic of the engines shall be provided for operation on Natural Gas and Fuel Oil. All galleries, stairways, handrails and guards to give access to all parts of the units shall be provided. The reciprocating dual fuel engines shall be designed for a life of 25 years and for an operation time as specified. Sufficient measures shall be taken to prevent or minimize corrosion of the exhaust valves. Exhaust valve rotating design is strongly preferred. The engine and connected apparatus shall be mechanically designed for an overspeed of 18 per cent. The engine speed under operating conditions shall be outside of the critical speed of the engine and connected apparatus. Attention shall be paid to a vibration-free assembly of the generator sets and the design shall be such that the transmission of vibration to other parts of the installation is minimised, (e.g. the surrounding building, installations erected in the vicinity). Vibration severity of the generating sets when in operation shall not exceed the limit values stated in ISO 8528-9. In order to minimize ring and liner wear fully oil cooled pistons shall be included. Fastening of the engine on the foundation shall be such that all parts can expand freely and alignment is maintained. Internal connecting pipes shall be provided with expansion bends, wherever necessary, so that considerable stress in and deformation of parts of the engine, due to reaction forces (such as temperature effects), are prevented. Expansion bellows shall be avoided as much as possible. The coupling between engine flywheel and generator, as well as the structure to which both machines will be assembled shall be designed such that the generator may be dismantled, assembled and aligned easily and rapidly without disturbing the alignment of the engine. Piping connections shall be welded as much as possible insofar as this will not hamper maintenance. Pumps, valves and other fittings, removable parts of heat exchangers and the like, shall be fastened by means of flanges.
PAGE 51
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Flanged connections shall not show any leaks, under any circumstances. Gasket materials shall be selected for fluids compatibility and optimum service life at the operating conditions. A crankcase oil mist detector shall be provided for each engine, to give early warning of hot spots within the engine crankcase. The unit shall be of proven design, arranged to sample each crankcase compartment. The unit shall give alarm and shutdown signals in the event of high oil mist concentrations. The power supply to the unit shall be such that dips on the electrical system do not give rise to inadvertent alarms/trips as a result of the light source dimming. A turbocharger washing system, utilizing demineralised water, shall be installed complete with all necessary tanks, pipework, valves and controls.
6.1.3.
Flywheel
The flywheel and flywheel coupling shall be designed to ensure that torsional vibration is damped to a minimum and in any case to less than the limits laid down in ISO 3046 or other agreed standard. The flywheel and all moving parts shall be suitably guarded.
6.1.4.
Crankcase
Crankcase explosion relief valves shall be fitted. They shall open automatically in the event of abnormal pressure rise inside the crankcase space, and shall comply with Lloyd's Register of Shipping Rules and Regulations. Large oil-tight doors shall provide access to both sides of the crankcase. All crankcase and other breathers shall operate under negative pressure and all oil mist shall be removed by coalescing separator and returned to the drain tank. Vents to atmosphere shall be via filters.
6.1.5.
Bearings
The main bearings on the engine and generator shall be split horizontally and so arranged that the bottom halves may be removed without appreciably raising the shaft. Any thrust bearing requiring periodic adjustment shall be so arranged as to facilitate such adjustment. Bearings should be provide with oil temperature monitoring and protection systems) In order to avoid damage to the main bearings due to induced currents, the bearings of the generator and associated oil pipes shall be insulated from the bedplate.
6.1.6.
Governing
The set shall be equipped with all necessary governing systems, protective devices, control and other instruments for reliable and efficient functioning under all operating conditions. The set shall be provided with all instruments and sensors required for local control. The engine shall be fitted with a governor capable of satisfying the limits laid down in ISO 8528, Performance Class G3 for steady state operation and G2 for transient operation. Speed excursions, within accepted limits, shall not operate the overspeed trip mechanism. Means shall be provided so that adjustment of speed, synchronizing and load control may be made by hand and managed only from the Control Room. The governor shall be equipped with a device to permit the engine speed to be adjusted over the range given in ISO 8528-2 at any load.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 52
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The governor shall be arranged to shut down the engine by cutting off all fuel to the fuel pumps automatically in the event of the operation of a mechanical or electrical shut down device. The system shall be able to control the speed and the power, in a stable way, between zero and maximum load, when operating parallel to other generators and in island operation. Dynamic stability of the entire governing system shall be ensured and shall be guaranteed by the EPC Contractor. The speed under zero load shall also be adequately adjustable by a device, operated by hand, for testing the overspeed protection. The speed droop shall automatically balance the load between the parallel operating engines. The function of the speed droop shall be continuous over the entire power range. Any required disproportionate load distribution must be possible. Variations in speed under constant load and during island operation shall be as low as possible. Behaviour of the engine during a sudden change in load shall be in accordance with class A2 governing system. In case of a loss of the load, the governing system shall prevent response of the overspeed protection trip. The governor shall be fitted with a motor operated speed gear. A Woodward governor is preferred.
6.1.7.
Overspeed protection
An overspeed protection device, independent of the governor control, shall be provided in accordance with ISO 3046-6, with shutdown latching and manual reset. The trip device shall act directly upon the fuel supply to the engine, and shall contain electrical contacts for the tripping of the generator and initiating of overspeed alarms in the control room. Both mechanical and electrical overspeed protection devices shall be provided.
6.1.8.
Turning gear
Electric motor driven barring gear shall be included and provision will be made to prevent starting of the engine with the barring gear engaged. A manual barring facility shall be incorporated into the barring gear. Means shall be provided to indicate the angular position of the crankshaft relative to each cylinder.
6.1.9.
A vibration damper shall be fitted to the free end of the crankshaft if found necessary.
6.1.10. Foundations
The engine foundations shall consist of a substantial concrete block of sufficient stiffness and strength to support the weight of the engine and the generator, and to withstand external moments and couples from the engine. The design of the engine foundations shall comply with the applicable Eurocode for foundations for reciprocating machines.
PAGE 53
6.2.
Cooling systems
It shall be possible to drain and de-aerate the cooling systems completely. De-aeration shall take place via a high-positioned expansion vessel. The radiators shall be constructed such that accumulation of dust is prevented as much as possible. The cooling air fan configuration shall be induced draft type, with low noise fans. It shall be possible to clean the air and watersides of the radiators easily and thoroughly. Cooling radiators shall be designed with sufficient margin to compensate for fouling, and engine heat rejection tolerances, in accordance with good industry practice. Additionally, each radiator module shall be designed with sufficient margin such that a single fan failure will not result in reduced generation capacity. Plastics are not allowed as material for the radiators for components such as cooling fins and fans. Radiators shall comply with the suppliers technical specification, but shall preferably be of the once through type with straight tubes which are easy accessible for cleaning. Materials used in the radiator construction shall withstand the operating environment and operating conditions specified. The design of the radiators shall be such as to facilitate ease of maintenance, and a lifting hoist shall be provided for removal and installation of the radiator fans.
PAGE 54
6.2.1.
The jacket cooling water shall be circulated through a jacket water cooler by an engine driven or electrically driven centrifugal pump. If electric motor driven pumps are utilized, two pumps shall be installed per engine, arranged for one duty and one standby. The standby pump shall automatically start on fall in system pressure. A thermostatic control valve and cooler by-pass arrangement shall be installed to maintain the desired constant engine outlet temperature throughout the range of operating loads. An electric heater to pre-heat the jacket water during shutdown periods shall be included in the system. A header tank with supporting steelwork shall be provided to allow for thermal volumetric changes in the engine cooling systems. The EPC Contractor shall supply a manual water make-up facility for the cooling system. . For manual operation, the operator will prepare the treated water and add to the water system. The treatment of the internal and external surfaces of the header tanks shall be to the Owners agreement. The outlet from each tank shall be connected to the respective cooling water system on the suction side of the circulating water pumps. A small bore air release pipe shall be taken from a suitable high point on each circulating water pipework system and led back to the head tank. Two 10m3 maintenance water storage tanks shall be provided to store engine cooling water during maintenance, complete with interconnecting pipework, pump and associated accessories.
6.2.2.
Lubricating oil shall be kept warm, if necessary, during engine shutdown periods to enable ready start up. The capacity of the engine sump shall be sufficient to enable the engine to run continuously for 24 hours at any load without replenishment. The engine sets shall be provided with a self-contained and independent pressurized lubrication system operated by a positive displacement pump and serving all the lubrication requirements of the engine and generator, including generator bearings, crankshaft and connecting rod bearings, shaft gears, camshafts, pistons, valve gear, fuel injection pumps and turbocharger. The oil shall be circulated from the sump via cooler and filters to the engine by an engine driven pump. A coarse filter shall be installed at the suction of each lubricating oil pump. Manual lubrication of any part of the engine will not be acceptable. The system shall incorporate automatic a water-cooled oil cooler and shall be complete with pipework, relief valves, valves and instrumentation. The automatic oil filter shall be placed close to the engine so as to minimize the length of pipe between the filter and the engine. Carbon steel piping shall be utilized between the oil filter and the engine, which will be pre-manufactured, tested and cleaned in accordance with the manufacturers quality assurance procedures. The automatic full flow duplex filters, which shall be provided with a manual changeover facility, shall be rated at 30 microns, or as required by the engine manufacturer. The design shall be such that the lubricating oil supply to the engine is not interrupted during any automatic change-over operation. It shall not be possible for both sides of the filter to be shut-off at the same time. Each filter shall be suitable for the discharge pressure of the pumps and shall be capable of dealing with the full lubricating oil flow requirements of the engine. The filter units shall be complete with connections for differential pressure gauges and shall be arranged so that the filter may be cleaned whilst the engine is running.
PAGE 55
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification A thermostatic control valve and oil cooler by pass arrangement shall be installed in the lubricating oil circuit to maintain the lubricating oil within the desired temperature range throughout the range of operating loads. The dual fuel generator sets must always be available for starting with the minimum of delay. If periodic flushing of the oil system is required to meet this condition then the flushing shall be automatically controlled, and the pump, pipework, controls, timers and associated equipment shall be provided under this contract. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for flushing the lube oil system prior to engine start-up, to the satisfaction of the engine manufacturer. Lubrication oil make up shall be from a lubricating oil storage tank. Lubricating oil meters shall be installed (a) in the oil unloading line and (b) in the common line from the engine filling pumps to the engines. The meters shall have local readout and also pulsed output connected to the DCS to give remote indication of metered quantities. Accuracy of the lube oil meters shall be 0.5% or better. The EPC Contractor shall recommend the type and grade of the lubricating oil to be used and identify those that are available in Oman. A portable lubricating oil centrifuge shall be provided for the Plant - common for all engines. The capacity of the centrifuge shall be capable of treating the contents of the engine sump four times in 24 hours. A lubricating oil storage tank of capacity of not less than the larger of one months storage or two engines worth of oil shall be installed in the tank farm complete with transfer pump. The pump shall be arranged to supply each engine sump. All lube oil delivery pipework shall be permanent. The storage shall be capable of being replenished from 200 litre oil drums and by road tanker. A drum unloading pump shall be installed at the road tanker unloading bay. A service tank, complete with transfer pump and interconnecting pipework, shall be provided for intermediate storage of lube oil during maintenance of the engine. A waste oil tank of capacity of not less than one months storage shall be installed in the tank farm, complete with mobile transfer pump. The mobile transfer pump shall be arranged to take suction from each engine sump and each lube oil sludge tank. A road tanker loading system shall be provided for sludge/oil waste disposal from the waste oil tank.
6.3.
The engines shall be started by compressed air. For this purpose two ac motor-driven air compressors, one duty and one stand-by, plus one diesel engine driven standby air compressor, shall be supplied. Each air compressor shall be capable of charging an air receiver from atmospheric pressure to full working pressure in a period not exceeding one hour, and from minimum starting pressure to full working pressure in a period not exceeding thirty minutes. The capacity of each air receiver shall be sufficient to enable six engine starts to be carried out without the need for recharging. The compressor shall be fitted with an unloading device operating at the design operating pressure for the air receiver. Each compressor and its driving unit shall be mounted on a common bedplate and shall be complete with all necessary equipment including intercooler and aftercooler, relief valves and discharge pressure gauges. Large capacity heavy duty air intake filters shall be provided for the main air compressors. It shall be possible to isolate any compressor for maintenance, with the adjacent compressor(s) running. Lockable manual isolating valves shall be provided for this purpose, downstream of the compressor
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 56
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification discharge non-return valves. The pipe section between the non-return and isolating valve shall have the means to be decompressed. The valves supplied shall be to the engine manufacturers standards. The air receiver shall be of the cylindrical type, designed constructed and tested to Class 1 in accordance with a recognised pressure vessel standards such as BS 5169, EN13445, PD 5500 and including the standards referred to in this specification. The air receivers shall be complete with the following connections and fittings:
air inlet from compressors air outlet to diesel engine drain safety/relief valve, directed to a safe area fusible plug, with discharge vented outside the Diesel Generator House automatic water drain trap with manual bypass line pressure gauge and isolation valve inspection cover. Nameplate.
After manufacture the external and internal surfaces shall be shot blasted to BS 4232 second quality. The external surfaces shall be primed with a 2 pack epoxy zinc phosphate primer to a thickness of 80 microns, followed by painting in the manufacturer's works with a 2 pack epoxy paint to a thickness of 40 microns, and a final coat at site to a thickness of 100 microns. Alternatively, the manufacturers corrosion protection system may be considered, subject to the approval of the Owner. The air starting system for the diesel generator set shall include all interconnecting pipework, valves and drain traps between compressor and receiver, receiver and engine. Two isolating valves shall be provided in the line to the engine, the valve nearest to the engine shall be lockable. An additional valve shall be provided, between this lockable isolation valve and the engine, to depressurize this part of the system. Drain traps shall be provided at all low points. The control system for the compressors shall be arranged so that the receiver is automatically maintained at the set pressure by the electric motor driven air compressor. The compressor stop pressure switch setting shall be such as to prevent excessive cycling of the compressor. A pressure reducing station, including drier and filters shall be installed to provide the correct pressure and quality of instrument air to each engine air system. The starting and instrument air systems shall be interconnected to provide control air supply in the event of a failure of the control/instrument air system. A percentage sample of the piping welds shall be subjected to radiographic examination, where relevant, and to the requirements of BS EN 13480-5.
6.4.
A separate system shall be provided to compress and deliver oil-free air of a quantity and quality suitable for all service, instrument and control purposes at all necessary points in the station. The system shall be entirely self-contained, arranged for predominantly automatic operation, complete with after and inter coolers, oil coolers, moisture separators, filters, dryers, silencers and air receivers. All appropriate pipework, valves, controls, gauges and other instruments shall be provided.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 57
6.5.
Combustion air shall be drawn from outside the building through desert condition air cleaners comprising of self-cleaning oil bath type filters with inertial pre-cleaner. Consideration shall be given to the fact that the Plant is located close to the sea. They shall be mounted above the ground and air cleaners shall be suitably sized for the combustion air flow requirements of the gas engine, with a suitable margin to allow for an increase in pressure drop during the service life of the filters. As a gas processing facility will be located in close proximity to the power plant the air intakes shall be fitted with flammable gas detectors which shall trip the Plant in the event of flammable gas detection. The EPC Contractor shall design the air filtration system to minimise the impact of any hydrocarbon release from the gas processing facility. The set point of the detectors shall be decided in conjunction with the Owner and owners of the gas processing facility but is expected to be in the order of 30% of the Lower Flammability Limit (LFL) for a gas cloud. Erection of inlet and exhaust pipes, noise silencers and filters shall be chosen such that maintenance of the engine is not hindered. Charge air ducting shall be suitably coated internally to prevent the ingress of pipe scale and weld debris into the engine. Wherever necessary, parts will be provided with provisions that will expedite dismantling and reassembly. Exhaust ducting shall be preferably installed with a constant upward slope to prevent accumulation of gases and to facilitate drainage of condensate. Drains and traps shall be installed at appropriate points to prevent run-back of condensate into the engine. Silencers shall be designed to prevent accumulation of trapped gas. Wherever necessary, corrosion resistant materials shall be applied. Gaseous emissions shall discharge to atmosphere through stack arrangements. The stack height shall be not less than 2 times the height of the largest building, or less than the minimum height as determined by an approved dispersion modelling program or EIA whichever is the greater. One flue gas stack shall be supplied for each engine, within a common steel structure which shall be designed to withstand all imposed loads, including wind and vibration loads. The common steel structure shall be fitted with access ladder(s) Suitable long life aircraft warning lighting shall be provided which meets all relevant authorities requirements. The lights and power supply shall be easily accessible for maintenance. The exhaust system shall include a system of explosion relief vents which is designed constructed and installed in accordance with NFPA 68 or equivalent international standard. The explosion relief vents shall be fitted with a device which will initiate engine shutdown upon detection of an explosion venting occurrence. Explosion products shall be vented to a safe area.
6.5.1.
A continuous emission monitoring system (CEMS) shall be provided, in accordance with the IFC 2008 Environmental Health and Safety Guidelines for Thermal Power Plants; [table 7, Natural Gas reciprocating engine technology, (Plant 50 to <300 MWth input)]. The emission monitoring system to be provided shall be extractive type using time-sharing principles to enable monitoring of multiple engines with a single analyzer. The system shall consist of sample probe for each engine stack, heated sampling lines, one sample selection and conditioning system and one NOx and O2 analyser for not more than four groups of engines, and a data acquisition and reporting system. The
PAGE 58
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification measurement of concentration of NOx and O2 in the flue gas shall be based on NDIR-infrared type analyzers for NOx, and electrochemical cell or paramagnetic for O2. The emissions shall be visualized in the plant operator interface and a separate reporting system to enables preparation of emissions reports (such as for example monthly reports). A cycling time of not less than 7.5 minutes per engine shall be provided. Suitable sampling ports with permanent means of access shall be provided to enable periodic testing to be undertaken.
6.5.2.
In order to comply with the Oman regulatory requirements and IFC guidance limits for emissions of pollutants to air, as outlined in section 3.8.2 of this specification, it may be necessary to provide a selective catalytic reduction (SCR) system as an option to reduce NOx emissions below the applicable limits. The SCR system should ideally use dry urea as the reagent although other reagents can be considered, depending upon availability The SCR equipment shall include the complete operating system, including the covered storage for dry materials, all materials handling requirements, mixing tanks (if required), forwarding and dosing pumps, reagent bulk tank sized for 14 days operation, catalyst, controls, instrumentation, air compressor plant (if required), interconnecting pipework and safety related equipment. The contractor shall include for a 90 days supply of all reagents in his offer, based on the continuous operation of all reciprocating engines at full load.
6.6. 6.6.1.
The EPC Contractor shall provide the complete fuel gas system, including installation of Gas Connection Facilities and Metering Facilities and complete installation on the Plant side of the Gas Delivery Point. Downstream of the Gas Connection Facilities and the Metering Instrumentation shall conform to the specifications as detailed in Appendix D. The system shall comply with the following requirements: The EPC Contractor shall ensure that the Natural Gas system downstream of the Gas Delivery Point: i) is of sufficient size and design to ensure GCPC is achievable at the minimum gas pressure at the Gas Delivery Point; and shall provide, downstream of the GCF within the Plant boundary, all the necessary facilities, including sufficient Natural Gas buffer to provide automatic and immediate on-load change-over from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil, to ensure GCPFC is achievable without interruption in the event of a Gas Operation Failure, trip of Gas Connection Facilities or the pressure of Natural Gas at the Gas Delivery Point falling below the minimum gas pressure specified in the documents.
ii)
The fuel gas system shall be provided complete with all necessary plant including but not limited to, the emergency shutdown system, equipment for the provision of Natural Gas pressure, conditioning and quality control, valves and pipework to provide fuel to the engines and any ancillary plant. The system shall be suitable for continuous unattended operation, and allow full operation in accordance with the design and operating philosophy of this Specification.
PAGE 59
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Gas detection systems shall be supplied within the engine rooms and the engine intake systems to provide a warning at low levels of detection and eventually trip the unit or the plant upon reaching a prescribed level. The EPC Contractor shall design and incorporate into the plant reasonable measures and equipment to prevent damage or loss in the event non-conforming Natural Gas is delivered. The flow measurement system must be designed, manufactured and installed in compliance with the standards outlined in Appendix D. At the terminal point on the site boundary adjacent to the MGP, the EPC Contractor shall provide for electrical insulation of its pipework and equipment from the pipeline upstream. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for liaising during the detailed design with the gas supply contractor, through the Owner, to ensure compatibility at the terminal point.
6.6.1.1.
Emergency shutdown
The EPC Contractor shall provide an emergency shutdown valve as close as possible to the fuel gas terminal point to isolate the fuel gas supply to the site in case of emergency. The valve shall be quick acting and hard-wired and be able to be activated from the Control Room. The operation of the valve shall not cause over or under pressure on the main gas pipeline upstream of the terminal point.
6.6.1.2.
Within the GCF, a dual stream (2 x 100% streams) gas pressure regulating station (GPRS) shall be provided to accept the incoming fuel gas and to condition it to make it suitable for combustion within the dual fuel engines. The GPRS shall include all necessary equipment including, but not limited to, safety shutdown valves, pressure regulating valves, purge vents and piping, filter separators, leak detection, and associated controls and instrumentation to ensure gas flow, pressure, temperature and quality is maintained across the full range of plant operating scenarios. Provision shall be made for future expansion of the system by way of leaving sufficient space and blank flanges etc. The gas conditioning equipment shall be located in a secure compound within the Site. The compound shall include a perimeter fence, sun-shade and locked access gate. The EPC Contractor shall provide separate housing for the Metering Facilities with an independent access from outside the plant battery limit. Each stream of the GPRS shall include duplex gas-liquid filter separators so that maintenance activities can be conducted without impacting on the supply of gas to the Plant, in accordance with the availability criteria as described herein. The EPC Contractor shall provide an appropriate electrically operated fuel gas heating system and/or thermal insulation, for proper operation of the gas engines, as required. All emergency shut down operations and normal monitoring shall be possible from the central control room. The GCF and Metering Facilities shall be designed in accordance with the standards below, which are listed in order of decreasing priority: a) b) The Specification for Metering Instrumentation as attached to this specification as Appendix D; Design Basis for Government Gas Pressure Reduction Terminals in the Oman STD 85904/35 Rev 0, January 1987, Addendum '99 PRT Improvement Review; and Oman Gas Company Design Basis Manual Rev A, June 2003; Petroleum Development Company Oman (PDO) specifications and Engineering Reference Documents;
PAGE 60
c)
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification d) e) f) Shell Design and Engineering Practices; national standards; and international standards.
The design of the GCF and the Metering Facilities shall meet the requirements of the NGSA and shall be based upon the following criteria: a) flow rate: The Natural Gas system downstream of the Gas Delivery Point shall be of sufficient size and design to ensure GCPC is achievable based on minimum Lower Heating Value of 845 BTU/scf at the minimum gas pressure at the Gas Delivery Point minimum flow rate: 1.75 million scf per day/1479 MMBTU per day receiving pressure: The GCF shall be capable of receiving Natural Gas at a maximum Delivery Pressure of 30 barg and a minimum Delivery Pressure of not less than 20 barg. The normal Plant operating range is expected to be between 23barg and 27barg. An alarm shall be activated at the Plant when the Delivery Pressure reaches 32 barg. The Plant shall be capable of operating safely at Delivery Pressures of up to 50 barg. In the event the generating units equipment require a higher gas pressure than the delivery pressure specified then the EPC Contractor shall ensure that all necessary compression equipment and control systems are provided. temperature: The EPC Contractor shall ensure the minimum delivery temperature shall at all times (under both static and transient operating conditions) be at least 10 deg C above the hydrocarbon dew point temperature
b) c)
d)
e)
The GCF and Metering Facilities shall consist of: a) b) c) d) e) f) g) an over pressurisation safeguarding system (an Instrumented Protective Function (IPF)); an inlet Emergency Shut Down system (ESD Valve(s)); filter separator(s); gas heating system (electrically heated as per MOG requirement); vent and drain system; metering units including gas chromatograph; and pressure reduction trains each with:
independent inlet Process Shut Down (PSD) valve providing high pressure trip; and two-stage pressure reduction valve(s) and associated monitor override controllers.
Instrument Natural Gas sourced from upstream of the Metering Facilities shall be used as the medium for instrument actuation. Process control shall be based upon a modern field bus technology. The design of the instrumentation and control system shall be based on a philosophy of unattended operation. Appropriate operational safety factors along with battery back-up and necessary fail safe actions shall be considered. All equipment installed shall be suitable for the Hazardous Area classification. The safeguarding system (SGS) shall be programmable logic control based and hard-wired, and the system interface shall be compatible with the control system on the field bus system chosen. The SGS shall be
PAGE 61
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification designed as per the requirements of IPF classifications and TUV certification shall be considered on an as required basis. The SGS shall be in accordance with PDO specifications and DEP 32.80.10.10 - Gen. The necessary smoke/fire detectors shall be selected in accordance with SP-1084 and DEP 32.30.20.11Gen and shall be interfaced with the SGS. The SGS shall have a separate file (DIN rack) for FGS. The FGS shall be an integral part of the SGS. No separate cabinet shall be provided for the FGS. All the major equipment and/or cabinets related to the GCF and Metering Facilities shall be installed in a suitable plant building. The GCF and Metering Facilities shall have an appropriate communication gateway/node for interfacing with SCADA infrastructure or the GCF pipeline monitoring system. The details of the interface shall be finalised during the project execution phase. The GCF shall be operated and maintained by the Owner. The Metering Facilities shall be operated by or on behalf of the supplier of the Natural Gas. All GCFs and Metering Facilities in the Government gas system are operated un-manned with occasional visits for valve maintenance, meter checking etc. Maintenance is carried out on an annual basis with relief valves being tested every two (2) years and vessels and heaters being inspected every five (5) to six (6) years. A dual power supply from two independent power sources, including any necessary step down transformers capable of delivering auxiliary power to the GCF and the Metering Facilities as per the GCF's and Metering Facilities design requirement shall be provided. Separate battery back-up for GCF and Metering Facilities shall be provided to ensure that essential instrumentation is maintained in an operable state for not less than eight (8) hours. Area lighting for the GCF and Metering Facilities shall be provided. Electrical distribution boards shall be installed in switch rooms for the GCF and separately for Metering Facilities. Control rooms will be dedicated to instrumentation only.
6.6.1.3.
The following interfaces will exist between the Metering Facilities and the Plant. Piping: Natural Gas will be supplied at the Gas Delivery Point, on the plant boundary, with a [-] inch 300 Pound Class raised face flange. Alarm to Plant: The following alarms/signals shall be sent to the Plant from the Metering Facilities: a) Common alarms. b) 24V DC system fault c) 240V AC UPS (uninterrupted power supply) system fault d) Smoke detection in control building e) Smoke detection system fault f) Flow computer watchdog failure alarm; and g) Telemetry shutdown override. h) Power supply voltage and current. i) FGS detected alarm. j) Flow computer watchdog failure alarm (for both flow computers). k) Gas flow rate hourly and daily. l) Gas supply pressure. m) Gas supply temperature. n) Gas LHV. The mode of communication between the Plant and the Metering Facilities shall be as follows:
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 62
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification a) All communication between the Plant and the Metering Facilities shall be through fiber optic cable (FOC) of minimum of 12 cores. If no power cable trench is available to be used to lay the FOC between the Plant and the Metering Facilities, a trench (not a duct) specifically for the purpose shall be provided by the EPC Contractor. All data transfer between the Plant and the Metering Facilities shall use a modern data communication protocol which can support time stamping information to be transmitted.
b)
Alarms/signals to the Metering Facilities: The following alarms/signals shall be sent to the Metering Facilities: a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h) trip of any Power Unit; total Plant trip; Gas Operation Failure; Non-Conforming Natural Gas; time of Natural Gas to Fuel Oil change over on Gas Operation Failure; time of Fuel Oil to Natural Gas changeover on Gas Operation Failure; Fuel Oil meter reading data; and hazardous gas at Plant boundary;
The following alarms will be made available by the Natural Gas supplier to the EPC Contractor as potential free contacts at the Metering Facilities: a) b) c) gas supply system shutdown; MGP fire and safety event; and conforming gas supply available.
Telecom/SCADA hot line system shall be provided. The hot line telephone system shall be of the point to point type. The EPC Contractor shall provide the system and handsets for the Metering Facilities and the control room. Hot line system beyond Metering Facilities shall be the responsibility of the Natural Gas supplier.
6.6.2.
Metering
The Metering Facilities shall be provided by the EPC Contractor and measure the quantity of Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point on a volumetric basis and calorific value basis. Only ultrasonic metering will be permitted. The Metering Facilities shall be accurate on a volumetric basis to within plus or minus one per cent (1.0%) and on a net calorific basis to within plus or minus one per cent (1%). The Metering Instrumentation is specified in Appendix D The Metering Facilities to be used for calculation of the delivered quantities of Natural Gas shall be installed by the EPC Contractor in such a way that no single failure of a component of the Metering Facilities shall result in loss or degradation of accounting data. To this extent, the Main (Pay) Metering Facilities which are primarily intended for accounting shall be labelled PAY and the Back-up (Check) Metering Facilities which are intended for checking is labelled CHECK. Upon detection of failure of the Main (Pay) Metering Facilities to produce data suited for accounting, an alarm condition shall be signalled and the Back-up (Check) Metering Facilities shall be taken online and be used for accounting. The Back-up (Check) Metering Facilities for that period of time shall have the same status as that of the Main (Pay) Metering Facilities, and shall not result in loss or degradation of account data.
PAGE 63
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Metering Facilities shall be time synchronised with the Master Clock of the plant which in turn shall be synchronised to the GPS. The metering data shall be transmitted with its time stamped at source.
6.6.2.1.
The standard test methods described below shall be used to determine the quality and quantity of Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point.
Description Sampling Hydrocarbons Total Sulphur Hydrogen Sulphide (H2S) Mercaptans Oxygen Mercury Water Content Lower Heating Value Ultrasonic meter volume Compressibility, Density Test Method ISO 10715 ISO 6974 ISO 4260 ISO 19739 ISO 19739 ISO 6974 ISO 6978 ISO 10101-3 ISO/DP 6976 AGA 9 AGA 8 1997 1984 1987 2004 2004 1984 1992 1993 1995 1998 1994
6.6.2.2.
The measurement and computation of the quantity and/or quality of Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall be carried out in accordance with the standards specified below: a) The volumetric flow shall be obtained by dividing the mass flow by the density of Natural Gas at the reference conditions. The mass flow shall be based on a flow meter for which the design and mass flow calculations are in accordance with AGA 9, ISO 5167/1, ISO 5168 and ISO 7066/1, or other system as agreed by the Owner based on a recognised international standard. The Natural Gas density under operating conditions used in the flow calculation shall be calculated in accordance with AGA 8 from the measured gas composition, pressure and temperature. The density at the reference conditions shall be calculated in accordance with AGA 8 and ISO 6976. The continuous measuring system of the Metering Facilities shall retain values of Natural Gas components concentrations in mol percentages. For the purpose of determining the molecular composition of Natural Gas, all hexane hydrocarbon components and hydrocarbon components heavier than hexane shall be included in the normal hexane fraction. The composition information shall be obtained from on-line Natural Gas chromatographic measurements installed in accordance with the ISO 6974 and calibration gases shall be prepared in accordance with ISO 6142. The continuous measurement system shall retain sufficient instantaneous, summed and averaged data to provide volume and energy reports on a daily and monthly basis. The format of such volume and energy reports shall be agreed to by the parties and shall be included in the specification of the Metering Facilities. The Lower Heating Value, Wobbe Index, Gas composition range in mol % density and relative density of the Natural Gas shall be calculated from the composition derived from the continuous measuring system of the Metering Facilities. The calculation of the quantities of energy delivered shall combine the continuous metering of volumetric flow at the Metering Facilities at the reference conditions and Lower Heating Value to give energy per unit time. The SI system of units shall be used.
b)
c)
d)
e)
PAGE 64
6.6.2.3.
A suitable venting system shall be provided to vent any gas during emergency or transient operations. The system shall be arranged to meet all local statutory and environmental regulations in relation to venting of gas and maintaining ground level concentrations below the lower explosive limit and odours to below discernible levels. The EPC Contractor shall provide for suitable connection points, vents and associated equipment to vent the complete fuel gas system with nitrogen in case of an extended outage or emergency. The vents shall discharge to a safe area outside of the building. The use of flame traps at the gas vent pipe terminations shall be considered in the design.
6.6.3. 6.6.3.1.
The EPC Contractor shall provide a liquid Fuel Oil system to deliver diesel oil to the engines at appropriate supply conditions and quantity. Fuel Oil will be transported to and stored on the Site in an area sufficient in size to accommodate the unloading, transfer, storage and feed of Fuel Oil for the Plant for use as pilot fuel and as an alternative fuel in the event of an interruption to the supply of Natural Gas. The Fuel Oil supply system shall be complete including truck unloading station and forwarding pumps, piping, valves, storage tanks and pumping station (including cleaning and treatment if required).The scope of supply for the Fuel Oil system shall include, but not be limited to, the following: a) The supply and installation of vertical, cylindrical and self-supporting distillate Fuel Oil storage tank(s), designed and constructed in accordance with API 650 or equivalent standard. The Fuel Oil storage tanks capacity shall be the greater of (i) sufficient Fuel Oil to operate the Power Unit Block for a continuous period of at least sixty (60) days on Natural Gas (i.e. based upon pilot fuel consumption) or (ii) sufficient Fuel Oil to operate the Plant for a continuous period of at least ten (10) days on Fuel Oil, at GCPFC and a replenishment rate sufficient to operate the Plant in accordance with dispatch instructions up to GCPFC.. Containment bund Delivery vehicle unloading facilities, comprising sufficient bays to unload one days fuel consumption at GCPFC within 24 hours and, in any case, not less than 4 unloading bays. The unloading facilities shall include provisions for the treatment and removal of any fuel spillage at the facilities. Supply and installation of Fuel Oil day tanks Quick sampling (representative) and testing facilities to demonstrate that the quality of the diesel oil meets the requirements of the engines. A Fuel Oil treatment plant consisting of one fuel centrifuge unit One duplex type strainer for diesel oil forwarding. Two 100 per cent capacity, positive displacement type, diesel oil forwarding pumps. Two unloading pumps One pressure regulating valve. One flow meter for the measurement of fuel deliveries to Site. Flow measurement devices for measuring the diesel oil supply to each engine.
b) c)
d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) l)
m) Fuel stop valves. n) Level transmitters fitted to the diesel oil storage tank, and day tanks
PAGE 65
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification In addition, the EPC Contractor shall provide all pipework, valves, air separators, filters, drains, drip pans, vents, fittings, and equipment needed to convey oil from the unloading point to the engines. There shall be two 100 per cent capacity filters in the supply to each engine. Fugitive emissions of the VOCs resulting out of fuel storage facilities and leaks (from flanges, valves, pumps and otherwise) related to fuel flow line shall be decreased by using Leak Detection & Repair Techniques. In addition, the process of monitoring VOCs shall be made by using a mobile monitoring instrument
6.6.3.2.
The tank(s) shall be installed in an impermeable containment bund sized to contain as a minimum 110 per cent of the tank maximum capacity. Additional freeboard allowances for surges due to sudden failure, rainwater containment, and fire fighting foam shall be considered in the containment capacity of the bund. The tank(s) shall be designed to API 650 and shall be complete with stairs, handrails, internal and external coatings, instrumentation, vents, manholes, drains, filling and extraction pipework, and any other equipment necessary for the safe operation of the Fuel Oil system. The EPC Contractor shall as a minimum: a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) Fit activated carbon filters for the removal of volatiles from the tank vents Fit fire valves on the tank outlets (capable of being operated via the plant control system) Install tank level instrumentation, including level transmitter. Install high level switches and an alarm system with display local to the tanker unloading point and on the plant control system. Install tank overflows with flap valves to prevent the overflow acting as a vent. Install a pump, pipework and power supply system to remove fluid from the bund area. Provide a complete unloading system comprising delivery vehicle unloading area (drained via an oil interceptor), valved and capped unloading pipework and earthing straps. Install a velocity diffuser in the tank on the incoming fuel line. Install two access ladders into the bunded area to provide alternative means of escape. Install access from the bunded area to the top of the Fuel Oil tank. Install storm water drainage system to be routed through the oily waste water system. The bund shall be drained via a manually operated valve or an automatic system incorporating an oil stop valve. Procedures for the regular discharge of impounded storm water during and after periods of rainfall shall be included in Operations and Maintenance Manual.
The tank floor shall be cone down and the tank shall be equipped with at least the following: Suitable water draw-off points with water/oil separation and drainage to interceptor Ports for the injection of additives Facilities to circulate the fuel in the tank to mix additives Any other facilities recommended to prevent the deterioration of the stored fuel. Radar gauging for level indication and control, linked to the DCS and pump control systems Manual dipping facilities. In addition to the main site Fuel Oil storage tanks the facility shall incorporate one day tank per Power Block which together meet the Fuel Oil requirements of the Plant for 8 hours. The day tanks shall supply the individual needs of the power units and shall be installed in bunded areas and be designed to recognised international standards.
PAGE 66
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Fuel Oil flow meters connected to the Plant control system shall be provided on the individual supply lines to each Power unit and the individual Fuel Oil return lines from the individual Power units to calculate the actual Fuel Oil consumed by the Power Unit. An adequate number of Fuel Oil transfer pumps with adequate standby transfer pumps shall be installed to transfer Fuel Oil from the Fuel Oil storage tanks to the Fuel Oil day tanks. The transfer pumps shall fill the day tanks automatically.
6.6.3.3.
Tanker unloading of Fuel Oil shall be undertaken within the Site boundary. The Fuel Oil unloading facilities shall be designed to allow at least four (4) articulated road tankers to be unloaded in parallel. Necessary traffic management systems shall be provided for tanker unloading. Fuel receiving / load-out capacity shall be based on road tanker deliveries by tankers carrying up to 40,000L. Each receiving point shall have a truck and trailer grounding facility. A common flow meter which reads cumulative and instantaneous fuel flows shall be provided. A permanent piping and pumping system shall be provided that allows fuel to be transferred from the storage tank back to a road tanker. A flow meter which reads cumulative and instantaneous fuel flows shall be provided. A bunded area shall be provided in the receiving/load-out area to contain any oil spillage during the receiving / load-out process. Any spillage shall be diverted to an interceptor. The tanker unloading/loading arms shall be self supporting. Hoses are not acceptable.
6.6.3.4.
As the diesel oil may be stored on Site for prolonged periods without use, a small treatment plant shall be provided to circulate and treat the fuel. The diesel oil treatment plant shall be constructed as a module, complete with electric heater (if required), valves and pumps, etc, and shall be tested thoroughly before shipment. The centrifuge shall be of the latest design of Alfa-Laval or Westfalia, or equivalent proven manufacture, operating as a clarifier without the use of gravity discs. The centrifuge shall take suction from the fuel tank and discharge treated fuel back to the same tank.
6.6.3.5.
Each diesel oil forwarding pump shall be capable of delivering the specified Fuel Oil at an appropriate pressure and quantity for the engines. The EPC Contractor shall take into consideration all pressure drops in the system caused by elevation differentials, friction in the pipeline, filters, heaters, meters and strainers and as required across all control valves. The forwarding pump shall have a low NPSH (Net Positive Suction Head) capability so that the pump is capable of emptying the tank contents down to the intake level of the suction pipe. Each pump shall be protected by a relief valve set such that the maximum design pressure of the piping system is not exceeded, and sized such that the flow requirements of the pump are met at all times. The discharge of the relief valve shall be returned to the suction side of each pump. The EPC Contractor shall submit performance curves and supporting calculations to substantiate the pump selection with his detail design.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 67
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Fuel Oil forwarding pumps shall be located adjacent to the Fuel Oil storage tank. The EPC Contractor shall provide suitable trays or containment for the collection of any seepage emanating from the pumps. Pipeline strainers shall be provided. The strainers shall be duplex type, and designed to provide for uninterrupted flow of oil during manual cleaning of one of the strainers. Baskets shall be of stainless steel. All strainers shall have pressure ratings appropriate for the service intended, but in no case, less than 1.5 times the maximum service pressure. Each strainer shall be provided with local differential pressure indication and a transmitter for remote indication. Vents and drains shall be provided at strainers and all high points and low points, respectively. Vents and drains shall each be equipped with a ball valve. In addition, connections required for periodic tests shall be equipped with valves and threaded nipples which shall be protected by threaded caps. All isolating valves in the Fuel Oil systems shall be of the non-lubricated full bore ball type with Teflon seals and resilient faces where applicable. Threaded valves shall only be used where required for equipment compatibility. Cast iron valves shall not be used for oil service. All piping and equipment shall be protected against excess pressure utilizing pressure relief valves. Over pressurization of blocked and full lines and equipment by solar heating and ambient temperature changes shall be considered in the design. Relief valve discharge shall be piped to the return header or pump suction as required.
6.7.
Water system
The EPC Contractor shall make provide onsite water production facilities sufficient for all requirements of the Plant. Demineralised water used on Site shall be produced as required by the EPC Contractor. For demineralisation plant, full regeneration and waste water neutralisation facilities shall be supplied. Economy in the use of chemicals and waste water for disposal shall be an important consideration. Facilities shall be provided for the treatment and disposal of all wastes arising from the processes.
6.7.1.
Water source
The only source of raw water for the plant will be seawater. Due to the issues with abstracting water directly from the sea, a Beach Well Assessment Study was commissioned by the Owner to investigate abstracting water from site wells. The reports conclusions were: The main aquifer system in the study area is alluvium and limestone formation; The water table may strike within 6-8 m bgl (assuming that ground level is fractionally higher than high sea level) in this aquifer system; The yield of the aquifer system is ranged between 32 to 79m3/h. However further confirmation is required with well specific pump test. The geological settings and hydrogeological formations indicate that the study area can easily cater to 3 the MPC water requirement of approximately 100m /h. The EPC Contractor is to provide test wells on the site to confirm well yield and to optimise the location of the supply wells. The beach wells shall be supplied with sufficient redundancy to accommodate a well out of service and to avoid continuous drawdown from a single well to maintain the static water level. The wells shall be spaced to avoid drawdown between the wells.
PAGE 68
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The wells should be constructed perpendicular to the flow line from the sea to minimize the mutual interference. Considering the high salinity of the water and shallow depth of the wells, uPVC casings should be used for the well assembly.
6.7.2.
A combined raw water and firewater storage tank shall be provided to supply buffer storage capacity in the event of a temporary loss of well/river water supply. The total working capacity of the tank shall be based on: The nominal water requirements of the plant, plus The maximum anticipated flow rate for the largest single risk associated with the Plant plus two hydrant points, for a period of two hours. The off take for general station use shall be above the level dedicated to storage for fire fighting. The tank shall be located adjacent to the fire water pump house. The tank shall be complete with all necessary connections for make-up, pump suction, vortex inhibitor, pump testing and maintenance access, together with level indicator, low level alarm, access ladder, handrailing and a dosing system to inhibit microbial growth.
6.7.3.
Potable water
The Plant is to provide the total potable water requirements, with adequate margins, for all personnel within the Plant, under all conditions of operation. Details of the Plant's design throughput sizing and potable water storage facilities shall be provided to demonstrate the adequacy of the Plant provision. The storage facilities shall, if required, be fitted with access ladders, platforms, vents and access ports. Level and contents gauges shall be located for operational convenience. The provision shall include equipment for disinfection and for the adjustment of pH and hardness, as required, such that the supply conforms to WHO guidelines. Adequate monitoring and control instrumentation shall be installed to allow automatic operation of the plant and permit continuous measurement of the conductivity of the final product water. Alarms advising poor water quality and system malfunctions shall be provided to the DCS operator interface in the Control Room. Normal operation is from the local control panel. Alarms and indications shall be displayed locally with essential alarms and indications conveyed to the Control Room.
6.7.4.
A water treatment plant (WTP) shall be provided to meet all the plants process water make-up requirements. The WTP shall be fully automatic and shall provide demineralised water supplies to the plant under all operating conditions. The WTP shall be capable of local operation within the WTP building with alarm and malfunction signals sent to the Control Room. Sea water shall be pumped from the sea water pump bay to the water pre-treatment plant and 2 x 100% pumping redundancy shall be provided. The plant shall consist of but not be limited to: Filtration stage using multi -media filters to remove the bulk of the suspended solids Filtered sea water storage tank to hold the filtered water required for backwashing the multimedia filters Dosing of the filtered water using acid, sodium hypochlorite, phosphate and/or scale inhibitor
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 69
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Cartridge filters (typically 5micron) to remove remaining suspended solids Dechlorination of feed water using sodium sulphite or bisulphite RO high pressure feed pump Membrane pressure vessels - may be two or three stages of RO membranes Degassing tower to remove carbon dioxide Mixed bed ion exchange units to remove the remaining dissolved solids The capacity of the filtered seawater tank shall be sized to allow the design output from the demineralisation plant for 12 hours with the pre-treatment plant out of service when operating at maximum output. Duplex cartridge filters ~5 micron filtration shall be installed and incorporate differential back pressure measurement equipment. The differential pressure equipment shall be linked to the control system in order to produce alarms when the differential pressure of an individual filter cartridge is high. The reverse osmosis module shall produce a permeate of suitable quality for feeding to the mixed bed units. The design shall include sufficient margin to allow safe reliable operation of the unit at the design conditions and for the specified expected water variation. The design conditions shall include a fouling allowance to ensure that design capacity is maintained, whilst operating the recommended membrane replacement programme. The reverse osmosis module shall contain rack mounted RO units with factory assembled pressure vessels. These shall include feed, product and reject piping and valves and also instrumentation. . The membranes shall include all protective measures required for their operation. Spare membranes equivalent to ten per cent of the installed membranes shall be supplied as part of the contract. A membrane store of appropriate capacity and storage conditions shall be provided. Membrane elements shall have an anticipated life in excess of five years. Rejected brine from the RO plant shall be directed to CW outlet sump. An automatically controlled dosing skid shall be included (sodium bisulphite, antiscalant, sulphuric acid or sodium hydroxide). A standby dosing pump will be included in the package and in the event of a pump failure the control system shall automatically switch to the standby pump. Out of specification conditions shall cause the permeate product water to be automatically redirected to the filtered sea water tank. The permeate product generated by the RO plant will be stored in the service water tank. All effluents from the WTP shall be treated and/or neutralised separately before being collected for disposal via the reject water pipeline. An iron removal unit shall be supplied integral to the WTP. Supply to the WTP shall be raw water. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for acquiring any necessary water samples and historical data to ensure the suitability of the water treatment plant proposed. Suitable sampling points in easily accessible positions shall be provided to monitor WTP performance. Chemical storage for bulk liquid chemicals shall be in bunded storage tanks. Solid chemicals shall be stored on pallets in a secured area. Delivery of bulk liquid chemicals shall be by road tanker, and provision for tanker delivery shall be provided. . All necessary personnel protection and safety systems, including safety showers and eye-wash stations, shall be supplied where appropriate.
PAGE 70
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The EPC Contractor shall supply a water test kit to analyse critical engine water parameters such as chloride and nitrite content and hardness.
6.7.5.
A demineralised water storage tank shall be provided with a capacity of not less than 8 days consumption of the Plant facility at maximum rate of use. A complete demineralised water distribution system shall be provided to automatically make up all systems using demineralised water.
6.8. 6.8.1.
The EPC Contractor shall provide an emergency and black start facility that is capable of starting a power unit within half an hour of instruction. Two 100% suitably rated black start/emergency diesel generating sets complete with all accessories shall be provided under the terms of this Contract. The EPC Contractor shall install two packaged high-speed diesel generator sets, connected to the LV system, each of capacity sufficient to power essential supplies both unique and common to allow starting of any one of the main engines. The generators shall each be sized to accommodate (a) supplying the station auxiliaries on loss of mains supply and (b) the black starting of a single engine / generator unit and its supporting auxiliaries.
6.8.2.
Fuel
The engine supplied shall be suitable for operating on Fuel Oil. A complete Fuel Oil system including valves, piping and daily storage tanks shall be provided to serve the Plant. The daily service tank shall be free standing and be large enough to supply the generator sets with fuel for a continuous running period of 24 hours. Replenishment of the daily service tank shall be provided from the main diesel storage tank. The engine fuel suction supply shall be fitted with a coalescing type filter separator which is capable of solids and water removal in accordance with the engine manufacturers specifications.
6.8.3.
Diesel engine
The diesel engine shall comply with ISO3046, ISO 8528 and IEC 60034-22. The engine shall be water cooled, cold starting type, fitted with renewable cylinder liners. An air cleaner, with replaceable element, shall be provided for the diesel generator unit to ensure air for the engine is adequately cleaned. An engine cooling system shall be supplied and shall operate in conjunction with a generously sized radiator. A high water temperature alarm, and low water level detection equipment complete with relays shall be fitted to the generator unit, and the engine shall be arranged to automatically shut down should the water temperature reach a dangerous level or cooling water level be unsatisfactory. A suitable silencer and associated fixed pipework including a weather hood where necessary shall be provided and installed under this Contract. All exhaust piping within the building or enclosure shall be provided with slab insulating material covered with an agreed finish to minimize the heat losses from the piping to the diesel generator enclosure.
PAGE 71
6.8.4.
Engine governing
It is anticipated that the load will be stepped onto the diesel generator. A delay of a few seconds shall be allowed between applications of load. On return of the mains supply it is anticipated that the load shall be removed from the diesel generator at a similar rate. The governing equipment supplied shall comply with ISO 3046. All electric motors shall be direct on line started.
6.8.5.
The diesel generator unit supplied shall have an air cooled radiator and engine driven fans arranged to discharge cooling air from within the diesel generator enclosure to the outside of the building. The diesel generator unit shall be complete with a suitable sheet metal duct to connect the radiator outlet to the cooling air discharge louvre which shall be supplied and fixed to the wall of the building. The EPC Contractor shall provide anti draught flap louvres at each discharge connection to prevent the ingress of wind. The diesel generator room air intake louvre shall open automatically on diesel generator start-up and shall close on shut down.
6.8.6.
Starting equipment
Suitable starting equipment shall be supplied. The equipment shall be of the battery starting type, complete with mains and engine driven recharging facilities, or compressed air. The charging equipment shall be automatic in operation and maintain the level of charge at a suitable value in each battery. Batteries shall be accommodated in specially constructed stands mounted local to the diesel generator units off the diesel generator house floor.
6.8.7.
The station switchboard shall be provided with an electrical detection and control system to allow the board to be fed separately either from the station auxiliary transformer or the standby diesel generating plant. The changeover operation shall be automatic following a failure of the station auxiliary transformer supply, permitting an automatic starting of the black start / emergency diesel generator. Switching of the system back to main supply upon restoration of the grid shall take place automatically. The supply to the diesel generator auxiliary plant shall be taken through a mains/generator changeover switch, the purpose of which is to feed the auxiliary equipment from the mains during those periods when the diesel generating plant is not operating. On failure of the mains supply the generator auxiliary plant shall be supplied from the generator itself. The black / emergency diesel generator shall automatically start when instructed by the operator to enable the back starting of a selected main unit and the relevant auxiliaries. The station auxiliaries will be automatically configured to enable black starting. The generator will be equipped with all necessary facilities to enable periodic full loading testing of the diesel generator unit. The diesel generator set shall be suppressed to prevent interference with communications equipment.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 72
6.8.8.
Generator
The diesel generating set shall be complete with a direct driven generator together with automatic voltage control equipment (AVR). The AVR shall be of a well established design, selected in conjunction with the other features of the diesel generating set offered, to ensure trouble free operation. Three phase sensing of the AVR shall be used to minimize the effect of the waveform distortion caused by load. The generator shall be fitted with a fully linked damper winding to keep the sub-transient reactance to a minimum. The generator frame shall preferably be of fabricated construction and incorporate an exciter. The generators shall be air cooled; insulation shall be to at least Class F with temperature rise to the next lowest class of insulation (class B). A proprietary flexible coupling shall connect the generator rotor to the diesel engine flywheel. Generator rotor shaft shall be machined all over to accept the cooling fan and the rotating field assemblies for the generator and exciter, all of which shall be readily detachable for maintenance purposes. The whole rotor assembly shall be statically balanced on completion.
6.8.9.
The generating unit shall be provided with protection equipment which shall protect the alternator/generator set from damage due to fault conditions. All relays or similar equipment including overspeed, oil pressure, cooling water level and high cooling water temperature, air cleaner differential pressure, lube oil filter differential pressure, directly associated with the prime mover shall be mounted on the generating set engine and associated with a suitable trip relay. Protection equipment shall be provided and arranged to trip the associated circuit breaker, suppress the excitation and shut down the prime mover if faults should occur.
6.9.
The EPC Contractor shall provide all necessary mechanical building services to ensure a satisfactory working environment for all personnel within the plant, and to provide a suitable environment for the performance of plant and equipment. Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) shall be provided in all areas where necessary for the correct functioning of equipment and for any normally manned rooms. All electrical and DCS equipment rooms shall be air-conditioned with at least dual 100% capacity systems. Air conditioning shall be provided to
PAGE 73
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification C&I workshops, all offices, the administration area, control rooms, meeting rooms, and kitchen/lunchroom area with at least 2 x 50% capacity systems. Air conditioning shall also be provided in the guard house, electrical stores, laboratory and warehouse areas. The HVAC system shall be designed in accordance with all relevant codes and standards. The EPC Contractor shall consider the health and welfare of all personnel and the requirements of the relevant equipment across all plant loading conditions and the full range of external ambient conditions. The design of the HVAC system shall also consider the requirement to provide air pressurisation for smoke control, adequate ventilation of hazardous gases and fumes and to control the spread of hot gases and smoke. The EPC Contractor shall identify in its proposal, for each area of the Works, the type of HVAC system, rate of ventilation and temperature conditions proposed. Where appropriate, the EPC Contractor shall provide humidity control in areas housing sensitive electrical or electronic equipment. In areas where smoke may accumulate, such as at the top of the engine building, the EPC Contractor shall provide high-level smoke ventilators, in accordance with or in addition to the requirements of the relevant standards. All HVAC equipment shall be fitted with detection equipment for hydrocarbons and hazardous gasses, which shall cause the HVAC plant to shutdown if high levels of the gasses are detected within the air intake systems. A smoke extractor system shall be provided in the welding workshop area. The HVAC system associated with critical plant areas shall be fed from the essential power supply.
6.10.
The Plant shall be designed and laid out to facilitate routine maintenance on all items of equipment. Facilities and equipment such as cranes, lifting beams and monorails shall be provided to ensure equipment can be dismantled and transported safely and expediently for maintenance and repair. The EPC Contractor shall demonstrate the maintenance procedures for major items of plant, including lifting, transportation and lay-down methods.
6.10.1. Cranes
An overhead travelling crane shall be provided in order to lift and transfer major items of plant within the power house building. The crane shall be designed to lift the heaviest component required to be lifted during maintenance, including for major maintenance and overhaul activities on the engines and generators. It shall have an auxiliary hoist. The EPC Contractor shall give consideration to the requirement to lift and remove all pumps, compressors, motors, major valves and other associated equipment, which may require removal for maintenance and shall design and install suitable means for doing so. An overhead travelling crane of 2 tonne capacity shall be provided in the workshop and stores building. All overhead travelling cranes shall comply with the requirements of a recognised international standard, and, shall be tested and certified prior to being put into service. Crane supporting steelwork shall be designed in accordance with the relevant Eurocode or equivalent standard.
PAGE 74
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification All cranes shall be controlled remotely and via a pendant push button unit suspended from a trolley or equivalent. Each crane's hoist and controller shall have two speeds. The trolleys shall have three speeds: creep, slow, and medium. Speeds shall be in each direction. All crane motors shall have reverse phase protection, jogging and plugging controls for precision work and soft start/soft stop capability. All chains, slings, shackles, and associated lifting accessories shall be tested and certified prior to being put into service.
6.11.
Spare Parts
The EPC Contractor shall submit the Recommended Spare Parts List and Consumables List for purchase by the Owner under the Contract and pursuant to Clause 11 of the Contract. The scope of the spare parts shall cover all equipment not covered under the LTSA and balance of plant items and assemblies, excluding the plant covered under the LTSA. The EPC Contractor shall provide an estimate of yearly consumption of the routine maintenance spare parts. The Owner may select from the list the scope of spares to be purchased under this Contract pursuant to Clause 11 of the Contract. The EPC Contractor shall supply consumable spare parts for 2 years operation, based on prudent operation and maintenance of Plant. The list of the consumable spares and the unit price shall be provided. Appendix E Plant System Categories for Spare Parts provides a list of the plant system categories to be covered.
6.12.
The fire protection facilities shall be designed, installed and tested in accordance with NFPA requirements and recommendations. In particular, the requirements of NFPA 850 shall apply to the design of the Plant. The fire system shall also comply in all respects with the requirements of all local requirements and standards including the requirements of the Royal Omani Police (ROP), including the use of ROP approved design and supervision consultants for fire detection and protection systems. The EPC Contractor shall conduct a risk assessment study and fire protection design report for the Plant. This report shall detail the design criteria and calculations for the proposed fire protection system. Reference to the relevant clauses of the applicable codes and standards shall be provided for each design parameter. The fire protection design report shall include for the classification of all hazardous areas.
PAGE 75
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification buildings shall be protected by automatic wet pipe sprinkler systems. Offices canteen and corridors shall be provided with hose reels and extinguishers as part of the overall fire protection system.
6.13.
PAGE 76
6.13.3. Balancing
All rotating parts of pumps, fans, motors and drives shall be statically and dynamically balanced.
6.13.5. Painting
The preparation of surfaces and painting shall be suitable for the operating environment specified. After all machining, forming and welding has been completed, all steelwork surfaces to be painted shall be thoroughly prepared and cleaned prior to any painting, in accordance with the EPC Contractors approved procedure The colours of the primer, intermediate and finishing coats of paint shall be easily distinguishable from each other. The final colours and identification systems for the equipment and pipework shall be generally in accordance with accepted industry practice and agreed with the Owner.
6.13.8. Valves
All valves shall be of an agreed design to international standards and manufacture and those of a similar make, size and type shall be interchangeable with another where practicable. Valves may be supplied to the EPC Contractors standard or other international standards.
PAGE 77
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The EPC Contractor shall provide new, good quality and non-leaking valves and check-valves. Leak tests of valves shall be undertaken by the EPC Contractor and its sub-contractors. Test results shall be made available to the Owner. All isolating valves shall be capable of being locked in both the open and closed positions for the purposes of plant isolation. All valves shall be fitted with position indicators so that it may be readily established whether they are open or closed. Valves equipped with hand-wheels shall be arranged so that rotating the hand-wheel in a clockwise direction shall close the valve. Hand-wheels shall be marked with the words open and shut with the relevant arrow to indicate the direction of rotation. Valves shall not be installed in an inverted position unless agreed. All valves required for the regular operation and maintenance of the plant shall be readily accessible from permanent platforms. Suitable lifting points shall be provided on heavy valves or valve components to facilitate lifting for maintenance. All parts, particularly seats and discs, which are subject to wear, corrosion or other deterioration which require adjustment, inspection or repair, shall be accessible and capable of reasonably convenient removal when required. All valve internals, with the exception of certain butterfly and small bore valves, shall be capable of being removed with the valve body in position. Valves subject to wear, corrosion or other deterioration shall have Stellite or agreed equivalent seats and trim. High pressure isolating valves shall be arranged in tandem. Two valves in series shall also be provided for drains, vents and sample lines. All test points and pressure gauge connections shall be provided with double isolating valves. All isolating valves shall be capable of being operated from floor level. Where valves are located in pits or enclosures deemed to be confined spaces, extended operating spindles or similar devices shall be provided.
6.13.10. Pipework
All pipe systems shall be inspected and hydrostatically tested in accordance with the requirements of the EPC Contractors applicable design and construction procedures. The design and installation of pipe
PAGE 78
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification systems shall such that the pipes are adequately supported and have sufficient means of venting and draining. Pipe system layout shall be arranged such that equipment and sections of pipework can be removed without major disturbance to adjacent pipework. Pipe ends during transport and construction shall be protected from external damage and sealed against ingress of dirt. The cutting of floor or roof beams or reinforcement of concrete for the fixing of pipe supports shall not be permitted.
6.13.11. Locks
All isolating equipment including valves, switchgear, cubicles and hand switches as appropriate shall be suitable for being padlocked.
PAGE 79
7.
Electrical Specification
7.1. General
The transmission system voltage for the project is 132 kV. The EPC Contractor may choose all other voltage levels within the Plant from the levels recommended in IEC 60038 subject to any local requirements of the Owner. The normal voltage ranges shall be 10 per cent. In accordance with section 2.1, two options shall be offered. In Option A, the Plant shall be provided with not less than a four (4) step-up transformers to connect to the Tibat grid sub-station. The maximum number of step-up transformers that can connect from the Plant to the Tibat grid sub-station shall not exceed six (6) due to space restrictions. Power Unit Blocks shall be connected through a suitable medium voltage switchboard to a step-up transformer. Power Unit Blocks connected to a step-up transformer shall be of identical capacity. For Option B, the configuration shall provide for the required number of generators to be banked at Gen kV and connected to Tibat grid sub-station using four step-up transformers rated to support full output of the plant with one step-up transformer out of service. In the 132 kV Tibat grid substation, the 132 kV incoming transformer bays will be provided and operated by the Licensed Transmission System Operator. Only emergency manual tripping and protection tripping from the Plant control room, with proper interlocks will be allowed. The plants own generator circuit breakers shall be used for the purposes of generator synchronisation. The plant shall not use the generator step-up 132 kV circuit breakers of the Licensed Transmission System Operator for synchronisation. The Licensed Transmission System Operator will provide facilities to synchronise across its 132 kV outgoing feeder circuit breakers. The auxiliary power for the facility for power generation shall be derived from the Plants internal electrical system. The auxiliary power for the facility for power generation shall be derived from the Plants internal electrical system. Equipment connected to the 132 kV system shall have an impulse voltage level and a prospective fault withstand as required by the Owner. The impulse voltage levels for equipment connected at other voltages shall be in line with the requirements of IEC 60071. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for ensuring that all electrical equipment in the Plant shall have a fault capability adequate for the system to which it is connected. All plant and equipment shall be designed to ensure satisfactory operation under such sudden variations of load and voltage as may be met under working conditions, including those due to starting loads, transient short circuit, internal and external fault conditions The design and installation shall be carried out so as to minimize the risk of outbreak of fire and consequential damage. Where possible materials used shall not support combustion. The EPC Contractor shall designate a hazardous area classification to each area where gas may be present under normal or abnormal operating conditions. Where electrical equipment is located within a designated hazardous area it shall have a degree of protection appropriate to the area classification. Capability curves for the dual fuel driven generator shall be submitted which shall demonstrate that the generator, main connection system, and the associated cooling systems are adequately rated to transfer the output of the engines over the complete range of loading conditions, grid voltage variations, operating modes and ambient conditions. The EPC Contractor shall carry out all electrical studies, including load flow; short circuit levels, protection setting and co-ordination taking into account the technical requirements for transmission system interface.
PAGE 80
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The electrical auxiliaries AC and DC systems shall be designed to give adequate and reliable supplies to the various items of plant, together with the necessary standby or duplicated supplies. As a general principle, the failure of no single item of auxiliary plant shall result in the complete loss of unit electrical output. Plant failures may result, at most, in a reduction of electrical output. One engine in the plant shall continue running (on-load) under grid failure conditions and the essential supplies system shall be capable of maintaining the supply to all instruments, controls and auxiliaries required for the safe and reliable operation of the plant and equipment under all normal and abnormal operating conditions. Where electrical equipment is essential to the continued running of the installation, the associated auxiliary power supply systems shall be arranged to allow recovery from fault conditions and also permit inspection and maintenance to be carried out without interference with normal operation. The low voltage system shall be solidly earthed. The generator voltage system shall be earthed at the neutral of the generator as described in the generator section below. Protective relays and systems shall be provided to detect all credible faults on each item of plant and equipment and their primary interconnections. In the event of unacceptable electrical system disturbances occurring, the protection shall operate, as rapidly as possible, consistent with maintaining adequate discrimination, to minimize damage to the plant and equipment and disturbance to the system as a whole. Each protective scheme shall be designed so that it does not cause incorrect tripping of a circuit breaker if a fault occurs outside the zone of protection covered by the scheme. A single protection failure should not prevent fault clearance or cause plant tripping. The plant and equipment shall be capable of being controlled under normal operation from the Central Control Room or locally. Automatic and manually initiated synchronizing facilities backed up with check synchronizing circuits shall be provided. Synchronizing equipment shall operate satisfactorily in conjunction with the automatic excitation control and the respective engine speed governing equipment. Synchronizing shall be carried out at the generator circuit breaker. As a minimum, the EPC Contractor shall undertake the electrical system studies listed below. The results of these studies shall be provided in report format for review and comment by the Owner. The design of the electrical power system infrastructure shall be based upon the results of these studies. The Generator shall ensure that numbering and nomenclature of high voltage apparatus will be in accordance with the plant identification system of the RAEC Code.
7.2.
The continuous current rating sizing calculations for all HV & MV cables shall be based on IEC 60287 / 62067 and shall verify the short circuit capacity of the cabling. The sizing calculations for all LV power cables shall be based upon the requirements of IEC 60227/60502.
7.3.
Auxiliary supplies
The EPC Contractor shall determine the design of the auxiliary power system; comprising unit transformers and/or station transformers. Based on the proposed design the EPC Contractor shall determine the requirement for a back-up MV supply from the local public distribution network. The auxiliary system shall provide a suitable level of redundancy to ensure that the failure of a single item of plant does not cause a loss of generation.
PAGE 81
7.4.
Studies shall be carried out to determine the voltage profile for the Plant based upon the full range of working conditions, to ensure that they remain within acceptable limits. Studies shall also be undertaken to determine the maximum and minimum fault levels that shall occur at various points on the power system network. The anticipated fault levels and running currents shall be used in the load-flow and fault level studies to determine equipment service and fault ratings.
7.5.
Studies shall be carried out to determine the transient stability during grid fault conditions and the Critical Clearance Times and the Fault Ride Through capability of each generating unit.
7.6.
Earthing studies
Studies shall be undertaken in accordance with BS 7671, BS7430, and IEEE Std 80, as a minimum, to design the earthing system for the plant and determine the following: Soil resistivity measurement and analysis and derivation of a multilayer soil resistivity model at the substation. Safety criteria Conductor sizing and earthing system resistance Derivation of the earth fault and grid currents. Earth potential rise Touch, step and transfer potentials Lightning protection earthing calculations. These studies shall take account of the interface with the earthing system that shall be installed at the substation, which is connected via the transmission line overhead earth wires. The earthing studies shall be undertaken based upon the earth fault currents expected from the development in order to determine conductor and connection sizes and to determine touch and step potentials and earth potential rise etc.
7.7.
The EPC Contractor shall determine the protection philosophy for the station, taking into account the technical requirements listed elsewhere in this document. The EPC Contractor shall also undertake a protection co-ordination study to determine the optimum settings for the protection relays and systems. This shall take account of the interfaces with the substation protection system at their substation and the requirements of the Grid Code. This study shall derive settings for all of the protection relays installed on the plant and provide a separate setting sheet for each relay listing the settings to be applied. These settings shall ensure discrimination is achieved where possible to ensure only the faulted section on the power system is isolated in the event of a fault.
7.8.
The EPC Contractor shall undertake insulation co-ordination studies in accordance with IEC 60071 which take account of the following: Temporary over-voltage resulting from HV earth faults
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 82
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Temporary over-voltage resulting from LV earth faults Temporary over-voltage resulting from load-rejection and short-term unearthing of the Site Transient over-voltages resulting from lightning impulses, originating from the external network. Switching transient over-voltages resulting from fault and fault clearing at HV and MV: point-on-wave Switching transient over-voltages resulting from load rejection and point-on-wave. Switching transient over-voltages resulting from transformer energisation.
7.9.
The EPC Contractor shall undertake a study to assess the risks and provide a suitable lightning protection system and design in accordance with IEC 62305.
7.10.
The generator shall be of an established design having a proven record of reliability for similar applications. The generator shall comply with the requirements of the relevant sections of IEC60034 and any local requirements, and shall use air as the coolant, with suitable filters. Bidders shall supply capability curves for the proposed generators. The generator insulation systems shall be Class 155(F), in accordance with IEC62114, but the relevant temperature rise shall not exceed the limits for Class 130(B). The generator shall be capable of supplying its rated real power output at nominal voltage and at a power factor between the following limits: 0.80 power factor lagging and 0.95 power factor leading. The generator shall be of open air-cooled inlet filtered type. The generator shall be capable of operating at its maximum continuous rating (MCR), at rated frequency, at a voltage that may vary between the limits stipulated in the Grid Code. The generator and prime mover shall also be capable of supplying the rated output, at rated voltage and power factor, at a frequency that may vary between the extreme limits stipulated in the Grid Code for the stipulated duration. Bearing and oil pipes shall be electrically insulated to prevent circulating currents. It shall be possible to test the insulation without having to dismantle the bearing. An earthing brush, of a proven design, running on the generator shaft shall be provided. The generator shall be designed to withstand, without failure in accordance with IEC 60034, the forces experienced during the following conditions: 1) 2) 3) Three phase short-circuit fault, with zero impedance, applied at the generator terminals; Line-to-line fault, with zero impedance, applied at the generator terminals; and Out of phase synchronism to the distribution network and with the voltage 120 out of phase.
The stator winding shall be star connected. The design shall ensure that no fretting of the coils in the slots and the winding overhang occurs under normal operating conditions. The integrity of the stator winding shall not require post-manufacture resin injection of the slot portion in order to achieve this requirement. Slot and end winding discharge shall not occur and the design shall ensure that slot wedge tightness and radial pressure on the coils is maintained to ensure satisfactory operation for the life of the plant. It shall be possible to re-tighten slot wedges if required. No re-tightening of the end-winding clamping between major maintenance overhauls shall be required.
PAGE 83
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The generator end shields at both the turbine and collector ends shall be designed to prevent contaminant ingress into the rotor and stator. Filters, seals and gaskets to be used on the end shields shall be heat and oil resistant. The generator shall be specifically designed to operate at 50 Hz and not be a 60 Hz design. In particular, stator end windings, terminal connections and their support structures shall be designed such that the natural vibration frequencies are well outside the forcing frequency of 100 Hz, and this shall be confirmed by bump testing. There shall be no significant dusting of the end winding insulation indicating insulating fretting and damage. The stator end windings shall be designed to last the design life of the generator without failure. The stator slot wedges shall be capable of withstanding the bursting force imposed during the most arduous electrical short-circuit between adjacent coil connections of different phases. Each coupling and its bolts shall be designed to withstand the forces that may be experienced at that coupling without sustaining permanent deformation of components and without relative movement of the coupling halves. Journal bearings shall be readily accessible, adjustable and replaceable with minimal disturbance to adjacent components. All necessary measures shall be taken to prevent leakage of oil from bearing pedestals and pipe work under all conditions of operation including shut down. Arrangements shall be provided for the local indication of the temperature and flow of oil from each bearing pedestal. Instrumentation shall be provided to monitor the temperature of the generator major components, which, as a minimum, shall include the following: Stator winding Stator core Bearings Cooling media to and from the stator and rotor cooling systems Rotor Shorted turns in the rotor winding These shall be wired back to the control room and shall alarm on high temperature A neutral earthing system shall be provided for the generator through an appropriately rated resistor. The earthing system shall limit the generator neutral current under fault conditions to suit system design limits. Special tools for assembling and dismantling the generator, including jacks, slings, lifting beams, skids, shaft extensions, shall be provided. The excitation system for the generator shall be of the brushless type having a permanent magnet pilot exciter. It shall comply with the requirements of IEC60034 and shall also comply with any particular requirements for the local 132 kV network and provide facilities to support black start of the plant and connection to the 132kV system via a single generator / step-up configuration. The equipment shall operate reliably and shall not impose restrictions on the availability of the generator due to excitation equipment faults or malfunctions.
PAGE 84
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The excitation system and equipment shall be complete with fast response continuously acting automatic voltage regulator having; no dead band, standby manual excitation control equipment with auto-following and auto-transfer facilities, monitoring and fault identification unit, limiters and stabilizers, field suppression equipment, protective devices, dedicated instrument transformers and all control facilities to enable the excitation equipment to be operated from both local and remote positions. The excitation system of the Power Unit generator shall be provided with a fast-acting reactive power (MVAr) under-excitation limiter so as to prevent the Power Unit generators MVAr output falling below its safe limit. A power system stabiliser shall be incorporated in the excitation system of each Power Unit generator. The excitation control system shall include the following functionality: Automatic and manual modes of operation and local and remote points of control; Manual mode of operation shall be provided by closed loop control of the field current; Fault tolerant behaviour with bumpless fail over and change over; V/Hz limiter; Over-excitation limiter; Under-excitation limiter; Power System Stabiliser Manual excitation control shall be subjected to over and under excitation limiters as for automatic voltage regulation; Automatic excitation run-up; Rapid de-excitation by provision of field suppression equipment; Reactive power compensation. A static excitation system having an equivalent or superior performance would be considered.
7.11.
The main connections between the generator and the generator circuit breaker shall be by cables. The main generators to step-up transformers connections shall have a short-time current rating determined by the higher of the fault contributions from the generator and the system.
7.12.
Transformers
PAGE 85
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The transformer shall have an on-load tap changer with the tapping range selected to meet the voltage and reactive power requirements of the network. Tap position shall be shown in the control room. The tap changer shall be fitted with a position indicator and an operation counter that can be read at the transformer. As a minimum requirement, the transformer shall be provided with the following auxiliary equipment: Gas, oil level low and oil surge protection relay (Buchholz) fitted in connection between the main tank and the conservator; Tap-changer gas and oil surge protection relay, if separate to the main tank; Main tank pressure relief device(s); Tap-changer pressure relief device, if separate to the main tank; Top oil and winding temperature indicators, alarms and protection trips; Conservator oil level indicator and alarms; Marshalling and control cubicle; HV and LV cable box; On-line condition monitoring equipment; Cartridge type conservator silica gel breather; Dehydrating breather for OLTC tank; Lifting lugs; Jacking lugs; HV surge arrester mounting brackets; and Rating and terminal marking plates. The transformer and its cooling system shall be designed to minimise operating costs over the design life of the plant.
PAGE 86
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification All voltage transformers shall comply with the requirements of IEC60186. Primary windings shall be connected to the switchgear through renewable fuses of agreed type to IEC60269 or IEC60282 and shall be readily accessible. Secondary fuses shall be provided on each voltage transformer and secondary windings shall be earthed at one point only through a link in an accessible position.
7.13.
Metalclad Switchgear
7.13.1. General
The design of the equipment shall ensure easy operation and maintenance and shall prevent accidental contact with live metal and avoid the spread of fire or damage from short circuits or other causes. All medium voltage equipment shall include fully rated earthing facilities to provide safe maintenance access. Equipment to be installed indoors shall have ingress protection to IP 41; outdoor equipment shall be to IP 65. All enclosures containing electrical equipment shall be provided with thermostatically controlled anticondensation heaters arranged to operate at low voltage ac. All enclosures shall be provided with an earth terminal of not less than 12 mm diameter to which shall be connected all internal apparatus, screens and supporting metal, and which shall be connected externally to the general earthing system. A steel cabinet with doors and locks equipped with a complete set of spanners to fit every nut and bolt on the circuit breakers along with any special tools or maintenance equipment necessary shall be provided. A key cabinet capable of accommodating all padlocks and keys for the switchboard and padlocks of an approval type for all padlocking positions shall be provided for each switchboard.
7.13.4. Control
Switchgear shall normally be controlled from the control room. However, local control at the switchgear shall be also provided for maintenance purposes. Lockable rotary local/remote selector switches shall be provided. Where electrically held-in contactors are used, individual transformers shall be fitted to each circuit unit. The primary winding shall be connected via suitably rated fuses to the busbars. One side of the secondary
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 87
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification winding shall be earthed via a removable link, the other side of the secondary winding shall be provided with a suitably rated fuse. An earthed screen shall be provided between the primary and secondary windings.
7.14.
7.14.1. General
All MV switchgear shall comply with the requirements of the relevant parts of IEC62271-100 and IEC60298. MV switchboards shall comprise metal-clad vacuum or SF6 type switchgear, with circuit breakers for the incomers, interconnector circuits and feeder circuits together with contactor units or circuit breakers for the motor drives and transformer feeder circuits. Cable and busbar earthing facilities shall be provided. Each switchboard shall be readily extensible and space shall be provided to allow the future installation of two circuit breaker cubicles at both ends of each switchboard, i.e. four future cubicles per switchboard. A clear side access space of one metre shall be provided at each end of the fully extended switchboard. It shall be possible to reset trip relays from outside the cubicles.
7.15.
Generator circuit breakers shall be designed for the receipt of suitably rated cables The circuit breakers shall be designed, manufactured and tested for generator switching duty in accordance with the requirements of the standards for 50 Hz application. Isolating and earthing switches shall be provided to permit adequate and safe maintenance of main plant and equipment to be carried out, including all connected equipment.
PAGE 88
7.16.
7.16.1. General
Low voltage switchboards shall be three-phase and neutral with four-pole switching devices on the incoming circuits and any busbar coupling circuits. Other low voltage switching devices may be three-pole with a solid neutral connection through accessible bolted links to each star point to suit contractor design. Low voltage switchgear shall be Form 4 Type 5 in accordance with the requirements of IEC 60439-1.
7.17.
Battery systems
Main dc systems shall be provided and shall be rated to supply all the essential load and control requirements of the Plant, including all dc supplies for safe run-down and cool-down. The EPC Contractor
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 89
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification shall choose the voltage levels from standard levels. Each dc system shall comprise one set of batteries and two chargers. On loss of output voltage from any battery charger, the associated battery shall supply the load on the dc system without a break in supply. The battery shall supply the dc load for sufficient time for the load to be transferred to a battery charger, i.e. by restoration of ac supply to the charger in question, or by transfer of the battery and loads to the alternative battery charger. The batteries shall generally have both poles fully insulated and shall be suitable for unearthed operation. A full set of battery test accessories shall be provided, mounted in a box. The station dc distribution boards shall be equipped with double pole circuit breakers for each incoming, interconnecting and outgoing circuit. Each battery charger shall be provided with local alarms and instrumentation and provision for remote indication of a common alarm on the DCS. Each battery charger shall also be equipped with ac input and dc output circuit breakers. The batteries shall be rated for a period of 2 hours when supplying 125 per cent of the maximum continuous load of its associated equipment.
7.18.
The black start unit shall be sized to enable automatically the auxiliaries of a selected main unit and the relevant station auxiliaries to be energised to enable black starting of the Plant. The selected main unit or units shall be capable of energising the relevant step transformer and energising the 132 kV substation in an unloaded condition. Subsequently the 132 kV substation outgoing circuits will be energised, the generation being matched to the step load demands. The black start / emergency generator shall be automatically start and supply the station auxiliaries on loss of the Plant output.
7.19.
A secure ac power supply system shall be provided for the operation of control and instrumentation equipment including the DCS operator stations and communication devices, e.g. network switches. The secure supply shall be derived from two inverters fed from separate dc systems with independent battery back-up supplies. Each complete system shall be rated to supply the complete control and instrumentation load of the associated plant. The performance of the inverter shall be compatible with the requirements of all connected loads in respect of steady state and transient output voltage variation, frequency variation, harmonic distortion, etc. The short circuit performance of the inverter shall be adequate to ensure correct fuse discrimination on short circuit of the outgoing circuit protected by the highest rated distribution fuse. The duration of the associated voltage depression must not be sufficient to affect the operation of the plant, other than that associated with the faulty circuit. The control scheme shall automatically transfer the ac load from the inverter to a back-up supply on inverter failure. The back-up supply shall be provided from a LV emergency supplies switchboard via a transformer and static switch. Operation of the above transfer shall not affect the output of the Plant. Facilities shall also be provided for transferring back to the inverter without affecting the Plant output. A manual bypass switch capable of switching between the incoming supply and inverter output without a break in the supply shall also be provided. Faults in the UPS shall be alarmed on the DCS.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 90
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The UPS equipment shall be rated for a standby period of 2 hours when supplying 125 per cent of the maximum continuous load of its associated distribution board.
7.20.
Protective system
Protective devices shall be provided to disconnect faulty circuits with speed and certainty, without interference with healthy circuits. Each protective scheme shall be designed so that it does not cause incorrect tripping of a circuit breaker if a fault occurs outside the zone of protection covered by the scheme. Each protection scheme shall generally be arranged in two independent groups according to the main/backup protection principle. The types of protection schemes required shall include: Generator transformer protection: high speed transformer biased differential (87GT); HV overcurrent (50/51); HV earth fault (50N/51N); HV restricted earth fault (64REF); HV standby earth fault (51G); LV earth fault (50/51N) for open generator circuit breaker; oil level low (71) Buchholz relay (63TCB-T/63TCB-A); pressure relief valve (63PR); oil temperature alarm and trip (49OT); winding temperature alarm and trip (49WT); over voltage relay (59); and under frequency (81).
Generator protection with one hundred percent (100%) redundancy: generator differential (87G); voltage dependent overcurrent (51V/27R); thermal overload stator and rotor (49); stator earth fault ninety five percent (95%) protected (59N); stator earth fault one hundred percent (100%) protected ( (64F3 {third harmonic under voltage relay} combined with 59N); rotor earth fault (64G); sensitive directional earth fault (67N);
PAGE 91
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification neutral displacement (59N); pole slip/out of step (78); over voltage (59); under voltage (27UV); over frequency (81O) (Stage 1 & Stage 2); under frequency (81U) (Stage 1 & Stage 2); under impedance/back-up impedance (21); field failure/loss of excitation (40); over excitation V/Hz (24); negative phase sequence (46); low forward power relay(37); reverse power (32R); inadvertent energising (50/27); generator circuit breaker failure (50CBF); voltage balance (60); check synchronising (25); and out of step protection (78).
Station transformer protection: high speed biased differential (87UT); HV overcurrent (50/51/51N); LV restricted earth fault (64REF); LV standby earth fault (51G); Buchholz relay (63BG/BT); pressure relief valve (63PT); oil temperature alarm and trip (26); and winding temperature alarm and trip (49).
All relays and protection schemes shall comply with the requirements of the appropriate parts of the IEC60255. All relay cases shall prevent the ingress of dust and shall meet the requirements of IEC60529, classification IP 50, category 2 Electronic protection relays, of the programmable microprocessor type incorporating fault and transient measurement memories, matrices for programming tripping sequences and auxiliary relays shall be
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 92
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification provided. The fault and transient measurement capabilities of the relays shall be used to provide a digital fault-monitoring and disturbance recorder system which covers the entire Plant electrical system items, including but not limited to: incomers and couplers of all main low voltage (LV) switchgear; all LV switchgear feeders except motor feeders (motor feeders shall be monitored via the DCS); and all HV switchgear bays connected to the Plant;
Each relay or protection scheme shall be provided with an adequate number of indications to ensure that the appropriate faulted phase, zone, etc. can be easily identified after a fault condition. Each indicator shall be visible and capable of being reset without removing the relay cover. Indications shall only be given from the protection activated by the fault. Each protection relay or protection scheme shall be provided with sufficient output contacts of suitable rating to carry out the prescribed tripping functions, alarms, indication and fault recorder functions and such supplementary signalling functions as may be necessary for the initiation of automatic reclosing or automatic switching control, etc. In all cases, contacts intended for tripping duty shall be designed so that they cannot inadvertently interrupt trip coil current. All solid-state equipment shall be designed to withstand the impulse and high frequency test requirements for Class III as specified in IEC60255-4. Solid-state protection equipment that requires an independent low voltage dc supply shall preferably use dc/ac/dc converter power packs for this purpose. Separate power packs are preferred for each individual discriminative relay unit. Adequate test facilities shall be provided at the front of the relay panel to enable the protection equipment to be tested whilst the primary circuit is on load, without having to disturb any wiring. Adequate facilities shall be provided to isolate all dc and ac incoming and outgoing circuits so that work may be carried out on the equipment with complete safety to personnel and without loss of security in the operation of the generating station. All test equipment required for commissioning and routine testing of the offered protection equipment shall be provided.
7.21.
Motors
7.21.1. General
Motors shall comply with the requirements of IEC60034. Motor enclosures shall be IP 54 for indoor application and IPW 55 for outdoor. Motor windings shall be insulated with materials Class 155(F), in accordance with IEC62114, but the relevant temperature rises shall not exceed the limits for Class 130(B). All MV motors, LV motors required to operate outdoors, or motors that may be at standstill for relatively long periods, shall be fitted with anti-condensation heaters of appropriate rating. The heaters shall be designed for connection to a suitable low voltage supply and shall be energized when the motor is at standstill. A separate heater terminal box and isolating facilities shall be provided for each motor.
PAGE 93
7.22.
Earthing
7.22.1. General
The EPC Contractor shall supply an earthing grid for the entire plant that conforms to the relevant sections of IEC 61000-5-2, IEC60364-5-54, IEEE 80 and IEEE 665. The EPC Contractor shall present calculations to show that the proposed system complies with IEEE 80 and is safe in terms of touch, step and transferred potential. There shall be separate direct connections to the station earth electrode from all low voltage, medium voltage and high voltage system neutrals, and from the station main earthing bar. Test links shall be provided. The main earth bars within the Plant shall comprise annealed high conductivity bare copper strip or stranded copper wire. Earth conductors installed directly into the ground shall normally be laid bare and the trench back filled with fine topsoil. Where the soil is of hostile nature precautions must be taken to protect the earth conductor. TN-S earthing arrangements to BS7671 (IEC equivalent) shall be provided for the electrical distribution system.
PAGE 94
7.23.
Alarm equipment
Alarm equipment shall be provided on the plant control panel and shall be equipped with interface equipment to allow transmission of each alarm to the CCR. The equipment shall be capable of acceptance and resetting from the CCR. Critical alarms i.e., those requiring urgent action by the operator, shall be hardwired from each alarm system to the DCS.
7.24.
Cabling
7.24.1. General
The cable installation to be provided under the Contract shall include all cables required for the supply, control, indication and monitoring of all plant provided under this Contract. The installation shall be complete with all cable terminations, cable trays, cable ladder racks, junction boxes, glands, ferrules, lugs, numbered ferrules, cable markers, clips and all fixings, fittings, brackets, cleats, piping and accessories. The EPC Contractor shall undertake all design studies for the electrical distribution cabling system. Cable conductors shall be stranded high conductivity copper. The conductor cross section of each cable shall be adequate for carrying the prospective fault current determined by the next relevant short circuit protection device. All cabling and wiring shall be of the flame retardant type to the latest IEC standards and during combustion shall emit no halogen and produce minimal smoke. Cabling and wiring shall be designed and the installation arranged to minimize the risk of fire and damage. Cable shall be of the low the low smoke zero halogen type. The insulation of each conductor shall be identified throughout its length either by colour or embossed numbers. The cable insulation shall include inhibiters for rodent protection. Each cable shall be identified by a securely fixed fade-free and dirt resistant identification label adjacent to the cable gland at each end of the cable. Single point earthing shall be used for all single core cables. Cables shall be glanded at entry to each panel with suitable mechanical glands to meet manufacturer recommendations. For all equipment, conductors up to and including 2.5 mm shall be terminated with agreed crimped terminations. Conductors larger than 2.5 mm shall use an agreed crimped termination
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 95
2 2
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Cable and core unique identification shall be provided, and terminations to suit manufacturer recommendations for terminal points. The EPC Contractor shall submit for agreement full details of all loading on cables. No intermediate joints shall be allowed in any length of cable without agreement.
PAGE 96
PAGE 97
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification joints. The joints shall be of an agreed plastic type, flexible and self-aligning. Grooved cable conduits shall be provided for splitting where split conduits are required for protection of existing services.
Inspection pits
An inspection pit shall be constructed at every junction and at every change of direction greater than 30 ; The pits shall be so constructed as to avoid ingress of water, with walls of reinforced concrete or brickwork resting on a reinforced concrete base. The internal dimensions of inspection pits shall be greater than the minimum bending radius of the largest cable to be drawn through the pit. The top of the
PAGE 98
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification inspection pit shall have a reinforced concrete slab of thickness to DIN 19580 in accordance with the traffic application class; A cast iron frame of a size agreed by the Owner shall be built into the top slab. A cast iron (or concrete) cover to suitable for the duty and of a type which prevents ingress of water into the pit shall be provided. The EPC Contractor shall submit details for the agreement of the Owner; Four pairs of lifting keys shall be supplied for each type of cover; The floor of the inspection pit shall slope to a sump; The invert of the lowest duct at the point of entry into an inspection pit shall not be less than 150 mm above the floor;
c) d) e) f)
7.25.
The lighting and small power installation shall be installed in accordance with BS7671 (IEC equivalent) and cover the complete Plant and shall comprise: Permanent lighting installations, emergency lighting systems, area floodlighting; Small power socket outlets for plant areas, equipment and control rooms, office areas, maintenance and testing areas, and domestic items; and Secondary supplies to distribution boards, transportable and fixed equipment, welding plant, environmental plant, and sump pumps.
7.25.1. Lighting
The main lighting installation shall be designed to give the IES recommended minimum levels of illumination in such a manner as to ensure even lighting and to avoid glare. The level of illumination in the Local Control Room(s) shall not be less than 100 lux under emergency conditions.
PAGE 99
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification A section of the main lighting installation shall be operated as an emergency lighting scheme that shall be automatically energized on failure of the electrical supply to normal lighting in the relevant area. Selfcontained emergency lights shall be used to indicate personnel exit points. In areas where continued operation is necessary under emergency lighting conditions, the illumination level shall be consistent with the continuity of such operation. In the remaining areas, including general access areas, the level of shall ensure the safety of personnel at all times.
PAGE 100
8.
8.1.
The design of the control and instrumentation systems and components shall be consistent with the overall availability, reliability and operational philosophies adopted for the Plant. The design of the control and instrumentation systems shall conform to accepted industry practice for generating units of this nature.
8.2.
Systems, equipment and components shall be designed, installed and commissioned in accordance with the relevant NFPA, IEEE and IEC Standards. Other National or International Standards shall not be used without the written approval of the Owner. Control and instrumentation systems shall comply explicitly with the latest revision of the following standards.
IEC 61131-3 IEC 61508 IEC 61511 IEC 60654 Programmable controllers Part 3: Programming languages Functional safety of electrical/electronic/programmable electronic safety-related systems Functional safety Safety instrumented systems for the process industry sector Operating conditions for industrial-process measurement and control equipment
IEC 60529 EN 55011 IEC 61000-4 IEC 61000-6 EN 50014 IEC 60079-14 BS 6739 ISA-5.1
Specification for degrees of protection provided by enclosures (IP code) Industrial, scientific and medical (ISM) radio-frequency equipment Electromagnetic disturbance characteristics Limits and methods of measurement Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) Part 4: Testing and measurement techniques Electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) Part 6: Generic standards Electrical apparatus for potentially explosive atmospheres. General requirements Electrical apparatus for explosive gas atmospheres. Electrical installations in hazardous areas (other than mines) Code of practice for instrumentation in process control systems: installation, design and practice Instrumentation symbols and identification
8.3.
Control and instrumentation equipment shall: Ensure safe and efficient operation of the Plant by an optimum number of operators during normal onload plant operation within the technical limits of a Power Unit, Power Unit Block and the Plant as applicable, as well as start-up/shutdown; Be designed to operate satisfactorily over the full range of operating and ambient conditions of the plant. This shall also include operation in hazardous areas where necessary; Be designed to provide a high level of availability and reliability consistent with a power plant operating with a high utilisation factor. This shall be achieved through the application of redundant systems with automatic on-line change-over facility upon detection of a fault or failure of the operating unit and the use of equipment well proven in similar applications. The control system design philosophy shall be such that a single C&I component failure shall not result in the loss of complete generation of the Works or the reduction in the Works capacity greater than that of a single generating Unit of the Works.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 101
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Use of failsafe design principles to provide Plant safety critical control and protection systems. Triple modular redundant control systems (2-out-of-3 voting) or equivalent (e.g.1-out-of-2-diagnostic) shall be provided for all plant safety critical control systems relating to gas and liquid fuel critical control and shut-off schemes to meet the Safety Integrity Level (SIL) required for the particular application. Utilise a high level of standardisation with regard to equipment selection and control logic design. Have demonstrated satisfactory performance in similar applications for at least 3 years. Be designed to maximise the level of automation provided for such Plant operations as start-up, synchronising, loading, unloading and shutdown. The automated sequences shall be designed with a view to optimise the start-up / shutdown times whilst maintaining the mechanical and thermal stresses that the Power units are subjected to within allowable limits. The Plant shall be provided with a load dispatch model which will be able to receive Dispatch Instructions/optimise the number of Power units which require to be in service at the load required by the RAEC System while maintaining adequate spinning reserve and dispatching the Power Units within their emission limits. This shall also take into account any other power generation units in operation in the RAEC System. It shall be able to carry out economic Dispatch; and Utilise a high level of standardisation with regard to equipment selection and control logic design, so that training requirements for equipment operation and maintenance and of spare parts holdings are optimised. Automatic and immediate on-load change over from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil to ensure GCPFC without interruption in the event of a Gas Operation Failure, trip of Gas Connection Facilities or the pressure of Natural Gas at the Gas Delivery Point falling below the minimum gas pressure specified in the NGSA or the pressure at the Gas Connection Facilities falling below the minimum gas pressure required by the Power Units Block(s), and thereafter changeover from Fuel Oil to Natural Gas when pressure is reinstated or Natural Gas supply interruption is corrected To meet the grid operational requirements of the Owner, the control system shall be designed and set up to ensure that at least one gas engine shall remain on-load in the event of the loss of the 132kV transmission grid. This is to ensure that a supply is maintained for house loads, local loads and to the gas conditioning system. The Owner shall be able to designate and change/rotate the engines which shall perform this duty. Space provision shall be provided in the central control room for an additional PC and screen for control and monitoring of external systems. The PC and screen shall be provided by others.
8.4.
The control, monitoring, protection and information management functions for the Plant shall be carried out by an overall Distributed Control System (DCS). At the plant end of the DCS, real time process data shall be acquired using plant-mounted instrumentation and sent to I/O sub-systems that are located either locally (preferred) or remotely. In the case of local I/O, the sub-system shall be designed to tolerate the plant environment in which it is operating. The I/O sub-systems shall transmit the plant data using suitable data links to controllers that are either physically distributed around the plant or located at a centralised equipment room with functional segregation, for data processing and execution of sequence logic and modulating control algorithms. Depending on the application and the implementation philosophy, a controller and its I/O system may be part of the native DCS family (e.g. station load controller, fuel forwarding system) or a high integrity fault tolerant version of the DCS (e.g. engine control/protection system) or a stand-alone dedicated system (e.g. engine
PAGE 102
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification control/protection system, generator control system, water treatment plant controller, fuel gas conditioning skid controller). The controllers shall communicate with each other and the Human Machine Interface (HMI) part of the DCS to send/receive data, command and feedback. This shall be achieved using a dual redundant communications network, with the HMI and the controllers from the DCS family interfacing seamlessly to the communications network while the foreign controllers (e.g. stand-alone dedicated controllers) shall interface to the network using gateways or protocol converters as necessary. The DCS HMI shall be located in the CCR and shall provide a fully integrated control, monitoring and alarm facility to the plant operator with a view to optimise the visibility and controllability of the process and minimise operator manning levels. In addition, local control and monitoring facilities shall be provided where appropriate for use during commissioning and maintenance. The DCS and local controls shall be designed such that it shall not be possible to operate any item of plant from more than one point of control simultaneously. Adequate local indication of mechanical and electrical quantities shall also be provided. The high level plant management sub-systems of the DCS such as the plant historian and condition/performance monitoring systems shall interface with the DCS communication network to extract the plant data. These sub-systems shall communicate within the DCS in such a way that the real time operation of the DCS is unaffected. External third party control systems (e.g. GIS SCADA system, RDC, MGP alarm system, settlement system, fuel demand model, weather monitoring system, etc ) shall be interfaced to the DCS by suitable means (e.g. hardwired, serial data link) for data exchange to allow high level cross-monitoring and Plant overall control functions. The DCS shall also interface with the Plant administrative Local Area Network (LAN) via its communication network and gateway server protected by suitable firewalls for transfer of plant data to high level plant management and reporting applications resident in the Plant administrative computer systems.
8.5.
Safety Instrumented Systems (SIS) shall be supplied where necessary to prevent danger to personnel and damage to plant by initiating an automatic emergency shutdown (ESD) operation on detection of an unsafe operating condition of the plant. It is a mandatory requirement that adequate safety integrity is engineered into the overall plant and equipment in accordance with IEC 61508 and IEC 61511. The SIS design shall include two stages in its design process, viz. Safety Integrity Level (SIL) selection and SIL validation. The SIL selection includes the definition of a target SIL when undertaking a Preliminary Hazards Analysis (PHA) or a formal Hazards and Operability (HAZOP) study of the various sub-systems of the plant. The SIL selection shall be done by one of the standard techniques currently used in the industry, e.g. Risk Graph method. The SIL validation initially includes a description of the design approach taken to achieve the target SIL for the identified sub-systems, followed by calculations to prove that the target SIL has been achieved. A Cause and Effect diagram shall also be produced by the EPC Contractor to support the design of the SIS. The functional safety which is being engineered into the system shall be documented for all Safety Instrumented Systems (e.g. engine emergency trip and protection systems, fuel shut-off system) in terms of both the target SIL and the design approach offered to meet this target for each sub-system. This documentation shall also show how the overall functional safety in terms of the SIL shall be assessed. This shall take on board the plant measurements, the associated cabling, data networks if used, the logic which
PAGE 103
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification acts on the measurement data, and the control/shut-off valves or other control elements which shall put the plant into a safe condition. Since the SIL rating of the shutdown systems would be higher than that of the DCS, these systems shall be independent from the DCS. However, high level monitoring of these shutdown systems shall be organised via the DCS so that the status of these systems can be presented on the operator screens for monitoring from the CCR. Where special high integrity controllers with certified SIL rating are available in the DCS family, they may be considered for emergency shutdown functions as long as they are engineered as independent nodes of the DCS with the DCS communication network being used only for high level monitoring from the CCR.
8.6.
An integrated DCS shall be provided for the complete operation, instrumentation, control and human machine interface (HMI) of the plant. The DCS shall interface with the equipment / unit control systems supplied under the Works including but not limited to those for the engines, generator, water treatment plant and all station electrical systems. The control system shall be fully integrated using microprocessor techniques and shall have a distributed architecture comprised of a family of independent functional processors and communications components consistent with the recognised international industry interpretation of a DCS. Each component shall be software programmable and maintainable and shall be set up to carry out specific tasks. Outstations shall be capable of autonomous operation and perform data acquisition, calculation, digital (open-loop) and analogue (closed-loop) control functions. Communications between the outstations located in different plant areas and the Operators and Engineers workstations located in the Control Room shall be performed over a redundant high speed data highway. The data highway shall be designed to perform at the speed necessary to ensure that all variables are updated and control commands are issued without loss of system performance. The data highway shall include all control equipment, error detection and correction facilities and cabling. The DCS shall be designed to ensure maximum availability by the inclusion of built-in redundancy for both hardware and software. This shall include duplicated control processors, data highway and power supplies with automatic changeover to the standby unit upon detection of a fault or failure of the operating unit. Where appropriate, I/O cards shall also be duplicated. The failure of any single element shall not affect the operation of any item of operating plant. In particular, the duplicated control processors shall be capable of fail over without change to plant status, sequence status or control actions, at any stage of plant operation. It shall be possible to replace a failed redundant module without affecting the satisfactory functional operation of the plant and without system downtime. Comprehensive system diagnostic facilities shall be incorporated to assist in maintenance and troubleshooting. These shall include memory, control processors, I/O cards, data highway, storage devices, as a minimum.
8.6.1.
DCS Functionality
The DCS shall: a) allow fully automatic unit operation through a local operator-initiated cold start, synchronise on line, run up to demand generation under automatic generation control (AGC) and conversely run down to cold stop under safe and controlled conditions;
PAGE 104
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification b) c) d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) l) automatically ensure safety of personnel and equipment under all Plant operating conditions; supervise and control the common services facilities provided for the Plant; maximise the availability and efficiency of the Plant; enable the Plant to be operated and maintained with the minimum of appropriate personnel consistent with cost effectiveness and safety; provide station auxiliary electrical supervision and control; provide performance monitoring of the Plant provide life-consumption monitoring of the Plant and plant items; meet the operational and design requirements as specified; provide Plant alarm monitoring and interlock functions; provide Plant data logging, including but not limited to sequence of events, historical storage and retrieval, trending; minimise the cable requirements on Site; and
m) provide external interfaces as defined elsewhere It is accepted that some minor plant equipment such as diesel and lubricating oil unloading and transfer units, etc will be controlled locally. The AGC facility shall incorporate automatic and manual regulation of the real and reactive power output of the Plant. It shall be capable also of remote AGC operation by RDC
8.6.2.
Software
The latest version of the manufacturers system software shall be provided fully developed, tested and installed. The EPC Contractor shall implement and co-ordinate software design, integration and implementation across sub-contract systems. The software design shall comply with the requirements of IEC61131-3. Software licences for unrestricted use by the Owner shall be supplied for all packages required for operation, diagnostics and reconfiguration of the system. Software shall be implemented through standardised component control logic designs. Control logic designs shall be designated for all field devices or functional groups of field devices, as appropriate. The number of control logic designs shall be kept to the minimum possible, in order to simplify DCS software, and the full set of designs shall be submitted to the Owner for agreement prior to implementation. The application software and associated displays, reports, databases, etc, shall be pre-formatted when installed at site. The creation or modification of displays, reports, databases or control strategies shall be possible with the system on-line by the Owners engineering personnel without affecting the plant operation. Modifications to the software shall be done in straightforward and logical steps using, wherever possible, graphic displays. It shall not be necessary to have specialist knowledge of the underlying software in order to carry out modifications. Access to software and application programmes at various levels shall be possible by operating or engineering personnel using passwords. This shall protect the software from unauthorised access.
8.6.3.
The operator interface software shall enable the operator to carry out the necessary actions in a safe and efficient manner. In particular the following features shall be included, as a minimum, but not be limited to:
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 105
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Software shall be structured in such a way so as to provide a hierarchy of control from automatic sequential plant start-up through to manual control of an individual item; During manual intervention by the operator (sequence initiation and individual device control under normal and failure conditions), all software derived, hardwired permissive and overrides shall be visible to the operator; Where process measurements have been duplicated into the DCS for improved reliability, the signals shall be averaged for control purposes and quality monitoring shall be employed to automatically switch to the good signal in the event of an interruption. The operator shall have, for the purposes of maintenance, the on screen facility to select either signal or the average, as the measured variable for control.
8.6.4.
Reports
The DCS shall be capable of presenting to the operator, on request or at predetermined times, pre-defined reports, which shall include: Periodic logs, daily logs and group logs, balance of energy and efficiency log; Snapshot report, providing the current value of analogue signals or the current status of all or selected binary points; Change of state report; Alarm report, listing alarms in chronological order; Analogue history report; Hours Run-Time report; Event count report; Trip report; Sequence of Events report; and Statistical Metering report, to provide average demand values over a 24-hour period for MW import/export, MVAr import/export, and auxiliary MW and MVAr and fuel use; In addition reports shall be produced to meet the requirements of the Environmental Protection Agency. All report formats shall be to the agreement of the Owner.
8.6.5.
Alarm management
All Plant and system generated alarms shall be prioritised, logged and displayed by the DCS. There shall be a dedicated alarm display which shall show all the plant alarms or groups of alarms. The operators work stations shall have a visual and audible warning which shall raise the attention of the operator upon the receipt of any alarm. Alarms shall also be printed on the alarm/event printer. The alarm philosophy shall be such that alarms shall only be displayed to the operator where the condition requires immediate operator attention to prevent plant damage, loss of plant life, loss of efficiency, loss of availability or other abnormal conditions. Intelligent alarm filtering shall be employed in order to minimise the occurrence of nuisance alarms. All alarms and events shall be logged and stored for future analysis. The operator shall have the facility to select optional alarm displays, summary of alarms, historical alarms on global or point based, unacknowledged alarms, alarms by priority, alarms by pre-defined system groups.
PAGE 106
8.6.6.
The DCS shall incorporate long term data logging facilities for all analogue, digital, serial data, alarms, condition monitoring and other internally generated points including the overall extension capacity specified. All data shall be automatically archived and retained for future reference in either optical or magnetic medium. The operator shall have the facility to present real-time data, recall data held in the data logger memory or from archives over a specified period of time. The requested information shall be presented on the operators workstations either in tabular form or as selected variables on a trend display. It shall be possible to compare on the same display, multiple trends of real-time data or historical data from the data logger or archives. The format and content of the reports for data retrieval from the logging facility shall be subject to agreement.
8.6.7.
Sequence of Events
A sequence of events (SOE) recording system shall be supplied to allow analysis of the causes of trips or plant disturbances. The SOE recorder may be either integrated within the DCS (preferred method) or a stand-alone item of equipment. The SOE recorder shall scan all designated binary inputs continuously. The overall error in event time stamps in controllers shall be 40 to 50 ms considering a clock accuracy of 20 to 30 ms between controllers and a cycle time of 20 ms. The philosophy shall be to have more accurate time stamps for electrical events (i.e. electrical protection relays time stamping the events to an accuracy of 1 ms) since they are fast acting. Less accurate time stamps for slow acting process events shall be accepted, thereby achieving a correct sequence of events log. The status of each point shall be time tagged. Data shall be continuously deleted from the database after the specified time period has elapsed. Facilities shall be provided for data to be archived for future reference. The SOE shall allow for the retention of data on a user defined event (e.g. engine trip), or manual initiation from the DCS. All data for a user defined time period before and after the event shall be recorded. The SOE recorder shall automatically reset after the elapsed time period and continue to monitor the plant in the normal way.
8.6.8.
The control hardware of the DCS shall consist of control processors, I/O sub-systems, communication modules and communication networks. The control processors shall be capable of executing multiple modulating control and logic sequences in a time shared arrangement within the processor and shall have the power to meet the sampling frequency requirements of the control algorithms dictated by the process. The control processors shall be functionally distributed, i.e. a processor handling the requirements of a section of the process, and shall have a duty/standby configuration with automatic failure detection of the duty processor and bumpless switchover to the standby processor. The I/O system shall be functionally and geographically (preferred) distributed. The system shall be resilient to environmental conditions and electrical noise that it can be subjected to. Time stamping of scanned data shall be done as close to the field as possible and shall make use of a master real time clock reference for the whole system derived from the station master clock system. A modern internationally accepted communication protocol shall be used to exchange data with the control processor.
PAGE 107
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The control processors shall have data communication modules that allow the interfacing of foreign systems which are not part of the main control system family by acting as gateways or protocol converters. The control processors shall communicate with each other and the HMI via a dual redundant fault tolerant communications network. The network shall use an internationally accepted open protocol and shall have sufficient bandwidth to handle the worst case data traffic under transient conditions of the plant without a noticeable reduction in the speed of response of the control system and the operator HMI. Adequate fault detection of the network and data error detection and correction facilities shall be provided as part of the basic design of the communication network. The cabling for the dual redundant network shall be segregated and the network cables shall be routed along two separate paths to prevent an accidental damage occurring to both cables from a single incident (common mode failure). The plant and controller dynamic data shall be resident in a real time database that shall be either distributed throughout the controllers or resident in dual redundant servers for access by the controllers and the operator HMI. The loading of a control processor shall be no greater than 40% on average, with peak load within 65% of its capacity. The memory usage of a control processor shall be within 50% of what is provided. The loading of the communication network shall be within 40% of its capacity during normal conditions and no greater than 65% under abnormal plant conditions. Fully installed and wired spare I/O shall be a minimum of 20% for each type of I/O. Provision for future expansion of the I/O by 20% by installing additional modules in the I/O racks shall also be given. The control, I/O and communication hardware shall be supplied from two independent power sources, with at least one of them derived from an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) source. The internal power supplies shall be derived using duplicated power supply modules to maximise the availability of the system. The system shall have extensive diagnostic facilities to facilitate trouble-shooting and maintenance operations. A hot replacement facility shall be available for all redundant hardware without affecting the operation of the overall system.
8.6.9.
The DCS shall provide a single, coordinated operator interface with the Plant. Control and monitoring of all plant systems shall be through the DCS HMIs located in the central control room, excluding those that, by their simple, robust nature and minimal impact on overall availability and reliability, are provided with local controls only. An adequate number of HMI workstations shall be provided for centralised control and monitoring of the Plant from the CCR. The number of operator stations and their grouping in the CCR shall be decided taking into consideration safe and efficient operation of the plant by an optimum number of Plant operators; however three dual-headed operator workstations shall be supplied as a minimum. A workstation for the shift supervisor shall also be provided for overall plant supervision and high level control functions, e.g. station load control. The HMI workstation shall consist of its processing unit, dual/triple headed LCD VDUs, keyboard and mouse/track ball. The workstation shall be connected to both lines of the redundant communication network via separate network cards installed in the workstation. Network switches which enable the connection of the workstations and peripherals to the communication network shall be intelligent/managed to optimise network traffic. Printers of the laser jet type (colour and black & white with A4/A3 printing facility) shall be
PAGE 108
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification provided in the CCR for printing alarm/event logs (on request), reports, trends and screen copies. Sufficient quantities of workstations, printers, switches etc. shall be provided to maximise the availability of the HMI. The HMI workstations shall be based on an Operating System (OS) which is rugged, user-friendly and has been field-proven for continuous use in industrial applications (Microsoft Windows OS preferred). The Tenderer shall describe in his bid the recommended methodology and the provisions made in the workstations to prevent the inadvertent entry of computer viruses into the DCS via data transfer facilities such as Compact Disk (CD) drives and Universal Serial Bus (USB) ports that are available in the workstations. The control desks for locating the DCS HMI in the CCR shall be ergonomically arranged consistent with the plant operating philosophy. The arrangement shall be suitable for plant control and monitoring by the minimum number of operators with the possibility of access to workstations by more operators for special operations and for training purposes. The control desk shall also accommodate a minimum of one telephone for the station internal system. Cable routing facilities shall be provided for the control desks. The supervisors desk shall include his workstation, internal telephone with dial out facility, external phone dedicated for load dispatch purposes and other station communication equipment such as the public address and radio communication systems. An engineering facility via engineers workstations shall be provided in the CCR as well as in an engineering room adjacent to the CCR for modifications to the control system configuration, screen graphics and application software as well as to run diagnostics. This facility shall include password protected workstations with high resolution VDU and a colour laser A4 printer. All CCR equipment including workstations, printers, network switches etc. shall be powered from a UPS source. The Central Control Room shall have a false floor to enable easy routing of C&I, communication and power cables to the various workstations, computer peripherals etc. The CCR shall be air conditioned. All CCR furniture including control desks, fully adjustable swivel chairs, printer desks, document storage facilities, discussion table with chairs etc. shall be supplied and fully colour co-ordinated with the rest of the CCR. Large digital numeric displays to indicate variables of general interest shall be mounted in the CCR. These shall include as a minimum, total gross and net real power exported, system voltage, system frequency and local time. An architecture drawing of the DCS HMI showing the number of workstations, peripherals, network switches etc. included in the offer as well as the grouping and connections of these devices shall be submitted with the tender. A drawing which shows the proposed layout and locations of equipment and furniture within the CCR shall also be provided with the bid submission.
PAGE 109
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Screen layout shall be designed to optimise the efficiency of data display. Ideally, any given system shall be displayed on one screen. However, it is recognised that some systems are too complex to achieve this requirement. In these instances clearly identified and logical links shall be made between the pages that make up the complete system. In all instances, where the operator passes from one screen to another, it shall be possible to return directly back to the previously viewed screen. The main, or highest level, DCS screen shall represent, in as simple a manner as possible, the entire plant and give the operator the main control parameters, such as power out, fuel gas pressure, terminal volts, etc. It shall be possible to reach any sub-system screen from the main screen by following as few links as possible. HMIs shall be provided with large screen support as necessary to enable operator management of all units simultaneously.
PAGE 110
8.7.
A master clock shall be supplied as part of the station clock system to provide a common time reference for the Plant. It shall be referenced to an appropriate radio time signal (e.g. GPS signal). Station clocks shall be supplied and installed at various locations of the Plant. The quantity and locations of the clocks will be finalised during the detailed design stage, however, a reasonable provision for a typical Plant shall be included for this item in the Contract. A large alphanumeric display showing hours, minutes and seconds shall be installed in the CCR for indicating the local time. The station clocks and the digital display shall be driven from the master clock. The master clock shall provide real time reference to the DCS and all other plant control, monitoring and protection systems by suitable interfaces capable of achieving a time synchronisation accuracy of 1 ms among these systems for their data acquisition and logging activities.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 111
8.8.
Instrumentation
All transmitters shall have internals and fittings of a corrosion resistant material suitable for the medium being measured. All instrumentation shall be selected such that the normal maintenance intervals to maintain the performance and function based on the worst case plant operating conditions is no more than annually based on manufacturer recommendations. Programmable smart transmitters are preferred. Each transmitter that is used to transmit a signal to the DCS shall be powered from 24 V dc supply and utilise a two-wire transmission system. All electrical and pneumatic transmitters shall be equipped with separately mounted local indicator. All transmitters shall be provided with test connections and instrument isolating valve manifolds. Separate indicating thermometers and manometers will be provided. Transmitters shall be used wherever possible, however, where used switches for pressure, flow, temperature and level monitoring shall be of the heavy-duty type with double pole changeover contacts. Contacts shall be rated to suit their required duty. Mercury switches shall not be used.
8.8.1.
All field mounted electrical items shall be weather-proof to IP 65 or equivalent and suitable for the local ambient weather conditions. Pneumatic instruments shall be weather-proof to IP 54 or equivalent. Components that are not line or vessel mounted, shall be mounted on local instrument racks and connected to the measurement source with stainless steel tubing or pipe. These racks shall be configured in a manner to consolidate multiple devices in the same plant area to a centralised location for cable routing and to facilitate equipment servicing. Instrument impulse lines shall use compression type tube fittings. Only one manufacturers fittings shall be used throughout the Plant.
8.8.2.
Flow instruments
For high pressure applications, the carrier for the primary device shall be of similar material to the pipeline in which it is to be mounted, and shall be connected into the pipeline by butt-welding. Other applications shall use flanged connections wherever possible. All differential pressure devices shall be provided complete with tapping point isolation valves, 3 valve manifolds and drain valves or 5-valve manifolds, as required. Turbine type flow meters shall be used for gas flow measurements. Meters used for tariff metering purposes shall be supplied, complete with adjacent pipe sections where necessary, with calibration certification from an agreed laboratory. Flow meters employing alternative measurement principles may be utilised for appropriate applications subject to the agreement of the Owner. Flow integrating meters shall provide output in the form of pulses from volt free contacts to the DCS. The flow measurement system must be designed, built and installed to the current editions of ISO 5167-1 (Measurement of Fluid Flow in Closed Conduits - Pressure Differential Devices) and ISO 9951
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 112
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification (Measurements of Gas Flow in Closed Conduits - Turbine Meters). The uncertainty of the measurement systems must be assessed in accordance with ISO 5168 (Measurement of Fluid Flow - Estimation of Uncertainty of a Flow rate Measurement) and the relevant parts of ISO 5167 and ISO 9951.
8.8.3.
Level instruments
Level measuring devices may be of the direct measurement, differential pressure or electrical/electronic type as appropriate to the application. For local indication of level, direct measuring devices shall be used. Unless otherwise agreed by the Owner it shall be possible to remove any level measurement device without the vessel or other instruments being taken out of service. Where installed, each level indicating gauge shall be fitted with top and bottom isolating valves with full bore drain valve at the bottom and plugged vent at the top. Flanged connections, rated the same as the vessel, shall be used. Differential pressure transmitting devices shall preferably be used on all services other than slurry. Displacement type instruments and switches shall be mounted in external cages with flanged connections, rated the same as the vessel. This type of instrument shall not be used for applications involving viscous, corrosive or flashing liquids. Float switches shall be glandless with magnetic coupling. Switches used for level detection shall provide facilities for testing the mechanical and electrical operation of the switch without its removal from the process.
8.8.4.
Pressure instruments
Low pressure gauges may employ manometer or barometer devices to indicate small gauge, differential pressures or vacuums. Gauges measuring low ranges that can be exceeded by a higher containment pressure shall be fitted with over-range protection. Gauges shall be fitted with vent/test valves. Blow out devices shall be provided for high pressure applications. All differential pressure transmitters shall be capable of withstanding without damage or calibration change, full rated line pressure as a differential input. Pressure transmitters shall withstand at least 115% of nominal input range without damage or calibration change. Pressure switches shall be such that under normal process operating conditions, the contact in the switch shall be closed unless otherwise agreed by the Owner. Switches shall have adjustable set-points and adjustable hysteresis, as required.
8.8.5.
Temperature instruments
Sensing elements for air, inert gas and radiant temperature measurements shall be complete with suitable protective sheath. For water and hazardous applications, thermowells shall be utilised. Where thermocouples are employed then cold junction compensation shall be provided. In the case of direct immersion metal couples of the mineral insulated type, the couple up to the associated junction box shall be capable of easy replacement. A flexing coil having a minimum diameter of 250 mm shall be provided in the couple between the junction box and the carrier.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 113
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Where thermocouple assemblies are supplied, a disconnection head shall be arranged clear of the pocket and associated lagging and shall be sufficiently long as to prevent excessive temperature of the head assembly. Local temperature indicators shall be supplied with a thermowell.
8.8.6.
Analytical instruments
Analytical instruments monitoring chemical or physical properties of process fluids and substances may be installed either directly in the process line or vessel or at a distance and connected by means of sampling systems. The delay time between the sample being withdrawn from the process and being available to the analyser shall be consistent with the measurement and control requirements of the particular process. The preferred method of keeping sampling lags to acceptable limits shall be by locating the analyser close to its sample take-off point. When this is not practicable the distance velocity lag of the sampling system shall be reduced by increasing the velocity of the sample. Analytical instruments shall be selected to operate continuously, infrequently or on a continuously interrupted cycle as most suited to the measurement and the intended application. Where sensors require the use of calibration solutions or gases then a minimum of one years supply at normal usage shall be supplied. Where sensors require replacement or removal for recalibration or rejuvenation at regular intervals, then an adequate number of spare sensors shall be supplied for one years normal usage. Self cleaning pH and conductivity probes are preferred.
8.9. 8.9.1.
All control valves shall have local indication to show the actual position of the valve. Where transmitters are used to indicate the position remotely, the transmitted signal shall be taken directly from the actual valve position. Control valves shall be supplied with suitable actuators matched to the operational and environmental requirements of the plant. Digital valve controllers are preferred. All actuators shall be provided with a means of local control that shall be capable of being utilised without the use of tools. Loss of remote/automatic operation of an actuated valve shall be alarmed to the operator. Where the position of an actuator or regulating device is required for remote control or indication, then suitable linear variable differential transducer or plastic film potentiometer devices shall be fitted together with a transmitter. Position feedback of an actuator or other regulating device shall take their measurement as directly as possible from the mechanical output of the actuator or regulating device. Where it is only necessary to provide a limited number of discrete position indications, then position actuated switches shall be used. Switch settings shall be adjustable. Control valves shall be designed to fail to the safe state, given the valve application. For each valve application, due consideration shall be given to whether the safe state is open, closed or for the valve to
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 114
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification remain in the last position prior to loss of control (through control system failure, loss of feedback, power failure (pneumatic, hydraulic or electric), etc.).
8.9.2.
Manual valves
Where the open/closed status of manual valves is monitored, dual limit switches shall be provided, one for each end of travel.
8.9.3.
All primary isolating and blow down valves shall be capable of being locked in the open or shut positions. The direction of rotation shall be clearly marked on the hand-wheel. Two valves in series shall be provided for all applications above 40 bar line pressure. Double isolation shall be provided for hazardous services. The primary isolating valve shall be located at the tapping point, be of the parallel or globe type and rated for the temperature and pressure of the main line. Equalising valves shall be provided on differential measurements, downstream of the instrument isolating valves, to permit zero checking. Instrument isolating, equalising and vent valves shall preferably be incorporated in a single manifold.
8.10.
Installation requirements
Only one instrument shall be fitted to each tapping point. Instrument isolating valves, vent/test valves and instrument manifolds shall be attached to measuring devices so that it is possible to disconnect the device from the connecting pipe work without having to disconnect or drain the pipe work. There shall not be any open blow down or drain connections inside panels or local equipment housings. All instrument vent/drain points shall be directed to a safe position away from site personnel. The arrangement of pipe work and connections shall be such that the temperature of the instrument isolating valve or instrument valve manifold does not exceed 55C. For pneumatic connections each individual air user shall be provided with a line size and lockable isolating valve immediately upstream of a dedicated filter regulator. All indicating instruments and controls shall be readable and accessible from floor level or permanent platforms. Gauge glasses shall be visible from any control valve that controls the vessel level. Clearance shall be allowed for servicing and access to all items. Post or bracket mounts for instruments shall not be attached to pipe work, removable flooring, and handrails or be directly affixed to machinery and equipment subject to vibration. Instrument ranges shall be such that normal working indication lies between 60 and 75 per cent of the span. Instruments shall be mounted in heated or protected locations wherever possible in order to minimise the effects of ambient weather conditions. Instruments in water services or where water can accumulate in the impulse lines shall be trace heated where the ambient temperature can fall below 0C. Wind chill factor shall be considered.
PAGE 115
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Instruments in liquid services, which solidify at ambient temperature, shall be provided with diaphragm seals. Seal chambers or diaphragm seals shall be used where fluid services are corrosive, viscous, congealing, deposit forming, or dangerous. Seals shall be located as close as possible to the primary isolating valve.
8.11.
The DCS shall incorporate a shift log facility for use by the plant operators from the DCS screens. A separate PIMS historian system shall be installed to provide longer-term historical storage of plant analogue, digital, alarm and event data. The system shall be based on a field-proven database and shall have an open interface (e.g. OPC) for data acquisition. The system shall acquire all relevant process data from the DCS and store data for the life of the Plant. The historian shall incorporate an efficient algorithm to optimise the sample points stored without compromising the data quality and integrity. Sufficient storage capacity shall be provided in the system to meet the requirements. The retrieval, display and processing of historical data stored in the system shall be straight forward. It shall be possible to present historical data from different time periods in trend displays. A data back-up facility shall be provided for the historian system. The PIMS shall use a database for storing plant historical data and making it available via a hardware firewall to users both on site and off site. The data shall generally be used in long term asset management, maintenance and fault finding. The PIMS system shall provide the same data resolution and reliability as the data logging in the DCS and have the capacity of online storage of at least five years of historical data. The server, firewall and network hardware platform and architecture for the PIMS shall be to a standard agreed by the Owner. The PIMS interface to the control system data shall be via an OPC link via a network connection and firewall.
8.12.
The EPC Contractor shall provide an engineering and design database that centralises information related to field cabling and I/O. Information entered into the database shall be used to automatically generate cable schedules and loop diagrams. The data shall also be exported to form the basis of the DCS database.
8.13.
All security systems shall comply with the requirements of the ROP and EPC Contractors shall receive the necessary ROP clearance before implementing the security systems.
PAGE 116
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The interconnecting cable between the PABX and the Owners telephone network including the terminations shall be the responsibility of the EPC Contractor who shall provide all facilities for the connection of this service including ducting within the building where the Owners telephone exchange is located. All other internal telephone connections within the Plant boundary, including cabling shall be the responsibility of the EPC Contractor. The telephone system shall be powered via a battery/charger system to maintain the PABX and the siren system in normal operation for a period of not less than 10 hours in the event of a failure of battery charging current, when the exchange has been fully extended. The batteries shall normally be kept charged by a dual battery charger unit, each charger comprising a float charger with manual boost charge facilities with capacity sufficient to cater for ultimate extension facility referred to previously. Each battery charger shall be housed in a separate robust and well-constructed cubicle with good access to all components and equipment. It shall not be possible for the load to become disconnected from both batteries and chargers simultaneously. Telephone instruments suited to the location and environment in which they are installed shall be supplied by the EPC Contractor. These shall include basic wall and desk mounted units, executive handsets, and units suitable for noisy and outdoor plant areas (e.g. background noise suppressed units with acoustic hoods and weatherproof units) as necessary.
PAGE 117
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification system shall operate in the UHF band with multiple frequency channels in a semi-duplex mode for transmissions through the base station and in a simplex mode for direct communication between portable sets. The portable sets shall be light-weight with adjustable power levels to conserve battery life. The base station shall be powered from a UPS source or battery system. The portable sets shall be powered by rechargeable batteries that have sufficient capacity for normal usage during an eight-hour working shift and do not have memory problems.
PAGE 118
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification using IEC 60870-5-101 or IEC 60870-5-104 protocol to be decided during the design stage. Interoperability between the RDC and Plant shall be ensured. The interface shall be communication ports on the multiplexing equipment provided by the Licensed Transmission System Operator at the Tibat grid substation. The Generator shall provide all materials required to establish redundant communication links to the multiplexing equipment, including patch cords, network switches, fibre optic patch panels and fibre optic cable with accessories. The data exchange between the RDC and the Plant shall be provided in accordance with RAEC Code and the Consolidated SCADA List. In addition all necessary signals for implementation automatic power generation control AGC for regulation of the real and reactive power output of the Plant remotely operation by RDC. The list of signals with Licensed Transmission System Operator shall be finalised during the design stage. In accordance with the NGSA the Plant is required to exchange data with the MGP. The Generator shall provide all materials required to establish this data link to MGP, including patch cords, network switches, fibre optic patch panels and fibre optic cable with accessories. The list of signals with MGP shall be finalised during the design stage. The Generator shall also include the signals from the MOG related to interruptions in Natural Gas supply, MGP gas releases and MGP safety alarms with potential to impact the Generator in the data transmitted to RDC. The hardwired signals interchanged to and from the Plant and the Licensed Transmission system Operator, at the interface marshalling cubicle shall be exchanged as follows: 4 to 20 mA signals for analogue; and volt-free change over contacts for digital signals.
PAGE 119
9.
9.1. 9.1.1.
Civil Requirements
General requirements for civil works General
This section of the Specification covers the civil engineering and building works (collectively referred to as the civil works). This is a design and build project and shall include any preliminary studies, fully detailed design and construction of all civil works, auxiliary works and services necessary for the completion of the Plant. The civil works required shall include site investigations and data collection as deemed necessary by the EPC Contractor, detailed design, preparation of construction drawings, procurement of materials, execution and maintenance of works complete in all respects, provision of record drawings and CAD CD-ROMs as described herein. The design concept is to build the Plant on a platform at +15m MSL (optimal level without reducing plot surface area, and maintaining road slope of 5%) the platform being made by reducing the mountain on the east of the plot initially to foundation level and using the selected graded rock to elevate the existing plot ground level to foundation level(or foot of piling level)by backfilling, levelling, grading & compacting. When foundation level (or foot of piling level) is achieved by using the same methodology the elevation will be increased to +15m MSL using a suitable size capping layer. Priority is to be given to completion of the RAECo sub-station area to enable others to meet their schedule, the substation is within the plot area at +15m MSL. As well as creating the platform other activities but not limited to include: controlled blasting using laser face profiling & vibration monitoring, mountain stabilisation, storm & site drainage, access roads, rerouting of any existing infrastructure (e.g. Omantel cable), excavation of foundation areas, steel fixing & concrete works, backfill to structures, effective dust suppression by means of high pressure misting systems on any crusher/screening systems and fog machines in quarry working areas, An area of land reclamation will be constructed for ROP and/or the Owners use on the southern side of the existing jetty in front of the project site, using all of excess rocky material arising from the site excavations estimated to be 1.5 million cubic metres as the Base Case. Reclamation for the area north side of the existing jetty, in front of the project site is an Option Case. Due to the close proximity of the MGP & ROP border post, pushing down of material from the mountain will not be permitted and hauling of material using suitable dump trucks must be used to reduce dust emissions Although International Standards have been used extensively in this Specification, equivalent Oman codes and standards whose use is a statutory requirement or the norm in the construction industry in Oman will be acceptable provided a comprehensive list of these codes and standards is included with the proposal. Where Oman codes and standards do not exist to cover the full scope of work, other recognized and accepted international standards may be used only if they are explicitly stated in the proposal. The following example of the inspection & test plan for the early civil work is attached Sample Inspection & Test Plan showing minimum requirements for Earthworks and Land reclamation
PAGE 120
Activity
Controlling Document
Frequency
Specification limits
Material Verification Rock Suitable for Embankment (+7m to +13m MSL) Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.5.2 1 test per 8000 cubic meters with not less than 1 test per material type. For every change in material type Maximum particle size = loose layer thickness 25% maximum passes 0.42 mm (sieve #40)
Rock suitable for Land reclamation +2m high tide level to +4m MSL
Soil Suitable for Embankment (+13m to +15m MSL) Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.5.2
1 test per 3000 cubic meters with not less than 1 test per material type. For every change in material type
loose layer thickness Maximum dry density not less than 1.7 T/m3 Gypsum content not more than 5% No use of A-6, A7 soil Plasticity Index less than 20% 4-day soaked CBR should not be less than 8% Organic Matter not more than 5%
Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.7.3
1 test per 500 cubic meters with not less than 1 test per material type. For every change in material type
Site Preparation Protect existing services SP-1279-C Cl.2.5.2 During operations No damage to existing utilities & facilities during earthwork operations Complete removal of trash and debris
SP-1279-C Cl.2.4
Before Backfilling
Surveying Marking Establish benchmarks Approved plans Each area of Horizontal : 6mm allowable
PAGE 121
Rock suitable for Land reclamation +2m high tide level to +4m MSL Soil Embankment (0-100mm) Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.5.3 Each fill layer 250 mm compacted thickness for layers in excess of 1.5 m from final level 200 mm compacted thickness for other layers
Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.7.3
Compaction & Field tests Rock-fill Embankment Compaction Plate Load Bearing test Compactometer test Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.5.3
Max. Settlement 0.5 % of the average compacted layer thickness Allowable bearing capacity = 25 Ton/m2 to be confirmed in design
Rock suitable for Land reclamation +2m high tide level to +4m MSL Soil Embankment Compaction Sultanate of Oman , Standard Specification for Road & Bridge Construction 2010, Clause 2.5.4
Each layer compacted at least 90% of Modified Maximum Density as per AASHTO T-180 and at moisture content between 1% above and 2% below the optimum for compaction, 95% of Modified Maximum Density as per AASHTO T-180 for layers 600mm below final level
PAGE 122
Each layer compacted at least 95% of Modified Maximum Density as per AASHTO T-180
Grading Finish Grade area Soil Embankment & Land reclamation SP-1279-C, Clause C2.8.2 Final surface finish elevation of each area of operation Even and smooth surface and all voids are filled Level shall be within a tolerance 15mm from the required levels
Rock Armour Rock properties Armourstone Part 1:Specification BS EN 13383-1:2002 Armourstone Part 2: Test methods BS EN 13383-2:2002 Gradation Approved plans & Armourstone Part 2: Test methods BS EN 13383-2:2002 Surveyed to approved plans Surveyed to approved plans Inspected to approved plans
9.1.2.
A construction programme shall be submitted to the Owner within 28 days of Limited Notice to Proceed or Notice to Proceed whichever occurs earlier. Once agreed by the Owner, this programme shall become the Contract Construction programme. The EPC Contractor shall prepare comprehensive method statements & inspection & test plans for all major construction activities and submit these to the Owner for review at least fifteen days prior to the commencement of the relevant activity. The method statements shall include, but not be limited to, working methods for earthworks& quarrying, blasting, rock bolting, shotcreting, gabion basket installation, rip rap installation, , geotextile installation on land reclamation, surveying, working at height, lifting, heavy mobile plant maintenance & brake testing schemes, temporary works, construction sequence, environmental considerations, quality control and safety arrangements. Hours of work should be identified & the owner
PAGE 123
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification informed at least 48 hours prior to any night work taking place, a permit for night work must be obtained and HSSE needs addressed (e.g. lighting, supervision, HSSE coverage, QC coverage etc..)
9.1.3.
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for seeking outline and detailed planning permission. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the timely submission to any relevant authority of such details of his proposals for the works as will be necessary to comply with all relevant legislation. The EPC Contractor, and allowance shall make the application for all costs related thereto, including any statutory charges, shall be deemed to be included in the proposal.
9.1.4.
Site investigation
The Owner has been advised that from natural ground level to optimum (with regard to optimising plot surface area and maintaining road slope of 5%) design foundation elevation(or foot of piling) rock debris and cutting soil is used as filling material by selecting suitable size fill material. Top filling layer from design foundation level (or foot of piling) to (+) 15.0 MSL shall be compacted and filled by granular soil. Since there exists the possibility of settlement, the EPC Contractor shall review the need for pile foundations. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for fully assessing for himself surfaces and sub-surface ground conditions by his own detailed site investigation should the EPC Contractor deem necessary. The EPC Contractor shall be fully responsible for arranging his own site survey, geotechnical, hydrogeological, contamination, bathometric and hydrological investigations which are necessary to fully assess surface and sub-surface conditions on Site. All site investigations shall comply with a standard to the agreement of the Owner. All geotechnical and contamination laboratory testing shall be conducted in a laboratory with an auditable quality control system in accordance with the specification and to the agreement of the Owner. The EPC Contractors scope of work and method statement for and standards used in carrying out the site survey and geotechnical investigation, borehole layout etc, shall be submitted to the Owner as a design intent memorandum (DIM) for agreement not less than four weeks before the site investigation work commences. The EPC Contractor shall submit to the Owner all factual and interpretative reports on the geotechnical investigation as the work proceeds, followed by an interpretative final report for the Owners agreement containing complete borehole logs, results of in situ and laboratory testing and a full description of ground conditions and material properties, any geotechnical and contamination risks to the project and geotechnical design criteria for earthworks, underground structures, foundations, ground improvement, infiltration drainage, groundwater abstraction and pavement design. The cost of all surveys, geotechnical, geological, hydrological and meteorological investigation work shall be deemed to be included in the EPC Contractors proposal. The EPC Contractor shall submit details of any further site investigation works he proposes to carry out prior to and during the construction of the Works.
9.1.5.
Environmental considerations
The EPC Contractor shall make sufficient provision both in his programme and his proposal to include for: a) b) Protection of the environment, both during construction and operation, from contamination, dust, siltation and erosion; The remedial treatment or removal/replacement of any unsuitable strata of material;
PAGE 124
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification c) d) The remedial treatment or removal/replacement of any contaminated soils; The EPC Contractor shall comply with all requirements and recommendations contained within the Environmental Impact Assessment which shall be prepared before the commencement of project construction activities ; The results of contamination testing of soils, groundwater and surface waters shall be compared to site specific assessment criteria or trigger concentrations to determine if remediation or disposal of contaminated soils is required. Qualitative risk assessment shall be used to determine if remediation is required; Operation license regarding burnout sources shall be obtained from the Inspection and Environmental Control Department of the Ministry as per the requirements of the Ministerial Decree No. 118/ 2004.; Transfer of coral reefs , Plan to manage marine environment during project and transfer of coral reefs, mathematical model in order to monitor changes to coastal strip as well as the topography; Translocation of any corals must be carried out in accordance with any plans approved by MECA.; and Diesel and waste oil must be stored in leak proof bunds as approved by MECA.
e)
f) g) h) i)
9.2.
The civil works to be provided by the EPC Contractor under the turnkey contract shall comprise investigations and studies as necessary, the full detailed design, preparation of construction drawings, site levelling, construction, completion and maintenance of the works until the end of the Defects Liability Period. The scope of the Works shall include, but not be limited to, the following items: a) b) c) Any further site topographical survey, site investigation: geotechnical, hydrogeological, contamination, meteorological, bathymetric, coral habitat and hydrological surveys, as required. Any further data collection (including verification of any design data provided in the Specification). Site preparation , site development site strip, bulk excavation and filling, grading, primary and storm drainage systems, any ground improvement and stabilization works (including preparatory backfilling and grading work for a future Phase 2 extension of the plant) and preparation of the RAECo substation area within the +15m MSL plot area.. The Base Case implementation of land reclamation on the western side of Khasab highway, south of the existing jetty, opposite the MIPP site, for the use of the ROP/Owner and relocation of and monitoring of coral, located on the north side of the jetty with 0.3 hectare in area, if approval is obtained. For the Option Case, land reclamation and relocation of and monitoring of coral will take place on the western side of the Khasab highway to the north of the existing jetty, opposite MIPP plot. During construction, including early civil & civil works, the EPC Contractor shall supply 4 offices for the Owners representatives, each office capable of housing 2 people and supply food for 8 people at the EPC Contractors canteen at lunch times. Building works, foundations, structures, all necessary welfare facilities, mess rooms, toilets, shower(s), locker facilities and building services for the installation, operation and maintenance of plant and equipment, fitting out and furnishing for the following:
d)
e)
Gas engine and generator foundations, building, laydown areas, supporting structures and craneage; Central control building; Electrical equipment building; Storage tank foundations and containment;
PAGE 125
4)
Fuel treatment building; Fire fighting pump foundations and sunscreen; Administration, workshop and stores building(s); Gatehouse / Guardhouse; Water treatment container; Fuel Oil unloading facility
Any other ancillary buildings necessary for the proper functioning of the Plant; Transformer and compounds for auxiliary transformers including steelwork, ground work, slabs, firewalls and finishing works; Fin fan radiator system.
5)
Service ways, trenches, pipe racks and bridges; Cableways, ducts, trenches; Foundations, plinths, bunds, culverts, access ladders and miscellaneous metalwork items water storage tanks, oil storage tanks, fire water tanks etc.
New access and site roads, hard standings, car parks, footpaths. To include also construction of access roads on-Site and connection to the off-Site access roads that may be necessary for access by others (RAECO) to Phase 2, electricity transmission and Gas Metering Facilities. Agreement with ROP should be obtained for access through the MGP site for delivery of abnormal loads during the construction period. Storm, foul, oily and chemical waste water drainage and underground services. Raw water supplies. Miscellaneous foundations and trenches for mechanical and electrical installation. Builders work associated with building services installation.
6) 7) 8) 9)
10) Security walls/fencing/gates/signage and lighting in accordance with Royal Oman Police (ROP) standards. 11) All temporary installations for the construction period, including Owners office. 12) Building services. 13) Application of protective coatings. 14) Site finishing works including hard landscaping, trimming, grading and protection. All aspects of the civil works shall be designed and constructed in accordance with this Specification, basic design data included therein and the referenced codes of practice and standards. All personnel employed by the EPC Contractor shall be competent and be able to demonstrate a combination of suitable experience and approved training and any other relevant qualities. All people in responsible charge down to supervisor level will have successfully completed an IOSH managing safely course or equivalent. No senior person shall be removed from the project without the Owners approval. All senior personnel above supervisor CVs to be reviewed by the owner. All drivers on the project will successfully complete a defensive drivers permit, and failure to wear seatbelts, or using a mobile phone while driving will be instant dismissal offenses, speeding will be three written warnings and then removal from the Site;
PAGE 126
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification A geotechnical specialist shall be employed by the EPC Contractor to evaluate measures required for slope stabilisation in design stage and during construction; The EPC Contractor shall ensure that all non-Omani employees (including those of any Subcontractors) have valid entry visas, residence permits, labour cards or any other documentation required by the Applicable Law; The EPC Contractor shall ensure that all employees (including those of any Subcontractors) who are required to drive any vehicles as part of their duties are in possession of a valid driving license acceptable to the Royal Oman Police and the Company whilst carrying out those duties; Visa, residence, labour and multiple entry road permits for working, driving licenses, work permits, and journey management plans shall not be part of the Permit plan; Should any Permit, have a limited duration, which expires before the completion of the activity of the Work to which it relates, the EPC Contractor shall include renewal of the Permit, in the Permit plan; Time delays in arranging/obtaining/issuance/renewal of Permits, shall not form the basis of any Variation to the Contract and is fully the EPC Contractors responsibility; EPC Contractor shall appoint an Omani public relations officer for overall coordination of the project public relations and external relations requirements. He shall be based at the EPC Contractors site offices during the construction phase; The EPC Contractor shall obtain the following Permits, if required including, but not limited to the following: 1. Consent to extract soil for construction purposes 2. Royal Oman Police notifications and approvals as well as well as the use transport and storage of explosives 3. Permits for temporary or permanent rerouting or relocation of roads, power lines and telecommunications and temporary camp site approvals (Municipality, ROP any other Governmental Authority.) 4. Handling and Storage of Chemicals and Hazardous Substances Permit to extract water for an Reverse Osmosis (RO) plant Permit to discharge RO reject water 5. Permit to dispose of wastewater 6. Permit to dispose of any construction waste 7. Permit to handle , store and to dispose of any other waste including Hazardous Substances 8. Approval from Ministry of Awqaf and Religious Affairs (MARA) regarding works adjacent to the graveyard.
It is not intended that this Specification cover every particular aspect of civil works design and construction. This, however, shall not relieve the EPC Contractor of his responsibility for the satisfactory design, construction, completion and maintenance of the entire civil works, whether specified or not, necessary for the safe and proper operation of mechanical and electrical plant provided. It is essential that the EPC Contractor should visit the Site before preparing his proposal for the purpose of examining the extent and nature of the work and means of access to the site, to familiarize and satisfy himself with respect to local and site conditions and to ascertain for himself the availability of all labour, workers accommodation, water supply, fuel supply, temporary laydown areas, plant and materials for the satisfactory execution of the works within the overall project programme. The proposal shall be deemed to meet all local and site conditions and restrictions.
PAGE 127
9.3. 9.3.1.
The EPC Contractors design of all buildings, plant enclosures and exposed plant shall be visually compatible with the surroundings and shall be designed for a life expectancy of 25 years. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for developing the overall architectural concept for the Plant, within the broad guidelines provided herein. He shall submit with his proposal the architectural treatment for main and ancillary buildings, taking account of the visual impact and function of the buildings, whilst observing the requirements set out elsewhere in this Specification. The architectural concept for the station buildings, including colour schemes and finishes schedules, shall be finalized and agreed with the Owner at an early stage in the design process. Main plant and ancillary buildings shall have structural steelwork frames, with upper levels and roofs having profile colour coated cladding of noise insulated double skin construction and with sandwich panel construction. Administration and minor buildings may be of sandwich panel construction. All buildings shall be designed to ensure that noise, vibration, temperature and dust levels are kept within acceptable limits to provide proper operating conditions for the plant which is to be installed and a comfortable working environment for the Owners operations and maintenance staff throughout the year. The construction of all buildings shall take into account the need to achieve all specified and regulatory noise restrictions. Provision shall be made in the designs for the maintenance of all high level buildings, internally and externally. Buildings shall be designed to comply with the relevant parts of the international or Oman regulations covering: Fire precautions in the design and construction of buildings; Code of practice for fire precautions in Plant. Design calculations and analyses shall take into account the most unfavourable combination of static, seismic, dynamic, erection and laydown loads and loads due to temperature and shrinkage effects, to which the structure or component part may be subjected, both for the serviceability and ultimate limit states. Methods of computation and magnitude of loads shall be in accordance with the relevant standards and codes of practices. For rotating machinery foundations the pedestal/foundation/soil system shall be designed for safe operation of the machine at any load within the speed range, without resonant vibration of the whole or any part of the system. Machine foundations shall be suitably isolated from all surrounding floor slabs and structural framing. The EPC Contractor shall provide all building services (electricity, telephone, computer, water, HVAC, fire protection etc), as specified in the Specification and ensure that they are readily accessible for maintenance and repair and adequate clearance is provided from main structural members and foundations. The extent and layout of new roads shall provide suitable access to, and within, the new plant in order to allow erection and maintenance works to be undertaken effectively and with minimum disruption.
PAGE 128
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The dimensions of buildings shall provide adequate space for the safe installation and operation of all plant and equipment and for maintenance procedures to be carried out by the Owner. All buildings shall be provided with roof drainage for disposal of storm water and be connected to the station storm water drainage system. A separate foul sewerage system for the station buildings draining shall be provided. The design of the sewage system should comply with the provisions of the regulation governing such matter issued by Ministerial Decree No. 421/98 and all procedures should be taken to prevent flooding from tanks. A waste water system shall be provided for the station. The EPC Contractor shall submit a design intent memorandum, which is to be reviewed and agreed with the Owner, describing the concept and design of the system. The design should allow for the separate collection, treatment and disposal of: Oily wastewater arising from run-off, plant buildings, oil related operations and from major spillages; Chemical waste water drainage arising from purge water and draining down systems which have been chemically dosed. Chemical waste water shall be drained to a neutralisation pit where it shall be adequately treated before discharge.
9.3.2. 9.3.2.1.
The EPC Contractor shall provide permanent office and administration facilities in accordance with the general design requirements detailed elsewhere in this Specification. The building(s) shall be designed in accordance with international or Oman regulatory requirements (whichever is the more stringent) and be appropriately sized to accommodate the proposed number of operating and administration personnel. The building shall be designed to ensure efficient and safe operation of the plant over the design lifetime of the plant and under full ambient design conditions detailed for the site. The EPC Contractor shall provide as a minimum the following offices and messing facilities: Offices for the following staff: 1 1 2 8 2 2 16 Plant Manager Operations Supervisor Accountant Plant Engineer Secretary/Clerk Visitors office Total individual offices
The following rooms are also required in the same area: Kitchen and lunchroom area; Prayer room; 2- Conference room (large enough for 12 people);
PAGE 129
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Mens locker/change facility (with toilets, showers, lockers, etc) for 50 operators; Womens locker/change facility (with toilets, showers, lockers, etc) for 10 operators; Copier and fax room; and Supplies room. Provisions are also needed near the control room and equipment room for the C&I engineers office, where the DCS engineers console shall be installed.
9.3.2.2.
The EPC Contractor shall provide a dedicated site workshop and store rooms to enable all routine maintenance activities to be undertaken in a sheltered environment with ease of access to all utility services. The store rooms shall include a tool store, materials/spare storage room. A separate electrical workshop shall be provided. The workshop shall be fully equipped to allow for the efficient maintenance and operation of the Plant, which shall have an office equipped with telephone and electrical connections and adequate lighting and ventilation provisions.
9.3.3.
Materials
All materials shall conform to the latest edition of the relevant international or Oman or other standards cited within this Specification. Samples of all materials for the works may be called for at any time by the Owner and shall be furnished by the EPC Contractor free of charge and without delay. The cost of all routine tests required by the adopted standard shall be borne by the EPC Contractor.
9.3.4. 9.3.4.1.
The EPC Contractor shall prepare for the whole of the works and each discrete section thereof a design basis statement. The design basis statement which shall be made available for agreement by the Owner within four weeks of the Notice to Proceed shall include, but not be limited to: a. Foundation design concept 1. Loading conditions
Dead Superimposed and live loading in accordance with international or Oman standards Plant and equipment including for laydown areas Wind loading in accordance with international or Oman standards Seismic design UBC Seismic Zone 2A
15) Load case combinations As required by relevant international or Oman standards and codes of practice.
16) Steel design parameters Design concept fixed, pinned, portal, braced Grades and sources of steel
PAGE 130
Protective coatings Quality Control / Quality Assurance compliance testing and acceptance criteria of materials and welding
17) Concrete
Grade(s) Cover requirements Mix designs and admixtures Sources of materials and compliance with standards Batching and curing strategy Sulphate class Quality Control / Quality Assurance compliance testing and acceptance criteria
18) Reinforcement Types Grade of steel Quality Control and Quality Assurance of materials
19) Other materials selection Materials selected for drainage and duct runs Materials selected for brickwork/blockwork construction Materials selected for architectural finishes and builders work
20) Earthworks Cut and fill balance (material densities to be considered) Selected engineering parameters for all soils identified at the site Material properties and availability of imported fill materials Compaction methods including ground improvement Acceptance criteria and compliance testing including testing frequencies Formation levels Landscaping levels and finishes
21) Pavements Design loads Geometry and swept path analysis Selected engineering parameters for formation soils and construction materials Compaction methods Acceptance criteria and compliance testing including testing frequency
The design basis statement shall also clearly state the codes of practice to be used for design and material specification applicable to the entire scope of civil works. English translations of the relevant codes and standards, where necessary, shall be provided by the EPC Contractor.
9.3.4.2.
Loadings
PAGE 131
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The Site is exposed to a seismic hazard induced by the seismically active Iranian coast. The Site is located in the Arabian Peninsula, identified as the rigid Arabian plate, which is a quiet zone. However in the mountain range along the eastern coast of Yemen, Oman and the United Arab Emirates, the existence of some minor faults increases the chances of earthquakes in the area.
Based on this, and considering the UBC with Seismic Zone 2A, earthquake loads shall be considered. The earthquake calculations shall be made in accordance with the latest UBC standards, international standards and Oman standards. Uniform Building Code 1997 for Seismic Design to Seismic Zone 2A
Fifty (50) year return period values shall be used for environmental loading as appropriate.
9.3.4.3.
Foundations
The design of the foundations for the engines, generators and other plant foundations subject to dynamic loads shall be in accordance with Eurocode 2. All other plant foundations and building foundations shall be designed in accordance with the applicable Eurocode or ACI standards. In the design of plant foundations, due account should be taken of settlement criteria required by plant manufacturers. The EPC Contractor shall state in his calculations the maximum permissible foundation movement that may be tolerated consistent with normal operation of the Plant. Foundations should be designed with a factor of safety in accordance with the applicable standard. For normal loads, the foundation designs shall be based on a stress distribution of 100 per cent compression on the underside of the base (eccentricity of loading < L/6) and within the allowable bearing capacity of the soil. For foundations with overturning moments, the following shall be satisfied: Uni-axial bending: eccentricity < L/4; Biaxial bending: 70 per cent of the base area to be effective in compression; and Allowable bearing capacity of the soil not to be exceeded. Permissible settlements for foundations shall not exceed settlement criteria imposed by plant manufacturers or shall conform with the following, whichever is more stringent:
Foundation Gas engine and generator foundation Other plant Buildings and miscellaneous structures Flexible tank foundations Total Settlement 10mm 15mm 25mm Differential Settlement 5mm 10mm 15mm Gradient 1 in 750 1 in 500 1 in 300
9.3.4.4.
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for all matters relating to design, construction, setting out, installation and testing of piles.
PAGE 132
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification All piles shall be designed with an ultimate load bearing capacity a minimum of 2.5 x the allowable pile capacity required for the pile. This factor of safety shall apply to compression, tension and horizontal loads. Group effects and negative skin friction (as appropriate) shall be allowed for in the design of the piles. The allowable load capacity and settlement characteristics shall be calculated using soil mechanics methods. Authoritative texts shall be used throughout the design. A 25 year design life shall be assumed in the design. Preliminary test piles shall be constructed and tested before the installation of working piles unless otherwise instructed by the Owner. The location of the preliminary test piles together with any reaction piles shall be agreed with the Owner prior to installation. On completion of the preliminary tests, piles shall be cut down to a minimum of 2m below ground level and backfilled. Preliminary test piles shall be subject to static maintained load testing to a load equal to 2.5x the design safe working load. A minimum of 2 preliminary pile tests for compression, tension and horizontal loads for each proposed type and size of pile shall be conducted. The performance of the preliminary test piles shall be reviewed against expected load bearing and settlement characteristics predicted by calculation. Should the preliminary test piles fail to achieve the specified design characteristics the EPC Contractor shall either modify the design of the pile or down-rate the allowable pile load. The EPC Contractor shall also carry out proof load testing on 1% of each type and size of pile installed or a minimum of 3 piles, whichever is the greater. The piles to be tested shall be selected by the Owner. The proof load shall be 1.5x the allowable pile capacity. Piles shall be tested using static maintained load testing procedures. Static maintained load testing shall be carried out in accordance with the UK Institution of Civil Engineers Specification for Piling and Embedded Retaining Walls 1996 or equivalent international standard agreed by the Owner Permissible pile settlements at proof load shall not exceed settlement criteria imposed by plant manufacturers or shall conform with the following, whichever is more stringent:
Foundation reciprocating engine and generator foundation Other plant Building and miscellaneous structures Total Settlement 10mm 15mm 15mm Differential settlement 5mm 10mm 10mm Gradient 1 in 750 1 in 500 1 in 300
Integrity testing shall be carried out on all piles installed at site using non-destructive testing techniques.
9.3.4.5.
Earthworks
All earthworks, including initial site preparation and grading, shall be designed and carried out in accordance with Eurocode 7. Suitable fill materials, whether selected from excavated material or imported from quarries, shall be used throughout. Any explosive blasting shall be to the Owners agreement. The EPC Contractor shall carry out material compliance testing and in-situ compaction testing of placed fill materials at frequencies stated in the design basis statement and agreed with the Owner. The range of
PAGE 133
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification testing required shall be agreed with the Owner prior to the commencement of earthworks operations. Compaction shall be carried out to minimize ground movements and foundation settlement.
9.3.4.6.
The following standards or equivalent Oman or international standards shall apply as appropriate.
9.3.4.7.
Security
The EPC Contractor shall fence off the Site and take all reasonable precautions to safeguard the health and safety of all persons, whether or not they are his employees, from all construction and construction related activities. The EPC Contractors proposals for security shall be submitted to the Owner. The exact delineation of the EPC Contractors site shall be established and agreed with the Owner prior to the commencement of the works. The Plant design shall include suitable security systems such as perimeter security fences. Facilities for security personnel such as a guard house and mechanised site access gates shall also be included.
9.3.5.
The EPC Contractor shall provide construction and access roads on-Site and connection to the off- Site access roads including any permanent roads offsite that may be necessary for access to Phase 2, electricity transmission and Gas Metering Facilities. An access road will be required at the south west side of the site of a suitable slope to allow ease of access to the heaviest piece of equipment for the plant approximately 5% (to be verified by calculation by the EPC Contractor). A second access road, with a suitable gradient for lighter vehicles of approximately 8% (to be verified by the EPC Contractor), .is to be constructed at the North West side of the Site. A permanent graded road is to be built to provide maintenance of the benching of the site and to provide access to any transmission equipment on the mountain, this should be 10% maximum slope and have suitable edge protection and 5 metre wide All materials, workmanship and testing shall be in accordance with the procedures of the Oman transport and highways authority (MOTC). All areas of roads or hard standing that could be subjected to a fuel, oil or chemical spillage shall be constructed in concrete. During construction on Site a traffic management scheme must be submitted to the owner for review and this should incorporate a one way system where possible with proper signage. Roads on the mountain must have adequate edge protection, suitable gradients, signage, run off points where possible and be 3 times the width of the largest machine and properly maintained, during development passing places must be provided. Temporary roads during construction period shall be suitable for transporting and positioning plant and equipment. The new permanent road system within the site shall be designed in accordance with AASHTO 2001 or equivalent international or Oman standard to allow for adequate access and emergency situations during
PAGE 134
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification operation and maintenance of both the Plant. The layout of the access roads and pavings serving the various plant items shall be designed to allow safe manoeuvrability and hard standing for all necessary deliveries. All access roads to and within the site shall be repaired to the satisfaction of the Owner on completion of the works and the Oman highway authority. Junctions with existing public roads shall be designed and constructed to comply with the requirements of the Oman highways authority. Design loads shall take account of the abnormal and heavy loads which occur during Plant construction and operation, box culverts are required under the access roads and they too shall be designed to carry required loads. Major access roads shall be 7 m wide and shall include the necessary kerbs, drainage, road markings and signs. Radii shall be provided on turning areas and corners that are suitable for transporting plant during the construction period and for maintenance purposes. Roads shall be constructed in asphaltic concrete or hot rolled asphalt, except that concrete paving shall be provided where Fuel Oil or chemical spillages may occur. Road markings and signs shall be in accordance with relevant Oman standards. Footpaths shall be of 1500 mm nominal width and designed for an accidental wheel load of 20 kN. Footpaths shall be either precast concrete flags or hot rolled asphalt. Within the plant area height limit gauges shall be provided where height clearances are limited and in particular where there is danger from overhead lines. Safety barriers shall be provided where there are exceptional local hazards or where specific plant protection is required. These barriers shall be of the Armco or substantial bollard type and be removable.
9.3.5.1.
Drainage
The EPC Contractor shall install the following drainage systems for the station: a) b) c) d) Surface water drainage; Foul water drainage; Oil/water drainage; and Chemical waste water drainage.
Drainage pipework shall be designed and constructed in accordance with Eurocode 7. Pipe materials shall be compatible for the chemical composition and temperature of effluent discharged through them. Underground pipework design, particularly at the interface with buildings, structures and chambers shall take into account the effect of seismic loading.
PAGE 135
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The capacity of the surface water drainage system, including perimeter surface water run-off interceptor ditches, shall be designed in accordance with Oman drainage authority procedures and storm parameters. A fifty year return period shall be used for the design. The design of the pipework shall be in accordance with BS EN 752 and the pipe manufacturers recommendations in respect of pipe grade, trench dimensions, pipe bedding and protection. Recognized and accepted design procedures shall be used in establishing design loads on buried pipelines. Manhole and chamber covers shall be heavy duty throughout.
Sewage drainage
Pipework shall be designed to accommodate flows as a result of the maximum number of staff required to operate the plant excluding maintenance personnel present during major overhauls etc. The pipework shall be sized and laid to falls so that appropriate self cleansing velocities are maintained throughout the system. The sewage drainage system shall discharge to a sewage treatment system. If raw water is to be abstracted from groundwater the septic tank shall be positioned so that any leakage from it will not be drawn into the well(s). The septic tank shall be located on the site in a location where leakage from it is unlikely to cause contamination.
The EPC Contractor shall design and install an oily wastewater drainage system which shall effectively drain all areas where oil spillages could occur. The design shall incorporate bunded areas, oil interceptors and traps. The oily water buffer tank shall be supplied with a single level transmitter. Bunds provided in transformer compounds, oil storage areas, lube oil tanks and such like shall have an impounding capacity 1.1 times the largest possible oil spillage that could occur. Facilities shall be provided to contain oil and protect the environment in the event of a catastrophic failure of the transformer. The EPC Contractor shall provide adequate facilities for the inspection and maintenance of oil interception equipment. Chemical waste water drainage Chemical waste water drainage systems shall be provided for all plant discharges which may have been contaminated with chemicals and metals. Such flows include, but are not limited to, purge water and process streams which have been chemically dosed. Such effluent streams shall be collected to local or a central collection or neutralisation pit prior to off-site disposal or neutralisation/treatment. Chemical waste water shall be treated so that it meets the requirements of the World Bank standards and the requirements of the Environmental Impact Assessment before discharge.
PAGE 136
9.3.5.2.
Buried pressure pipelines for water mains, fire water mains and rising mains for drainage shall be designed in accordance with BS EN 1295 or equivalent international standards and parameters required by the Owner. All pipelines carrying fuel/oils shall be installed in sealed ducts to prevent ground contamination in the event of a pipework leak. Underground pipework design, particularly at the interface with buildings, structures and chambers shall take into account the effect of seismic loading.
9.3.5.3.
Buried services
Ducts and chambers for electrical, mechanical and telecommunication services shall be designed in accordance with the relevant international or Oman standards and regulations Chambers, drawpits and manholes shall incorporate a drainage sump. Where practicable the sump shall be linked to the appropriate drainage system.
9.3.5.4.
The following is indicative of the type of corrosion protection surface preparation and painting: Main and secondary steelwork Cladding rails and roof purlins (all areas) In accordance with this Specification. Hot dip galvanized fixed with spun galvanized or sherardized bolts.
Where fire protection is required this shall be by an intumescent paint system in exposed situations (subject to required fire rating being achievable) or, where concealed, a fire resistant board system shall be acceptable.
9.4.
Deviations from the materials specified in this section may be permitted in order to comply with local building practice and availability, provided the substitute materials are similar to those specified and are agreed by the Owner.
9.4.1.
Notwithstanding the following outline specifications, cladding and roof decking shall be chosen, designed, detailed and constructed to achieve both the acoustic and thermal requirements for the plant and building operation.
9.4.1.1.
Wall cladding, where used, shall be metal sheet to a profile and colour agreed by the Owner. The wall cladding system shall incorporate an acoustic lining system designed to ensure that the acoustic requirements of the project are met.
9.4.1.2.
Roof decking, where used, shall be metal sheet to a colour and profile agreed with the Owner. The decking system shall have sufficient strength to allow personnel access for maintenance purposes. The roof decking system shall incorporate an acoustic lining system designed to ensure that the acoustic requirements of the project are met.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 137
9.4.1.3.
Fixings
Fixing of sheeting, flashings and cappings etc. shall be compatible with the sheeting system.
9.4.1.4.
Acoustic requirements
Specific requirements are stated for the maximum increase in noise levels from the completed buildings and these shall be taken into account in the design and detailing of the cladding and roof systems to ensure that the specified noise levels are achieved.
9.4.1.5.
Decking shall be laid to ensure they are straight and to an even and correct gradient. The panels shall be fixed to steel support beams in a manner recommended by the manufacturer.
9.4.1.6.
Cladding shall be fixed to ensure they are straight and even and true to line. The panels shall be fixed to the cladding rails in a manner recommended by the manufacturers.
9.4.1.7.
Cutting
If hole cutting is required on site to accommodate penetrations, this shall be done using a motorized disc cutter and/or hole saw or nibbler. Acetylene cutting shall not be allowed. Suitable flashings shall be provided.
9.4.1.8.
Venting
Roof vents shall be required to ventilate the voids immediately below the roof sheeting.
9.4.1.9.
Flashings
All flashing, trims and sills associated with wall and roof cladding shall match the cladding/roofing system. They shall be detailed and installed to fully close off any potential air, noise or water transmission.
9.4.1.11. Glazing
Glazing panels may be incorporated into the wall and roof cladding.
9.4.1.12. Windows
Windows incorporated into the external wall cladding shall be complete with all flashings and be fully sealed to substrate. The vapour barrier and breather membrane shall be fully sealed to the windows.
PAGE 138
9.4.2.
Fire resistant doors are made of steel profiles and steel sheet plates insulated with mineral wool, surface treatment and painting similar as other steel structures All doors shall be complete with ironmongery including locking arrangements, handles and where appropriate emergency escape facilities. Locking shall adopt a site master key system to be agreed with the Owner.
9.4.3.
If agreed with the Owner that doors and frames should not be metal, they shall be of an agreed hardwood. The doors shall have fire resistance appropriate to the fire rating of the building. Fire resisting door sets shall be installed in a manner to ensure continuity of the fire resistance between the frame and the surrounding fire wall. Vision panels shall be incorporated into fire doors with hardwood beads detailed so as not to compromise the required level of fire rating. All door sets shall be complete with ironmongery including locking arrangements handles and where appropriate, emergency escape facilities. Locking shall accord with the site master key system to be agreed with the Owner.
9.4.4.
Louvred doors
Where applicable, doors shall be manufactured in hardwood. The top rail shall be 148 x 50 mm, with middle and bottom rails 246 x 50 mm. The top and bottom panels shall be formed with hardwood louvre blades, each size 70 x 10 set at 45 to throw rainwater to th e external face. The EPC Contractor shall prepare a detailed drawing, to be reviewed by the Owner prior to manufacture commencing.
9.4.5.
Vision panels
Internal vision panels in blockwork walls shall be of a design to match the door sets in the relevant room. Where appropriate the fire rating shall be the same as that of the wall in which they are situated and glazing shall comply with the requirements of the Oman regulations.
9.4.6.
Masonry
Masonry walls shall be constructed in dense concrete blocks, fair face blocks built fair face where exposed in final construction. In all areas with suspended ceilings, the blockwork shall be finished with two coats of plaster and painted, the remainder shall be fair faced, sealed and painted. Necessary measures are to be taken to ensure structural stability of masonry free standing walls. Vision panels shall be provided in the masonry walls to satisfy operational requirements. In office areas, where if applicable, external blockwork skins are to be provided full height, to minimum 150 mm above the false ceiling (if provided), and finished to match other internal walls. The construction of external walls shall be in accordance with relevant international or Oman construction requirements.
PAGE 139
9.4.7.
Rainwater pipes shall be aluminium or galvanized mild steel, medium gauge. Pipes shall generally be straight and plumb fixed to structural steel columns. They shall be complete with suitable bends for connection to outlets and to drainage with brackets for support from columns. All rainwater pipes shall be routed externally. Jointing compound where required shall be compatible with the rainwater pipe system. Inspection covers shall be provided, suitably sealed, to all pipes immediately above ground floor level.
9.4.8.
Suspended ceilings
Suspended ceilings shall be installed to all circulation areas, toilets, control rooms, offices and the like, with recessed light fittings used in all such areas. Toilet areas shall have plain thermal tiles. Light fittings shall be supported independently of the ceilings. Ceiling tiles, electrical and other components shall be entirely compatible in all respects.
9.4.9.
Damp proofing
The design and installation shall fully comply with the requirements of Oman regulations. Proposals for the type and detailing of all damp proofing shall be submitted for review by the Owner.
9.4.10. Stairs
Stairs are to be provided to suit all requirements for means of escape, and the stairs and balustrades are to be designed to satisfy the detailed requirements of the Oman regulations.
PAGE 140
9.4.12.3. Schedules
Colour/finishes schedules shall be provided showing proposals for all surfaces both site and factory finished and submitted for review by the Owner.
9.5. 9.5.1.
Civil construction activities shall be carried out to the relevant international or Oman standards and codes of practice in terms of materials and workmanship. The latest edition of such documents shall be used, including all current amendments and additions.
9.5.2.
Materials
Samples, technical descriptions and sources of supply of materials shall be submitted where required by the Specification to the Owner.
9.5.3.
Certification of materials
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining any certificates required by the Specification or a relevant international or Oman standard, together with the results of any tests on such materials that are required by the Specification and the relevant international or Oman standards. The EPC Contractor shall submit to the Owner a statement detailing his test procedures and testing schedule for any site manufactured materials.
9.5.4.
The EPC Contractor shall provide, for approval, details of plant and equipment to be used in the construction of the civil works including his proposed construction craneage strategy.
9.5.5.
All survey, setting out and levelling shall be carried out in accordance with good working practices using instruments and equipment which shall be regularly checked and calibrated. Information regarding site datum levels and co-ordinates shall be provided by the Owner. Setting out stations shall be accurately positioned at locations to be agreed with the Owner and shall be adequately protected from damage during the construction of the works. The EPC Contractor shall carry out an accurate survey of all setting out stations relative to the site datum and shall submit details of their co-ordinates and levels to the Owner for agreement prior to commencing any setting out of the Works. All subsequent survey and monitoring work shall be based upon the setting out stations and shall record details of the reference station used.
PAGE 141
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Monitoring for movements of ground or structures shall, if required by the Owner, be carried out by the EPC Contractor at locations and frequencies as instructed by the Owner. All surveys and setting out work shall be fully recorded and the details and results provided to the Owner on completion of each section of the Works.
9.5.6.
Concreting strategy
The Specification for concrete, including producing, transporting, sampling, testing and assessing its compliance shall comply with the recommendations of American Concrete Institute (ACI) or equivalent international standard. Workmanship shall be in accordance with ACI recommendations or equivalent international standard. Water, admixtures, aggregates, cement or screeds shall be in accordance with ACI or equivalent international standard. Aggregates shall be certified as not containing minerals that may cause the alkalisilica reaction to occur, and may be produced on site using a crusher fitted with a proprietary high pressure misting system to control dust emissions (permit to be obtained by EPC Contractor). If water for batching concrete is obtained from boreholes or an RO plant, it shall be treated to ensure that it suitable for use in concrete production in all respects. Concrete may be produced from an onsite batching plant or, if available, from a local ready mix plant. Concrete shall be placed promptly after batching. Water shall not be added to the mix after batching. Fresh concrete shall be placed and cured in accordance with the relevant ACI standard taking into account the ambient atmospheric conditions during the curing period. Sampling of the concrete shall take place at the point of deposition. Concrete cubes shall be cured in similar conditions to the placed concrete. The compression test results for concrete cubes shall be made available to the Owner within 24 hours of the test being carried out. The EPC Contractor shall provide full details of his proposed concreting strategy for review by the Owner. Trial mixes shall be conducted to demonstrate the suitability of the proposed mix design. Formwork shall be designed and constructed to withstand the worst combinations of dead, imposed, dynamic and wind loads. Finishes to concrete surfaces shall be visibly suitable for their location. Tolerances shall be suitable for the integrity of their location. Worked finishes shall be suitable visually in their location. Steel reinforcement and fabrics shall be specified to comply with ACI or equivalent international standard. Joints in concrete shall be designed and constructed to allow for the proper functioning of the structure, following the recommendations of the ACI or equivalent international standard.
9.5.7.
Materials, workmanship and testing procedures shall be in accordance with the requirements of Eurocode 7. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for proposing material and chemical properties for each type of earthworks material required for the construction of the works. The material classifications shall include, but not be limited to:
PAGE 142
General fill Fill to structures Capping Sub-base Sub-soil Topsoil Filter material for abstraction wells Pipe and duct bedding materials Rip rap for slope protection and gabion baskets
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for carrying out compliance testing in accordance with BS1377, ASTM standards or equivalent international or Oman standard for all material and chemical properties used to classify each earthworks material type to determine their suitability of soils to be sourced from the Site for use in the Works. If the EPC Contractor intends to import earthworks materials to the site the proposed materials shall be subject to the same classification tests as soils sourced from the site and should be available in suitable quantities to achieve the schedule. The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for arranging for an independent testing organisation to carry out in-situ density tests on placed fill materials in accordance with BS1377, ASTM standards or equivalent international or Oman standard. The EPC Contractor shall present proposed earthworks material classifications, testing standards, allowable material and chemical properties for each classification, the frequency of compliance testing and the frequency of in-situ density testing in the design basis statement. Earthworks shall not commence until the proposals have been agreed with the Owner. Excavated materials considered inappropriate for reuse on site or surplus to requirements shall be disposed of (by the EPC Contractor) offsite at a suitably licensed disposal facility or in an area of (or near to) the site made available by the Owner.
9.5.8. 9.5.8.1.
Materials, workmanship and testing shall be in accordance with Eurocode 3 Generally the members of each individual structure shall be fabricated from steel of one grade and from the same manufacturer.
9.5.8.2.
The EPC Contractor shall give full access to the Owner at all times to the place of fabrication and storage for the purpose of inspection and testing. Mill test certificates shall be provided when requested by the Owner. When so instructed by the Owner, the EPC Contractor shall provide samples of the steel to be used in the works for tests to be carried out at an independent laboratory agreed by the Owner. The cost of these independent tests shall be paid for by the EPC Contractor. Should the works or any part thereof fail to pass
PAGE 143
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification any test or in the opinion of the Owner fail to comply with the Specification, the EPC Contractor shall immediately take such action as is necessary to ensure that the Works comply with the Specification and the Contract. All defective material and workmanship shall be rejected and shall be replaced and reconstructed at the EPC Contractors expense in accordance with clause 26 of the Contract. The EPC Contractor shall carry out non-destructive testing of all butt welds subject to tensile stresses. Testing shall be carried out in the fabrication shop or on site as the case may be. Unless otherwise agreed, non-destructive testing shall be by radiographic examination. Alternative forms of testing, if agreed, shall comply with the appropriate international or Oman standard. Any required storage pit for radioactive isotopes shall be built to ROP standards and be the responsibility of the EPC Contractor.
9.5.8.3.
No splicing of members between connections either by welding or bolting shall be permitted without the prior agreement of the Owner. Where it is necessary to fabricate sections from steel plate, fabricate laced or battened columns or where doubler plates are to be added to hot rolled sections, all the steel used in each individual member shall be of the same grade and be obtained from the same manufacturer. The welding of steel of differing grades and/or from different manufacturers shall not be permitted
9.5.8.4.
Shop drawings
The EPC Contractor shall prepare fully detailed shop drawings with supporting calculations for submission to the Owner for comment and review prior to commencement of any fabrication. Any design changes shall be submitted to the Owner on a red line drawing to be reviewed prior to construction. On Provisional Acceptance, as-built drawings will be submitted for each phase of completion. Review by the Owner shall not relieve the EPC Contractor of his responsibility for the correctness of all measurements, detailing, fabrication, alignment and erection of the Work.
9.5.8.5.
Protection to steelwork
The preparation, protection and painting systems selected for ferrous surfaces shall be according to S2.15/EP120/2-FE Sa2,5 for steel structures inside fulfilling corrosivity categories C2M, C3L and S3.21/EPZn(R)EP160/2-FESa2,5 for steel structures outside fulfilling C3H, C4L according to EN ISO 12944. The treatment class shall be Fe Sa2,5 according to EN ISO 8501. Finish colour shall be selected by the Owner within the colour range available from EPC Contractors colour program recommendation document. The EPC Contractor shall prepare and submit, to the Owner, four copies of a complete protection and painting schedule covering each and every item to be coated and shall fully describe the systems to be used including surface preparation, type of coating/paint, application methods, number of coats and dry film
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 144
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification thickness of each. The EPC Contractor shall complete a schedule, to identify the paint manufacturer and include representative colour samples. It shall be understood that the intent of the Specification is to detail a protection against corrosion and other types of damage whilst being aesthetically pleasing. It shall be the EPC Contractors responsibility to schedule and execute the painting and coating work to this end. All corrosion protection coatings shall be applied in accordance with the manufacturers written instructions. Where any coats are damaged, all loose and damaged paint shall be removed down to the bare steel using a needle gun and/or rotary wire brush and adjacent sound paint which is to be over-coated shall be thoroughly abraded to ensure adhesion of touch-up paint, all to the satisfaction of the Owner. Surfaces which are to receive a fire protective coating shall be delivered to site with travel coatings applied and shall be suitably protected until immediately prior to the fire protective coatings or casings being applied. The latter shall be applied as late as possible in the construction programme subject to other trades and operations. Primer and travel coat shall be compatible with the fire protection coating.
9.5.8.6.
All fire protection proposals and applications shall be in accordance with NFPA standards and shall be to the satisfaction of relevant local and fire authorities, to give adequate fire protection when tested. The coatings shall be applied by a specialist applicator strictly in accordance with the product manufacturers recommendations.
9.5.8.7.
Erection
Prior to the erection of permanent steelwork, the EPC Contractor shall submit for the Owners review a detailed method statement with all supporting drawings and calculations setting out his sequence for erection, laydown areas, details of craneage etc. The Owners review shall not relieve the EPC Contractor of his responsibilities under the Contract.
9.5.8.8.
Foundation bolts
Boxing out for bolts shall not be permitted. Tolerance tubes shall be fitted to foundation bolts. The projection of threaded portions of bolts above the foundation level shall be adequate to properly secure the nuts. All nuts shall be lock nuts or nyloc type, prior to use the nuts & bolts shall be protected using denso tape or similar.
9.5.9.
Materials, workmanship and testing shall be in accordance with relevant international or Oman guidelines and the requirements of the refinery. The drainage and pipeline systems shall, in all respects, suit the liquids that have to be carried, pipe bedding materials shall also comply with the relevant standards. Proposals for testing buried pipelines shall be in accordance with the relevant international standard and presented in the design basis statement.
9.5.13.2. Concrete
Foundation to posts, struts, bases and anti-burrowing kerbs shall be in concrete or reinforced concrete.
9.5.14. Landscaping
The layout of hard landscaped areas shall be agreed with the Owner prior to commencement of work. The landscaping scheme shall incorporate protection measures to all slopes to prevent erosion or instability including, but not limited to: suitable slope angles, bench heights and widths, rock bolting, gabion baskets, rip rap, shotcrete etc. Use of each methods suitability for different areas to be demonstrated through calculation.. Soft landscaping shall consist of low maintenance open grassed areas. The landscaping scheme shall ensure that the Site is efficiently drained.
9.6.
Transformer compounds for oil-filled transformers shall be constructed with blast walls between transformers and a bund wall at the entrance to each compound. The transformer support substructures shall be designed to contain any escaping oil. The oil retaining structures shall be filled with fire quenching graded
PAGE 146
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification round stones providing an air void capacity at least 120 % of the transformer total oil volume. Segregated ducts shall be provided for any cables installed within the substructures. Each compound shall be provided oil/water separators with water outlets drains and oil retaining chambers with pumping out facilities. Each compound shall be provided witha blast / fire resistant walls to sides and rear to prevent fire spreading from one compound to another. Firewalls shall be designed for a minimum 4 hour fire resistance. The dimensions of each compound shall be adequate for installation, operation and removal, and to allow for sufficient cooling of the transformers. Compounds shall each be provided with suitable chain link or palisade fencing and a lockable access gate. Each transformer compound shall be equipped with skid rails and demountable or fixed hauling bollards /eye to allow the easy installation and removal of transformers and ancillary equipment.
PAGE 147
10.2.
The EPC Contractor shall produce a Quality Plan to detail all pre-commissioning, commissioning and testing requirements of the Works.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 148
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Fully detailed written commissioning procedures shall be submitted to the Owner for all commissioning activities and tests. Unless otherwise noted, the procedures shall be finalised and submitted at least three weeks prior to the programmed start of any particular activity. All procedures shall include marked-up P&IDs, wiring diagrams etc showing valve positions (open or closed), sequence of operations with valve numbers and location of temporary strainers, fittings and pipe runs etc. The procedures shall cover all necessary inspections, adjustments and tests including clean out of vessels and temporary strainers to achieve progress through operation from no load to full load capacity. The acceptance criteria for the test parameters shall be clearly indicated in the commissioning and testing procedures. All safety procedures to be adhered to shall also be included. The procedures shall be divided into sections for each item of plant or system and shall include: Diagrammatic arrangement drawings of the item or system showing the major components with references to the relevant instrumentation and interlocks; A description in the form of a list, table or similar or the design operating conditions with details of all restrictions, precautions and limits on plant operation applicable to that section of the plant during the pre-commissioning and commissioning periods and then to subsequent operation; A list of all of the required settings of all protective devices and alarms for that section of the Plant; A detailed programme for the activities to be carried out from the completion of erection of each section of the Plant to the finish of its commissioning and performance trials. This programme is to identify all links with the work of other EPC Contractors and of the Owner, especially those which must be completed before the EPC Contractor is able to proceed with pre-commissioning of that plant section; Copies of the EPC Contractor's check sheets for the pre-commissioning, commissioning and testing of each plant item or system. These sheets shall provide a means for recording:
the plant set-up dimensions, measurements and/or calibration the name of the person who checked the above details of the operational testing carried out, the results of the tests and of any adjustments necessary to enable the equipment to meet its specified requirements.
Procedures for Acceptance Tests shall be submitted for agreement no later than six months prior to the planned date for the Acceptance Tests. The EPC Contractor shall provide a commissioning programme at least three months prior to the planned commissioning start date. The programme shall show the planned sequence of testing and include all activities from functional testing/pre-commissioning through to successful completion of the Acceptance Tests. Once commissioning activities begin, the programme shall be updated weekly.
10.3.
No later than six months prior to the planned commencement of commissioning, a commissioning coordinating group shall be established to coordinate and facilitate commissioning activities. The group shall include representatives of the Owner and EPC Contractor. Third parties may be invited to attend as required, such as transmission line/sub-station and gas facility contractors. The group shall be chaired by the Owner and shall meet weekly to perform this role.
PAGE 149
10.4.
Commissioning
10.4.2. Commissioning
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for carrying out all the commissioning work associated with bringing the plant to a condition where it is ready to undergo its reliability and performance tests. Prior to the start of commissioning, the EPC Contractor shall ensure that the Owner has been provided with the latest edition of all relevant documents and drawings. Once the component or system is charged, energized or otherwise made live, the EPC Contractor shall conduct further tests to demonstrate that the system and its constituent components function collectively as designed, that individual components operate at varying loads under steady state conditions within their stated operating parameters, and that the components and system respond correctly to transient conditions. The EPC Contractor shall undertake whatever adjustments are necessary to achieve the optimal level of plant reliability, capacity and performance. Base line operational data including vibration, temperature, voltage, current, pressure etc. shall be recorded for all equipment and systems. All fuel supply systems shall be tested to demonstrate satisfactory fuel pressure/flow control under all operating conditions including start-up and shutdown. When the EPC Contractor has completed all commissioning of all the local and remote/supervisory control functions, every function shall be demonstrated to have been commissioned, calibrated and loop tested. Tests to verify the correct and safe operation of the plant shall also be conducted to a protocol agreed between EPC Contractor and Owner.
10.5.
Testing
The Owners operations and maintenance group shall have completed the classroom and operational portions of the training programme required by the Contract prior to starting the tests. The Plant shall be operated by the Owners O&M staff under the direction and supervision of the EPC Contractor. The EPC Contractor shall remain responsible for the satisfactory conduct of each test. The testing of the Works shall comprise:
PAGE 150
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification 2. Tests on completion and 22) Acceptance Tests comprising: Start up tests Trial run Pre-reliability run tests Reliability run tests Initial performance tests Fuel switching tests Environmental testing (noise, emissions and effluent water quality) Grid compliance testing. Black start and energising of the 132 kV transmission line Full load rejection test (one unit must remain connected to supply house and local loads) The Tests on Completion shall be satisfactorily passed prior to commencement of the Acceptance Tests. The Reliability Run shall be satisfactorily passed prior to commencement of the Performance Tests. Elements of the noise tests may be undertaken in conjunction with the Performance Tests. All noise tests shall be completed before the commencement of the Reliability Run. Emissions tests shall be performed in conjunction with the Performance Tests. Grid compliance testing may be undertaken when convenient, prior to Plant Provisional Acceptance.
10.6.
Tests on completion
The object of these tests is to demonstrate the fitness for purpose of the plant and systems prior to commercial operation and Plant Provisional Acceptance. The scope of tests shall include, but not be limited to, the following: Testing of the Gas Connection Facilities, Gas Metering Facilities and Metering Systems; performance of the governing system and protective devices; demonstration of capability of each engine to operate at normal base load rating on stand-by fuel for 6hours; demonstration of capability of each engine to operate at normal base load rating on Natural Gas for 6hours; fuel change-over tests of each engine at full load (gas to oil to gas) plant ramp-rate test; demineralised water treatment plant capacity and purity tests; demonstration of adequacy of building services (HVAC systems performance, lighting levels (normal and emergency)) etc; demonstration of capacity, capability and functionality of all other balance of plant systems (e.g. compressed air supply, fire protection systems etc); demonstration of the starting reliability of the Works; The start up performance (ramping rate) of each engine and of the Plant shall be demonstrated by recording the megawatts of electrical power from the unit at the initiation of synchronisation and the time elapsed to achieve base load.
PAGE 151
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification The intent of some of the tests on the balance of plant systems may have been demonstrated during earlier commissioning tests and, subject to the agreement of the Owner, acting reasonably, further demonstrations or testing may not be required.
10.7.
Acceptance Tests
In conducting the tests, the performance of each of the Power Unit Blocks and, thereafter, the plant shall be evaluated. The Owner recognises that the RAEC System has limitations and cannot accept loads at GCPC or GCPFC for the Acceptance Tests. Depending on the period in the year, it is expected that the RAEC System will be able to accept one or more power units configured as a Power Unit Block. Accordingly, the Acceptance Test shall be conducted for one Power Unit Block at a time. On successful completion of each such Acceptance Test, the Demonstrated Power Capacity and associated Electrical Energy of the Power Unit Block shall be made available to the Owner. On successful completion of the Acceptance Test of the final Power Unit Block, the Plant Acceptance Test shall be conducted within the constraints of the RAEC System.
10.7.1. General
The EPC Contractor shall perform output and heat rate performance tests of each dual fuel engine fired on Natural Gas and Fuel Oil to demonstrate that the Works complies with the contractual performance guarantees. The whole of the Plant shall be tested in accordance with the standards of the agreed quality plans and testing procedures. The Owner and nominated third parties shall be invited to witness all tests. Due to RAEC System limitations the Plant shall be designed and constructed so that, for the purpose of testing the Plant, each Power unit block will be independently tested. Power output and heat rate of the overall Plant shall be determined in accordance with ISO 3046 and ISO 8528. The EPC Contractor shall formulate the testing procedure for carrying out performance tests on the plant with regard to identifying scope of tests, references and definitions, guiding principles, preparation for tests, operating conditions for tests, instruments and methods of measurements, computation of results and test report. The precise nature of the tests together with testing procedures and programmes, accuracy of measurement, expected measurement uncertainty etc shall be provided by the EPC Contractor and shall be agreed between EPC Contractor and Owner prior to execution of the tests.
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Sufficient data shall be collected during the tests to demonstrate that no item of plant or equipment is operating beyond its maximum continuous rating (MCR). If equipment that is found to have been operating beyond its MCR at the time of these tests is changed or replaced in such a way as to affect its auxiliary consumption or such that the results of the tests could have been different, then the test results shall be amended to take account of this or the tests shall be repeated. Every effort shall be made to run the test under the reference operating conditions, or as close to the reference conditions as possible, in order to reduce the application of corrections to the test results.
10.7.1.4. Metering
The EPC Contractor shall supply main and backup Metering Systems to measure electrical energy imported and exported by the Plant. One set of meters shall be used to separately measure the Electrical Energy
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 153
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification imported and exported by the Plant. The second set of the meters measuring in the same manner as the first set, will be used for verification purposes. Each set of meters shall be connected to a separate set of current transformers. The electrical output of the generator shall be measured by test-standard kilowatt meters of Class 0.2 or current transformers and voltage transformers Class 1, or better, installed in the appropriate feeders. All electrical meters used in the test shall be calibration checked immediately prior to the test. The electrical losses in transformers shall be calculated from the functional tests of the transformers, if applicable. Should any auxiliary loads that would not normally be operating at the guaranteed point be operating due to any reason, then the total of the absorbed powers (or nameplate rating if powers cannot be measured individually) shall be added to the measured net capacity figure to give the net capacity that would have resulted had these loads not been operating. The Metering Systems provided shall be of suitable accuracy for performance testing according to the appropriate test code. Procedures for measurement of other parameters, such as ambient temperature, barometric pressure, relative humidity etc, shall be fully detailed in the Performance Tests. Fuel flowmeters shall be independently calibrated in an independent qualified test facility. Pressure difference transducers measuring pressure drop across a fuel flowmeter shall be calibrated at line static pressure. No test measuring orifice plates, nozzles or venturi tubes shall be installed without the agreement of and witnessing by the Owner.
PAGE 154
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Instruments for primary measurements shall be calibrated using standard reference sources or shall have been previously calibrated and certified by independent nationally or internationally agreed calibration authorities. Instruments shall have been calibrated in an accredited facility subject to the agreement of the Owner. Calibration certificates shall be provided for the test instruments at the time of test. The costs involved in preparation of calibration certificates shall be borne by the EPC Contractor.
Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack Main Stack
NO NO2 Total NOX UHC SO2 CO Flue gas flow rate Oxygen content Temperature
10.7.2.3. Noise
The number of locations to be tested shall be agreed by the Owner and EPC Contractor. Far field noise measurements shall be taken during a range of operating conditions, including start-up, normal baseload operation, and shut down. Prior to testing a measure shall be made of the background noise levels without plant operating. Measurements shall preferably be made at night in a period of low background noise levels from other sources and minimum off-site vehicle movement. The measurement equipment shall comply with ANSI S1.4 precision standards. For work area noise acceptance tests, equivalent continuous levels shall be obtained at a minimum distance of 1 m from the surface of equipment, acoustic enclosures, or room boundaries. The results of the tests shall be fully reported together with operating conditions of the equipment, meteorological conditions, noise measurements, instrument locations and instrument details.
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 155
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Any increase in noise levels above that allowed in the Contract shall be investigated and should these be shown to be as a result of noise emanating from new plant, then the EPC Contractor shall remedy same at his own cost by the installation of sound attenuation measures. Repeat tests shall then be carried out to demonstrate that the remedial works have been successful in eliminating the noise problem.
Prior to the testing of the Power Units, the EPC Contractor shall test and commission the GCF. The testing and commissioning will be done in accordance with generally accepted industry standards and shall include the full load testing of the Gas Connection Facilities using a temporary flare system. Tests shall also include tests to demonstrate automatic change-over of standby equipment of the Plants Natural Gas supply system. Following completion of the tests of the Gas Connection Facilities and Gas Metering Facilities, the EPC Contractor shall disconnect the temporary flare system. EPC Contractor shall also submit to the Owner a report (the Gas Connection Facilities and Gas Metering Facilities Test Report) which shall contain all supporting information and documentation required to substantiate the results of any Acceptance Test, including proof of compliance with the acceptance requirements, prior to any Natural Gas supply to the first Power Unit.
PAGE 156
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification e) simulation of test load rejections on the individual Power Units or the Power Unit Blocks due to a trip condition at full load rating and at part loads to verify control systems and Power Unit governor operation and the automatic voltage regulation system; testing of the partial and full load rejection of each Power Unit and Power Unit Block to demonstrate for example, step and emergency loading of Power Unit Block, island operation; verification and checking of the operating stability and frequency response of the Power Units, or Power Unit Block when operated within the technical limits with load variations; part load and full load tests of the Power Units and the Power Unit Blocks; testing automatic and manual fuel changeover including changeover fuel switch from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil on a trip of the Gas Connection Facilities on low Natural Gas supply pressure and stable operation on Fuel Oil, fuel switch from Fuel Oil to Natural Gas, checking of automatic change-over of standby facilities on Natural Gas and Fuel Oil; testing automatic and manual fuel changeover including changeover from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil on a fall in the Natural Gas supply pressure at the gas delivery point and stable operation on Fuel Oil, fuel switch from Fuel Oil to Natural Gas, checking of automatic change-over of standby facilities on Natural Gas and Fuel Oil; verification of start-up times and loading rates of Power Units, Power Unit Blocks and after various shutdown periods including tests when Power Units are on hot standby with both Natural Gas and Fuel Oil; demonstration of load setting/control from main control room and of the data exchange to main control room and the load dispatch centre for Electrical Energy;
f) g) h) i)
j)
k)
l)
m) verification by the EPC Contractor of completeness of the Power Unit Block and of all ancillary equipment, compliance with the Law and of no known defects or outstanding works that would affect the safe and reliable operation of the Plant; n) other tests required to demonstrate the safety and security of the Plant and trip systems.
PAGE 157
These tests will require to be carried out with part and all the Power Units of a Power Unit Block subject to the load availability of the RAEC System.
Day 0 1
PAGE 158
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Day of Reliability Run on which Interruption occurs Maximum number of permitted Interruptions within permitted period Maximum permitted period of aggregate Interruption and re-start requirement if period exceeded.
Day 0 2
Day 3 4
The Reliability Run shall be re-started if either the maximum aggregate period of Interruption is exceeded or the maximum number of permitted Interruptions is exceeded. Where the Interruption does not require the whole or part of the Reliability Run to be re-run, the length of the Reliability Run shall be extended by the period of any Interruption.
PAGE 159
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification b) c) d) achievement of not more than one hundred and ten per cent (110%) of the heat rate of the Power Unit Blocks in operation on Natural Gas; achievement of the guaranteed emission levels and qualities of the Power Unit Block; and during Performance Tests, environmental emissions tests shall be carried out and environmental emissions shall be demonstrated to be within levels authorised by the Ministry for Environment and Climate Affairs of the Government or any other Competent Authority which is from time to time responsible for environmental matters and the monitoring of environmental emissions in the Sultanate of Oman.
PAGE 160
f) g)
h) i)
j)
k) l)
m) verification by the EPC Contractor of completeness of the plant and of all ancillary equipment, compliance with the Law and of no known defects or outstanding works that would affect the safe and reliable operation of the Plant; n) other tests required to demonstrate the safety and security of the plant and trip systems and to demonstrate compliance with requirements and of the RAEC Code.
PAGE 161
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification at load settings and operating conditions agreed by the parties (the Trial Run). The EPC Contractor should note that inadequate capacity in the RAEC System will prevent the Plant from achieving its full load. Starts and stops and switch-overs to standby equipment shall be included in the Trial Run. The EPC Contractor shall be permitted to undertake such work during the Trial Run as is necessary to optimise the running of the Plant. The EPC Contractor may extend the duration of the Trial Run to evaluate whether the Plant will be able to achieve the quality and stability of operation which would be required for the Reliability Run and the Performance Tests.
d)
PAGE 162
Day 6 7
The Reliability Run shall be re-started if either the maximum aggregate period of Interruption is exceeded or the maximum number of permitted Interruptions is exceeded. Where the Interruption does not require the whole or part of the Reliability Run to be re-run, the length of the Reliability Run shall be extended by the period of any Interruption.
c)
d)
e)
f)
During the Initial Performance Test of the Plant, the Demonstrated Power Capacity and heat rate at Demonstrated Power Capacity of the Plant on Natural Gas and Fuel Oil shall be tested in accordance with agreed Performance Test procedure and Performance Test codes. During the Tests, the EPC Contractor shall, unless the Owner agrees otherwise in writing, operate the Power Units in normal mode, i.e. not in peaking or overload mode. If at any time during a Test of the Plant, the RAEC System frequency is outside the limits defined by the RAEC Code, the Test shall be stopped and, after co-ordination with the Licensed Transmission System Operator, shall be repeated by the EPC Contractor.
PAGE 163
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Plant Performance Tests shall be conducted under normal auxiliary power loading conditions. The Demonstrated Power Capacity shall be reduced to reflect the shortfall in auxiliary power loading between the maximum auxiliary power loading and the auxiliary power loading conditions at the time of such Plant Performance Tests. The Initial Performance Tests of the Plant shall have been satisfactorily completed only if the following conditions are met: a) b) c) achievement of not less than ninety five per cent (95%) of GCPC and GCPFC; achievement of not more than one hundred and five per cent (105%) of the Contracted Heat Rate of the Plant at GCPC on Natural Gas and 105% at GCPFC on Fuel Oil; during Performance Tests, environmental emissions tests and waste water discharge tests shall be carried out and environmental emissions and waste water discharges shall be demonstrated to be within levels authorised by the Ministry for Environment and Climate Affairs of the Government or any other Competent Authority which is from time to time responsible for environmental matters and the monitoring of environmental emissions and waste water discharge levels in the Sultanate of Oman; and achievement of the guaranteed emission levels and qualities.
d)
PAGE 164
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Each Power Unit shall pass a Fuel Switching Test if it runs in a continuous and reliable manner in accordance with the Dispatch Instructions for a minimum period of fifteen (15) minutes once the switch from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil has been completed and the Power Unit has demonstrated its ability to transfer back from Fuel Oil to Natural Gas after a minimum period of fifteen (15) minutes of Fuel Oil running. After switching back from Fuel Oil it shall continue to run on Natural Gas for a further fifteen (15) minutes. Where a Fuel Switching Test is not Duly Completed, the Owner shall be entitled to require the EPC Contractor to repeat the Test until it is duly completed.
10.8.
Test records
The EPC Contractor shall be responsible for supplying to the Owner copies of all test documentation (including pre-commissioning and commissioning tests, tests on completion and acceptance tests) for the complete plant. All original data sheets shall become the property of the Owner and shall be handed to the Owner immediately following each test. The EPC Contractor shall retain copies for his records and preparation of the test reports. Unless noted otherwise, the EPC Contractor shall promptly prepare and submit a detailed test report to the Owner within 5 business days of completion of any test. The test report shall include the test procedure, description of any deviations from the test procedure of unusual event(s), which occurred during the test, copies of test data sheets, calculated results, copies of lab analyses, and copies of instrument calibration records.
10.9.
After completion of any of the Acceptance Tests, the EPC Contractor shall not in any way adjust the plant, its control system or any equipment in any way which, in the opinion of the Owner, could: Reduce output or increase heat rate from that tested during the Acceptance Tests; and/or Increase emissions, noise or any other parameter guaranteed or subject to an environmental condition such that the Works shall not comply with the guarantees or conditions of consent. If, after the completion of any Acceptance Tests, the EPC Contractor makes any such adjustment which, in the opinion of the Owner, could impact negatively on the results of the Tests already completed, then the
PAGE 165
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Tests shall be repeated to the satisfaction of the Owner. The results of the repeated Tests shall be considered as the results of the particular Acceptance Test.
PAGE 166
The Seller shall deliver Natural Gas to the Generator at the Gas Delivery Point at all times in compliance with Natural Gas specifications and Lower Heating Value set out in Table 2-1 Subject to the following provisions of this Schedule A, the Seller shall from the First Gas Delivery Date, deliver Natural Gas to the Generator in compliance with Table 2-1and Section 2.2 through to Section 2.5. 2. 2.1 NATURAL GAS SPECIFICATION Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall have the Natural Gas specifications and Lower Heating Values set out in Table 2-1 below. The sample gas composition shall be used as the basis for determining plant performance and guarantee parameters. TABLE 2-1 Component Sample Composition Mole Vol % where applicable Gas Minimum Composition Mole Vol % where applicable Methane Ethane Propane i-Butane n-Butane i-Pentane n-Pentane C6 + N2 CO2 H2S Mercaptan Sulphide Total Sulphur Oxygen Mercury 78.0 6.6 2.7 0.0643 0.0418 0.0030 0.0030 0.0000 9.0864 3.5 0.0015 0.003 0.003 0.0000 78.0 6.6 2.7 82.5 7.4 3.3 0.12 0.12 0.0056 0.0056 Trace 10 3.5 0.0015 50 ppm (vol) 150ppm (vol) 5ppm (vol) 5.5 micrograms/ Sm (at 15C and 101.325 kP) Maximum Composition Mole Vol % where applicable
PAGE 167
Musandam Power Plant Technical Specification Component Sample Composition Mole Vol % where applicable Gas Minimum Composition Mole Vol % where applicable Calorific (MJ/sm3) Calorific (BTU/Scf) Value LHV 882.07 845 1044 Value LHV 32.93 Maximum Composition Mole Vol % where applicable
1100
1400
Conversion method:
1 megajoule = 947.817 BTUs (Reference ISO 31/IV: 1992, Annex A) standard cubic metre = 35.383 standard cubic feet.
Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall be free from dust, oils, and any other substances which may interfere with the transmission or industrial use of Natural Gas. Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall have a minimum temperature which is at least 10 degrees Celsius above the hydrocarbon dewpoint at the Natural Gas delivery pressure. Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall have a maximum pressure of 30 bar(g) and a minimum pressure of 20 bar(g). Natural Gas delivered at the Gas Delivery Point shall have a water content not higher than 160 3 mg/Sm , except for occasional deviations therefrom which may occur during the months of May, June, 3 July, August and September, when the water content shall not be higher than 270 mg/Sm .
FUEL OIL SPECIFICATION (Typical quality of Fuel Oil on the Oman Market)
Property Appearance
Limits Report
Density at 15C
kg/l
Min Max
D4052
Max Min
D1500 D445
PAGE 168
Property
Units Max
C C % wt
Copper Corrosion (3 hrs at 100C) Carbon Residue (Ramsbottom) Water Ash Sediment Flash Point, PM Closed up Total Acid No Strong Acid No Distillation Rec at 250C Distillation Rec at 350C Cetane Index % wt % Vol % wt % wt C mg KOH/g mg KOH/g % %
Max
1.0
D130
Max Max Max Max Min Max Max Max Min Min
D524 D95 D482 D473 D93 D974 D974 D86 D86 D976
PAGE 169
Appendix B Data Sheets for Guaranteed Data, Performance Data, Design Data and Inputs into the Bid Evaluation Tool
PAGE 170
PAGE 171
Natural Gas RE operation (including Performance Guarantees as per Appendix C of the EPC Contract) Guaranteed Capacity for Power Unit Guaranteed Capacity for Block and Plant 2 (GCPC) Heat Rate (Not Guaranteed) including pilot fuel
Unit No.
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate at RSC (100% load) kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate (75% Load) at RSC kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate (50% Load) at RSC kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
Means (i) the aggregate of the Accepted Power Unit Block GCPCs from time to time prior to Plant Provisional Acceptance; and thereafter (ii) the total Electrical Energy generating capacity of the Plant, (expressed in MW) and which is available at the Electrical Delivery Point and which the EPC Contractor commits to provide when the Power Unit Blocks or the Plant (as applicable) are operating on Natural Gas on a continuous and reliable basis in conformity with the Operating Parameters and by reference to the Reference Conditions. 3 Electrical Delivery Point (EDP) 4 For the plant, referred to as Contracted Heat Rate
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 172
Fuel Oil RE operation (including Performance Guarantees as per Appendix C of the EPC Contract) Guaranteed Capacity for Power Unit Guaranteed Capacity for Block and Plant 5 (GCPFC) Heat Rate (Not Guaranteed) including pilot fuel
Unit No.
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate at RSC (100% load) kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate (75% Load) at RSC kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
LHV (Gross) Heat Rate (50% Load) at RSC kJ/kWh at gen terminals (Guaranteed)
Means (i) the aggregate of the Accepted Power Unit Block GCPCs from time to time prior to Plant Provisional Acceptance; and thereafter (ii) the total Electrical Energy generating capacity of the Plant, (expressed in MW) and which is available at the Electrical Delivery Point and which the EPC Contractor commits to provide when the Power Unit Blocks or the Plant (as applicable) are operating on Natural Gas on a continuous and reliable basis in conformity with the Operating Parameters and by reference to the Reference Conditions. 6 Electrical Delivery Point (EDP) 7 For the plant, referred to as Contracted Heat Rate
SINCLAIR KNIGHT MERZ PAGE 173
Plant Performance Data The EPC Contractor shall include specific data sheets to support the data provided under this Appendix and provide additional data relevant to the project specification
Description
Part I - 1 PERFORMANCE OF PLANTS (USE ADDITIONAL SHEETS IF REQUIRED) 1. ISO reference conditions (as per relevant ISO standard): inlet air temperature (dry bulb) ambient pressure relative humidity charge air coolant temperature, if applicable gross output at generator terminals for one Power Unit at ISO reference conditions gross heat rate (fuel + pilot fuel, if applicable) at ISO reference conditions Reference Site Conditions (RSC): inlet air temperature (dry bulb) altitude ambient pressure relative humidity charge air coolant temperature frequency Minimum generator power factor generator power factor (at insulation class B, amb. temperature 50 C) C mbar % C MW kJ/kWh
1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 2. 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8
C AMSL mbar % C Hz
50
50
1013 30
1013 30
PAGE 174
Description
fuel Natural Gas LHV for guarantee tests Natural Gas LHV range LHV for Fuel Oil Wobbe Index (WI) supply gas pressure range at interface to Gas Delivery Point Power Unit load performance and
Fuel Oil
42,600 1100 to 1400 20 to 30 Full load base On completion of trial run and reliability run Base load N/A Full load base On completion of trial run and reliability run Base load
2.16
equipment condition
2.17 3.
mode of operation Performance Values on Power Unit at RSC Condition in 2 above (Use additional sheets if Power Units have different ratings). Guaranteed gross output at generator terminals Power Unit auxiliary power consumption gross heat rate including pilot oil consumption, if applicable inlet air pressure loss inlet air flow Inlet air cooling Air temperature after inlet air cooling Relative humidity after inlet air cooling MW MW kJ/kWh m bar kg/s Status C C
On / off
On / off
PAGE 175
Description
3.9
3.10
exhaust pressure loss with or without environmental pollution control equipment as applicable exhaust gas flow
m bar
kg/s cu.m/h
3.11 3.12
exhaust gas temperature Guaranteed 75% Power Unit load gross heat rate at RSC (LHV basis) including pilot oil injection Guaranteed 50% Power Unit load gross heat rate at RSC (LHV basis) including pilot oil injection expected 30% Power Unit load gross heat rate at RSC (LHV basis) including pilot oil injection Guaranteed lube oil consumption limit for each Power Unit Performance Values for each Power Unit Block (when one or more Power Units are connected to a step-up transformer) at RSC in 2 above at GCPC/GCPFC. number of Power Units connected to a step up transformer identifying the number for each rating if units of different sizes are connected gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units connected to the step-up transformer, (3.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] as applicable x 4.1[use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes]) auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Power Unit Block operation other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included above total auxiliary power consumption, (4.3 + 4.4)
C kJ/kWh
3.13
kJ/kWh
3.14
kJ/kWh
3.15
grams/ kWh
4.1
No.
4.2
MW
4.3
MW
4.4 4.5
MW MW
PAGE 176
Description
4.6
4.6 5
Guaranteed net output at electrical delivery point for a Power Unit Block (Block GCPC), (4.2 - 4.5) Guaranteed Net Heat Rate (LHV) including pilot Fuel Oil consumption, if applicable Performance Values for each Power Unit Block which has a different number of Power Units or different output (from sl. no. 4 above) at RSC in 2 above. [use additional sheets if more power block unit sizes are proposed] number of Power Units connected to a step up transformer identifying the number for each rating if units of different sizes are connected gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units connected to the step-up transformer, (3.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] as applicable x 5.1[use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes]) auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Power Unit Block operation other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included above total auxiliary power consumption, (5.3 + 5.4)
MW
kJ/kWh
5.1
No.
5.2
MW
5.3
MW
MW MW MW
5.6 6
Guaranteed net output at electrical delivery point for a Power Unit Block (Block GCPC), (5.2 - 5.5) Guaranteed net heat rate including pilot oil consumption, if required Performance Values for Entire Plant at RSC at GCPC/GCPFC: number of Power Units for the Plant number of Power Unit Blocks with configuration as in 4 above number of Power Unit Blocks with configuration as in 5 above gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units in Plant, (4.2 [use appropriate
kJ/kWh
PAGE 177
Description
6.5
details if multiple unit sizes] x 6.2) + (5.2 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more multiple block unit sizes] auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Plant operation, (4.3 x 6.2) + (5.3 x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more power unit block sizes] other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included in 6.5 above total auxiliary power consumption, (6.5 + 6.6) Guaranteed net output at electrical delivery point of Plant (GCPC), (6.4 - 6.7) Not used
MW
MW MW MW
6.11
Guaranteed net heat rate (Contract Heat Rate), {(4.6 x 4.8 x 6.2) + (5.6 x 5.8 x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more power unit block sizes]}/6.8 minimum plant load net heat rate excluding pilot fuel (LHV)
kJ/kWh
kJ/kWh MW
minimum plant load net heat rate (LHV) including pilot oil consumption, if applicable Not used Not used Not used Not used Black Start Unit rated capacity adequate to meet the start-up requirement of any Power Unit together with the shutdown load on trip of all Power Units and other Plant requirements Power Unit correction curves together with equations
kJ/kWh
kW
PAGE 178
Description
9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 9.7 9.8 9.9 10 10.1
Gross power output versus ambient air Curve no. temperature Curve no. Gross power output versus relative humidity Gross power output versus ambient pressure Gross heat rate versus ambient temperature Gross heat rate versus relative humidity Gross heat rate versus ambient pressure Gross heat rate versus LHV Any other Any other Curve no.
air Curve no. Curve no. Curve no. Curve no. Curve no. Curve no.
Other Power Unit curves Reciprocating engine generator gross heat Curve no. rate degradation (recoverable and non recoverable) versus operating hours for the PPA period Gross heat rate versus engine load from minimum load to 100% load Curve no.
10.2
Power Unit auxiliary power consumption from Curve no. minimum load to 100% load Power Unit maximum step load versus load Curve no. from minimum load to 100% load Other Power Unit data Plant is designed to provide the power output (capacity) as is technically possible over the entire range of Site ambient Yes/No Yes/No
11.2
PAGE 179
Net Firm Capacity Performance Data Data Unit Natural Gas Fuel Oil
Description
Part I - 1 PERFORMANCE OF PLANT AT NET FIRM POWER LOAD (USE ADDITIONAL SHEETS IF REQUIRED) 1. 2. 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 Not used Reference Site Conditions: inlet air temperature (dry bulb) altitude ambient pressure relative humidity seawater temperature (if required) frequency Minimum generator power factor 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 2.11 2.12 2.13 2.14 generator power factor (at insulation class B, amb. temperature 50 C) fuel Natural Gas LHV for guarantee tests Natural Gas LHV range LHV for Fuel Oil Wobbe Index (WI) supply gas pressure range at interface to Gas Delivery Point Power Unit load performance and BTU/Scf BTU/Scf kJ/kg BTU/Scf Bar(g) 1100 to 1400 20 - 30 Full load base On completion of -N/A Full load base On completio C AMSL mbar % C Hz 1013 30 36 50 0.8 lag 0.8 lag Natural Gas 882 845 to 1100 42,600 1013 30 36 50 0.8 lag 0.8 lag Fuel Oil 50 50
2.15
equipment condition
PAGE 180
Description
2.16 2.17 3.
mode of operation water injection flow (NOx reduction) Performance Values on Power Unit at RSC in 2 above at Net Firm Power load (Use additional sheets if Power Units have different ratings). Gross output at generator terminals Power Unit auxiliary power consumption Gross heat rate LHV basis inlet air pressure loss inlet air flow Inlet air cooling Air temperature after inlet air cooling Relative humidity after inlet air cooling exhaust pressure loss with or without environmental pollution control equipment as applicable exhaust gas flow MW MW kJ/kWh m bar kg/s Status C C m bar Kg/s
Base load
On / off
On / off
3.10
kg/s cu.m/h
3.11 4
exhaust gas temperature Performance Values for each Power Unit Block at Net Firm Power Load (when one or
PAGE 181
Description
more Power Units are connected to a step-up transformer) at RSC Condition in 2 above. 4.1 number of Power Units connected to a step up transformer identifying the number for each rating if units of different sizes are connected gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units connected to the step-up transformer, (3.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes]as applicable x 4.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes]) auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Power Unit Block operation other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included above total auxiliary power consumption, (4.3 + 4.4) Net output at electrical delivery point for a Power Unit Block (Block GCPC), (4.2 - 4.5) Net heat rate No.
4.2
MW
4.3
MW
MW MW MW kJ/kWh
Performance Values for each Power Unit Block which has a different number of Power Units or different output (from sl. no. 4 above) at RSC in 2 above at Net Firm Power Load. (Use additional sheets if there are more Power Units Blocks with different ratings) number of Power Units connected to a step up transformer gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units connected to the step-up transformer, (3.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] as applicable x 5.1 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes]) auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Power Unit Block operation other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included above No. MW
5.1 5.2
5.3
MW
5.4
MW
PAGE 182
Description
total auxiliary power consumption, (5.3 + 5.4) Net output at electrical delivery point for a Power Unit Block (Block GCPC), (5.2 - 5.5) Net heat rate
MW MW kJ/kWh
Performance Values for Entire Plant at RSC at Net Firm Power Load: number of Power Units for the Plant
6.5
number of Power Unit Blocks with configuration as in 4 above number of Power Unit Blocks with configuration as in 5 above gross output at generator terminals for all Power Units in Plant, (4.2 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] x 6.2) + (5.2 [use appropriate details if multiple unit sizes] x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more power unit block sizes] auxiliary power consumption of all normal running auxiliaries required for Plant operation, (4.3 x 6.2) + (5.3 x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more power unit block sizes] other Plant auxiliary power consumption not included above in 6.5 above total auxiliary power consumption, (6.5 + 6.6) Net output at electrical delivery point of Plant (GCPC), (6.4 - 6.7) Net heat rate, {(4.6 x 4.8 x 6.2) + (5.6 x 5.8 x 6.3) [use appropriate details if more power unit block sizes]}/6.8
MW
MW MW MW kJkWh
PAGE 183
Unit
Data
min
Min
min
Y/N
Y/N
PAGE 184
Description
emergency loading rates maximum step load rise acceptable for Natural Gas and diesel oil
Unit M M
Data
PAGE 185
Description
Confirm that in Natural Gas mode engines are capable of automatic and instant changeover to Fuel Oil mode in alarm situations (eg. low gas pressure) without any loss of power. Confirm that in Natural Gas mode the engines are capable of changeover to Fuel Oil mode at any load without any loss of power. Confirm that in Fuel Oil mode the engines are capable of changeover to Natural Gas mode at any load without any loss of power.
Unit
Data
PAGE 186
Unit 1
Unit 2
Unit 3
PAGE 187
Unit 1
Unit 2
Unit 3
PAGE 188
Unit 1
Unit 2
Unit 3
PAGE 189
Unit 1
Unit 2
Unit 3
PAGE 190
Temperature
Unit 1 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
Unit 2
Unit 3
Unit 1
Unit 2
Unit 3
PAGE 191
Temperature
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
Description (for all units) Unit Natural Gas Average Annual Capacity Degradation of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant Based on information provided by the main power island OEM Capacity Not Recovered at Major Maintenance of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant (to be consistence with OEM/ LTSA proposal) Average Annual Heat Rate Degradation of each Power Unit/Power Unit (to be consistence with OEM/ LTSA proposal)Block/Plant Heat Rate Not Recovered at Major Maintenance of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant(to be % % Data Fuel Oil
PAGE 192
consistence with LTSA proposal) Major Maintenance Interval of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant (to be consistence with LTSA proposal) Length of Major Maintenance of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant (to be consistence with LTSA proposal) Length of Normal Maintenance of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant (to be consistence with LTSA proposal) Expected Forced Outage Rate of each Power Unit/Power Unit Block/Plant (to be consistence with LTSA proposal) years
days
days
Part I -3 Guaranteed Air Emissions Rates & Concentrations at the Stack Discharge
Parameter
Units
Stack Height (above ground level) Stack Height (above sea level) No of engines/engine type Exit Diameter of one individual stack Equivalent Stack Diameter (cluster 1 no units) Equivalent Stack Diameter (cluster 2 no. units, if applicable for engine type) Exit gas temperature)
m m
m m
m
o
PAGE 193
Part I -3 Guaranteed Air Emissions Rates & Concentrations at the Stack Discharge
Parameter
Units
Exit gas temperature Exhaust gas volume flow from one engine (wet, actual temp and pressure Flue gas oxygen content (wet) Flue gas oxygen content (dry) Flue gas water content
m /s % % %
Guarantee Emissions Rates NO2 NOx (as NO2) CO2 CO SO2 Total Unburnt Hydrocarbons (as C3H8) NMHC (as C3H8) VOC ( as NMNEHC (as C3H8)) Particulates (PM10) Guarantee Emissions Concentrations NO2 NOx (as NO2) mg/N m
3
mg/N m
3
PAGE 194
Part I -3 Guaranteed Air Emissions Rates & Concentrations at the Stack Discharge
Parameter
Units
CO2 CO SO2 Total Unburnt Hydrocarbons (as C3H8) NMHC (as C3H8) VOC ( as NMNEHC (as C3H8)) Particulates (PM10)
g/Nm
3
mg/N m
3
mg/N m3 mg/N m
3
mg/N m3 mg/N m
3
mg/N m3
Notes: 1. One 1 form to be filled for each engine type/capacity proposed 2. Emissions of pollutants to be based on the worse case Natural Gas and Liquid Fuel Specifications 3. For Natural Gas, for the purposes of calculating unburnt hydrocarbons, the concentration of propane may be assumed at max 3.03 mol %, butane & higher hydrocarbons at max 0.11 mol% and silcon and aromatic hydrocarbons absent 4. For liquid fuel the max Sulphur content should be taken as 0.5 wt % 5. All emissions rates to be based on site reference conditions (50oC, 30% RH, 1013 mbar) for stable engine load. 6. All emission concentrations expressed as Nm3 @15% O2, dry, 0 deg C, 1 atm 7. In addition to the specific data below Bidders to provide curves for the entire load range from min. to max. stable load of each engine for NOx, CO, NMNEHC, NMHC, Total UHC, SO2 and PM10
PAGE 195
PAGE 196
Case 1 15 MW
Air temperature Unit load as dispatched (MW) % Load of MCR Max In-feed loss (highest loaded Generator Step load available (exclude highest loaded generator) Is sum Step load > In-feed loss
Demonstrate dispatch configuration to meet largest in-feed loss 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C
Case 2 100 MW
Air temperature Unit load as dispatched (MW) % Load of MCR Max In-feed loss (highest loaded Generator Step load available (exclude highest loaded generator) Is sum Step load > In-feed loss
Demonstrate dispatch configuration to meet largest in-feed loss 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C 50C
State excess MW for step load When first unit of all blocks is dispatched and second unit of first block or a bus
Case 3
PAGE 197
Transition points
Air temperature Unit load as dispatched (MW) % Load of MCR Max In-feed loss (highest loaded Generator Step load available (exclude highest loaded generator) Is sum Step load > In-feed loss
section is dispatched, demonstrate dispatch configuration before and after to meet largest in-feed loss.
Note to bid form for security and response Case 1 - Low Load Conditions During the early years of operation the Plant will be required to meet loads that are small relative to the overall Plant capacity. Bidder must propose a Low Load Configuration that meets Low Demand Conditions and demonstrate that following a loss of the largest power in-feed, the primary response of the remaining generating units shall increase power output to restore the generation/demand power balance without the system frequency falling below 45.0Hz. Fuel Oil operation is permissible to meet primary response requirements provided the generating units change back to gas once stable operation is achieved. The maximum recovery time for a step load increase shall be 5 seconds. Change to Fuel Oil operation and return to gas operation shall be automatic, immediate and with no interruption to load. Generating units shall not be dispatched at levels below the minimum output necessary for stable operation and with no restrictions on subsequent loadings within the permissible step loading. Where dispatch loads are below 50% MCR, this should be clearly highlighted Case 2 - High Load Conditions
PAGE 198
Similar to the low load conditions but at high load, sufficient surplus capacity shall be provided to ensure that in the event of a Main Equipment failure the largest power in-feed loss does not result in loss of load demand, subject to the following: The largest power in-feed loss shall be the greater of the output of the largest operating generating unit or the sum of the outputs of generating units connected to the same busbar section. That at all times the maximum step load applied to generating units that remain in service after the loss of the largest power in-feed does not exceed the maximum permissible step loading available. No units shall be dispatched below 50% MCR.
Case 3 All block transition The total installed capacity of the Plant and the number of generating units will depend on the size and type of units deployed within the Plant to meet the net firm capacity requirement. Plant configurations may comprise a large number of small units, a small number of large units or a hybrid arrangement with a combination of large and small units. The design shall ensure sufficient surplus capacity is provided to ensure that in the event of a Main Equipment failure the largest power in-feed loss does not result in loss of load demand, subject to the following:-. The worst case scenario with respect to meeting the power in-feed loss and the maximum step load constraints is likely to occur with a hybrid arrangement. This is when all of the smaller units have been despatched to individual power blocks and the load increases to a point it is necessary to despatch the next unit which would be one of the larger units, resulting in a significant increase in the power in-feed loss in the event of a Main Plant failure. Depending of the number of power blocks this will be either the output of the largest operating generating unit or the sum of the outputs of generating units connected to the same busbar section. That at all times the maximum step load applied to generating units that remain in service after the loss of the largest power in-feed does not exceed the maximum permissible step loading available. No units shall be dispatched below 50% MCR.
The Bidder must demonstrate a configuration in this state which meets all security needs and emissions limits. There may be other case points showing transition points of note which the bidder should highlight and demonstrate compliance with security needs. In demonstrating compliance with the above requirements, plant capacity, response times and emissions levels should be based on guaranteed data provided in the Bid Forms to be provided as attachments to the Owners Technical Specification. Where data is relied on to demonstrate the above requirements and this data is not provided in the specified Forms, the Bidder will provide an appropriate Form guaranteeing the relevant data.
PAGE 199
PAGE 200
Note on Use of Design Data Sheets If the appended data sheets do not apply to the proposed technical configuration, the Bidder shall prepare its own data sheets, taking the appended data sheets as a model with the same scope of information and data. The data sheets are to be filled separately for each type of technology if both technologies are used.
Description
Unit
Data
Part II-1
DESIGN DATA
Manufacturer/License License Model No. Design Code Test Code Rated speed engine generator
Number of cylinders Cylinder bore Piston stroke Mean effective pressure Method of starting
PAGE 201
Description
Unit
Data
Method of automatic change-over from gaseous fuel to liquid fuel at base load Type of cooling system Type of air inlet filter system Governor type and model Turbocharger manufacturer Radiator manufacturer Radiator design temperature Gas pressure required at engine inlet Gas temperature required at engine inlet Fuel Oil pressure required at engine inlet Fuel Oil temperature required at engine inlet List of engine mounted auxiliaries provided List of off base auxiliaries with redundancies for: Fuel gas system Fuel Oil system Lube oil system Starting air and compressed air system Cooling system Intake air system Exhaust gas system C bar C bar C -
PAGE 202
Description
Unit
Data
Type of NOx -reduction measures Height of exhaust gas stack above ground level Configuration of exhaust gas stack Exhaust gas temperature At engine outlet At stack
m -
Engine-generator set mounted on springs Dimensions of DG set Weight of DG Type of lube oil recommended Type of cooling water additives recommended Inspection/Maintenance intervals (enclose details of running hours for same) Duration of inspection/maintenance and unavailability of each gas engine. Anticipated annual forced outage hours
Doc. No.
Days
Hours
PAGE 203
Description
Unit
Data
Design Code
kV
A rpm %
PAGE 204
Description
Unit
Data
Negative sequence reactance x2 Zero sequence reactance x0 Unbalanced load to be carried continuously Winding insulation class Temperature rise limiting insulation class
MW/MVAr
Details of AVR/Excitation system (described in block diagram form showing transfer functions of individual elements) Power system stabilizer fitted
PAGE 205
Description
Unit
Data
% MVAr
Part II-1.3 Prime Mover and Governor Power-/speed setter range and speed
Adjustable speed droop range Receive set points from DCS
kV A A A kA -
PAGE 206
Description
Unit
Data
Insulation medium Single phase / Three phase Nominal voltage Nominal design current (main/branch) Current at RSC (main/branch) Short circuit current (main/branch) Conductor material Conductor cross section kV A/A A/A kA mm
PAGE 207
Description
Unit
Data
Minimum tap position Maximum tap position Tap changer type: on load/off load Zero sequence impedance voltage
PAGE 208
Description
Unit
Data
Zero sequence resistance voltage High voltage side to neutral reactance High voltage side to neutral resistance High voltage side vector group Low voltage side vector group Type of cooling Maximum admissible over voltage Short circuit currents (3 sec) at primary/secondary
PAGE 209
Description
Unit
Data
Minimum tap position Maximum tap position Tap changer type: on load/off load Zero sequence impedance voltage Zero sequence resistance voltage High voltage side to neutral reactance High voltage side to neutral resistance High voltage side vector group Low voltage side vector group Type of cooling Maximum admissible over voltage Short circuit currents (3 sec) at primary/secondary
kV kV kV A -
PAGE 210
Description
Unit
Data
Section of core Max. temperature at rated and short circuit conditions Losses (conductor, sheath, dielectric) Conductor short circuit current (1sec, 3sec) Sheath short circuit current (1sec, 3sec) Total losses
Nos. digital
PAGE 211
Description
Unit
Data
Relay functions included (to be given separately) Fault recording Communication bus system Local configuration via PC and Remote configuration via communication bus system and PC -
Part II-1.12
Auxiliary Systems
PAGE 212
Description
Unit
Data
PAGE 213
Description
Unit
Data
PAGE 214
Description
Unit
Data
Maximum Daily Quantity of fuel gas required Maximum flow rate required during start-up (shutdown to full speed and no load) Minimum fuel gas flow rate at ignition
Sft3/h
Emergency shutdown system (2 x 100%) including emergency shutdown valves at Gas Delivery Point Metering facilities included Type of gas chromatograph provided Allowable percentage variation in fuel gas supply pressure downstream of Gas Connection Facilities Steady state Load changing
Yes/No
PAGE 215
Description
Unit
Data
Allowable temperature range for fuel gas supply to Power Units downstream of fuel gas heaters of Gas Connection Facilities Number and capacity of filter separators Number and capacity fuel gas heaters
bar(a)
-/% -/%
Type of fuel gas heaters Number and capacity pressure reduction stations Number and capacity of low load pressure reduction stations Operating gas supply pressure range after pressure reduction station Description of vent system provided Description of drain collection system provided -/% -/% bar(a)
Design flow rate Type of Fuel Oil Number Fuel Oil road tanker unloading points Unloading pumps Number / capacity each pump
Nos / m3/h
PAGE 216
Description
Unit
Data
Storage tanks Total storage capacity equivalent to normal consumption of plant (full load)+pilot oil number of tanks / capacity each tank
Type of cathodic protection system
days Nos/ m3
Nos / m3/h
Nos / m3/h
unloading system Fuel Oil supply for each Power Unit Fuel Oil return/recirculation line for each Power Unit pilot oil to each Power Unit
PAGE 217
Description
Unit
Data
Type of fire fighting systems and/or facilities provided for: fire fighting water main ring system Fuel Oil tank area Fuel Oil unloading and forwarding pump skids Fuel Oil tanks Fuel Oil tanks cooling gas pressure reduction station generator transformers auxiliary transformers cable cellar/trenches/ducts/trays lubricating oil storage tanks other buildings ( list each building)
Description
Unit
Data
PAGE 218
Description
Unit
Data
Source of water used for desalination Type of pretreatment process Plant output at design conditions Dealinated Water Storage Tank Number / Capacity Nos/ m3 m3/h
Type of gas detectors Hazardous gas detectors at Plant boundary Included / Not included
Nos./m3/h m3/cycle
Volume/type of exchangers per train Demineralized water storage tank capacity, each tank Number of tanks
l/m3 -
PAGE 219
Description
Unit
Data
Demineralized water Conductivity Silica less than Used chemicals for regeneration: S/cm ppm kg HCl 100% kg NaOH 100% Waste water neutralization Capacity Net volume of basin Make-up water (demineralized water) requirement: Maximum per hour Daily Average Annual Average Storage tanks (Buffer tanks for internal consumers) Number Nominal capacity No. of continuous chlorine dosing pumps No. of shock chlorine dosing pumps m3 No. m3/h m3/d m3/a t/d m
PAGE 220
Description
Unit
Data
PAGE 221
Description
Unit
Data
Cylindrical height
Nos. Nos.
m/h
PAGE 222
Description
Unit
Data
Nos. m3/h
Part II-1.12.11.4 Other waste water of effluent treatment system e.g. pre-treatment plant waste (if necessary)
Type of treatment Plant capacity m/h
PAGE 223
Description
Unit
Data
Part II-1.13.0
PAGE 224
Description
Unit
Data
Rated current main buses , sub-buses main circuit breakers Rated short time current (1 sec) for main / sub-busbars Mechanical protection class A A A IP
Part II-1.13.3 LV transformers (to be filled out for each size of transformer)
Type Total number Number of phases Number of windings Rated power at site ambient Type of tap changer Rated voltage (primary / secondary) Type of cooling Vector group Impedance voltage No-load losses Short circuit losses Short circuit current on primary / secondary Nos. Nos. MVA kV / kV % kW kW kA
PAGE 225
Description
Unit
Data
PAGE 226
Description
Unit
Data
Battery Chargers Rated voltage DC Rated current DC Rated capacity Rated input voltage
V A kVA V
Ah/A Ah/A
PAGE 227
Description
Unit
Data
Part II-1.14.0
execution of check back signal from individual control level to monitor of operator station
PAGE 228
Description
Unit
Data
Control system
Make Type Manufacturer -
Plant condition monitoring system as per the Specification Plant condition monitoring system integrated with DCS included as per the Specification
yes/no
Plant performance monitoring system as per the Specification Plant performance monitoring system integrated with DCS included as per the Specification
yes/no
PAGE 229
Description
Unit
Data
Field equipment
Type of actuators for isolating valves
PAGE 230
Description
Unit
Data
Part II-1.15.0 Custody Transfer Natural Gas Fiscal Metering System as per Appendix D of the Specification Ultrasonic Fiscal Flow Meter System
Number and capacity Manufacturer Nos./% 2 x 100% SICK MAIHAK, INSTROMET or DANIEL Multi-Path (4 paths or more) Ultrasonic Fiscal Flow meter with meter run Assembly
Type
Ultrasonic Fiscal Flow Meter as per Appendix D of the Specification included Pressure transmitter as per Appendix D of the Specification included Confirmation that 0.1% accuracy of span of pressure transmitter is adequate to meet the overall accuracy of the Fiscal flow metering system Temperature transmitter as per Appendix D of the Specification included Confirmation that 0.1 C accuracy of temperature t ransmitter is adequate to meet the overall accuracy of the Fiscal flow
yes/no
yes/no
yes/no
yes/no
yes/no
PAGE 231
Description
Unit
Data
metering system Flow computer to compute density, Corrected Metric standard volumetric flow, energy values in BTU and Joules at Standard conditions as per Appendix D of the Specification included Flow computer in redundant configuration On line proving of one meter against other shall be possible on command from supervisory PC included HART protocol mode to be confirmed Flow computers of each stream connected to rack mounted industrial grade PC based monitoring and operating station as per Appendix D of the Specification included Gas Chromatographic Analyser to provide gas composition analysis up to C6+, specific gravity, density and heating (calorific) value input and calculated hydrocarbon dew pointing analysis and result to custody transfer metering system as per Appendix D of the Specification included Sample conditioning system as per Appendix D of the Specification included Gas metering system interface with DCS and MOG included yes/no yes/no
yes/no yes/no
yes/no
yes/no
yes/no
PAGE 232
Part IV-3: References of Main Equipment Part IV-3.1: List of Manufacturers of Main Equipment
Address of Manufacturer
Equipment
Name of Manufacturer
Generator
PAGE 233
Step up Transformer
Power Unit Control System and Plant Control System. Indicate separately, if different. If different furnish references where integrated similar to the Specification requirements. A reference list must be attached for each type of main equipment, which should include the following information: * Name of plant / client * Type, size and main parameters * Year of commissioning * Relevant operational parameters (hours of operation, starts, etc.)
Note:
PAGE 234
Part V - Additionally Required Project Information Part V-1 Operation and Control Philosophy
Bidders shall provide a description of the operation and control philosophy proposed. The description shall include the Plant and its component parts, station utility and auxiliary systems under start-up, shutdown, normal and emergency operation and how the Plant will use such philosophy to match daily and seasonal load profiles. Bidders are required to address the following items: Scope of communications between Plant, 132 kV Sub-station and Load Dispatch Centre Required attendance levels Routine local manual operations and visual checking Remote control system Remote monitoring systems Proposed Plant operation principles Power load control with loading, load shedding and load rejection Detailed description of the automatic switching process from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil and vice versa - Immediate on-load change over to ensure GCPFC without interruption in the event of a Gas Operation Failure, trip of Gas Connection Facilities or the pressure of Natural Gas at the Gas Delivery Point falling below the minimum gas pressure specified in the NGSA or the pressure at the Gas Connection Facilities falling below the minimum gas pressure required by the Power Units Block(s), and thereafter prompt changeover from Fuel Oil to Natural Gas when pressure is reinstated or Natural Gas supply interruption is corrected Emission quality control Utility systems operation and control principles including fuels, chemicals, raw feed water, water treatment and air systems.
PAGE 235
Part V-2
Bidders shall provide the following information: Evidence of the Bidders thorough understanding of the Omani construction industry. Evidence of the Bidders ability to use innovative and flexible approaches in the implementation of the Project. A description of how the Bidder plans to perform the various functions (eg detailed design, procurement including purchasing, expediting and inspection, construction, commissioning, testing and training) and the offices where the various portions of the work will be performed. A description of how all of the work will be co-ordinated and managed. Organisation charts showing the Bidders proposed Project organisation both at its home office(s) and at the Project site. The charts shall show how sub-contractors and suppliers will interface and be controlled by the Bidders management team, lines of authority and communication. A Project Level 1 programme detailing engineering, procurement and construction. A description of the procedures to be used by the Bidder to control and monitor the Project and a description of how and what extent those procedures will be used to control the work of sub-contractors and suppliers. The description should demonstrate how the Project should be controlled. Total number of staff to be employed at the Plant and their job titles. Maintenance philosophy and maintenance schedule for the Plant. Number of shifts for operation and maintenance.
PAGE 236
Part V-3
Bidders shall provide: statement of intent for the adoption of a documented quality system and the acceptance of the requirements laid down in Section 7 of the Minimum Functional Specification for the Plant; copy of the Quality Assurance Manual; and details of any recent external assessments of the proposed quality system through second party or third party assessment. The results of such assessments should be listed in a schedule together with details of any accreditation of the quality system.
PAGE 237
Part V-4
Bidders shall provide construction, health and safety organisation and safety procedures and describe how they will be used on this Project, including:
(a) proposed field health and safety organisation for this Project, including a description of how the Bidder normally implements construction safety at the work site; (b) details of the Bidders field health and safety programme including induction and training programmes, safety meetings, publicity, safety motivation and incentive plans, safety inspection, medical facilities, site security and sanitation; (c) methods the Bidder will use to maintain open communications with sub-contractors on health and safety matters; (d) bidders procedures for recording site safety statistics including those of its sub-contractors, details of its site safety record for the previous three years and the method used to compile this information; and (e) details of the Bidders knowledge and experience of health and safety legislation in Oman.
PAGE 238
Part V-5
Fault level and stability studies for the electrical generation export distribution system, including reactive power adjustment (voltage control) and generator short circuit rating Operational Safety (HAZOP) Study for all areas/systems. Failure Modes and Effects Analysis (FMEA) study for all systems and equipment.
Bidders shall define their standard procedures/current proposals and methods of evaluation in as full detail as possible in respect of: Testing to be carried out pursuant to the Power Purchase Agreement (Appendix A) including in relation to: (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) Pre-commissioning Start-up Tests Reliability run Acceptance requirements Performance Tests
Bidders shall submit a draft documentation schedule detailing their proposals for submission of drawings, specifications, procedures, manuals, etc. to MHEW for review/information together with the timing of the listed submissions from the Effective Date. Bidders shall provide the proposed content (index) and submission date for the following manuals: (a) (b) (c) Design Manual(s) Procurement Manual Construction Manual
PAGE 239
Operations Manual(s) Operating and Maintenance Manual(s) Spare Parts Manual Certification-Manual
PAGE 240
Part V-6
Not used
Part V -
Other information
Plant Concept The Bidder shall submit as part of its Proposal the following technical information: a) b) Completed data sheets as set out in Form of this Appendix B. Description of main features of the proposed Plant such as: c) general description and main features of the Plant and use of the Plot including laydown areas; detailed time schedule; construction approach, phases of construction, commissioning and operation of plants constructed at the various phases; operational philosophy of Power Units and steam generation units (start-up, shutdown and failure of individual units); maintenance philosophy, maintenance schedule including major plant overhauls; details of operation, maintenance and training. activities
Standards, codes and regulations: Listing of major standards, codes and regulations (international, suppliers own county) which will be applied for the design and construction of plant equipment and facilities, for civil works and for testing of Plant equipment; Description of major equipment and systems including their auxiliaries; Main mechanical equipment and systems for Power Unit including auxiliary systems, electrical equipment and systems, such as: generators, generator protection, electrical power system philosophy, main electrical equipment including auxiliary systems, etc. I&C systems, such as: general control system philosophy, description of central room, local control rooms, Plant control system and control of common plant and auxiliary systems, etc.
d) e)
PAGE 241
f)
emission control measures; civil works, including site development, buildings, structures etc;
Project drawings and diagrams, such as: plant location map with areas temporarily used during construction; Site plan, general lay-out and arrangement drawings for onand offsite facilities, indication of fenced areas; equipment configuration in the area of the Plant, seawater pumping station, central control room, water treatment plant, etc; P&I diagrams for main systems; single line diagrams for: Plant main electrical systems; Plant electrical auxiliary systems; protection diagrams; heat balance diagrams for the Plant for various operating points as per the RFP; correction curves for part loads, deviating ambient conditions and gas composition range; start-up and loading diagrams () of Units and total Plant; generator performance chart; fuel changeover data.
Environmental Aspects and Data The Bidder shall submit as part of its Proposal the description and details of the following: a) b) Guaranteed air pollution emission rates and type of emission control and monitoring measures; Nature and estimated quantities of waste water, waste water treatment and disposal methods;
PAGE 242
c)
Contractors, Supplies a) The Bidder shall submit as part of its Proposal details and references of the nominated and/or proposed contractors and suppliers/manufacturers (where applicable) as specified in Appendix 7 of the RFP. Bidders shall submit a schedule of all major proposed subcontractors and supplies defining the type of work or service to be subcontracted and the country of origin.
b)
PAGE 243
Part VI
Milestones Effective Date Financial Closing date Start of site mobilization Site preparation
Date
Milestones
Date
Completion (end of erection) of Power Unit Blocks Power Unit Block 1 Power Unit Block 2 Power Unit Block 3 etc.
PAGE 244
Milestones
Connection of GCF and Metering Facilities to MOG gas supply system
Date
PAGE 245
Commissioning of Power Units Power Unit Block 1 Energisation of block step-up transformer Initial synchronisation Trial run Reliability test run Performance test Scheduled Pre-Commercial Operation Date Power Unit Block 2 Energisation of block step-up transformer Initial synchronisation Trial run Reliability test run Performance test Scheduled Pre-Commercial Operation Date Power Unit Block 3 Energisation of block step-up transformer Initial synchronisation Trial run Reliability test run Performance test Scheduled Pre-Commercial Operation Date Power Unit Block 4 etc. Energisation of block step-up transformer Initial synchronisation Trial run Reliability test run Performance test Scheduled Pre-Commercial Operation Date
PAGE 246
NOTE :
The Implementation Schedule shall be adjusted by the Bidder depending on the number of Power Units proposed.
PAGE 247
PAGE 248
DRAWINGS AND DOCUMENTATION All drawings shall be to scale and fully detailed. All important dimensions shall be given and the material of which each principal part is to be constructed shall be indicated. Drawings shall not exceed A0 standard dimensions and shall bear the contract references. Drawings for review shall be submitted as paper prints.
1.
Extent of documentation
In general the EPC Contractor shall be responsible for the preparation and issue of the following documentation: a) b) c) Initial design drawings and related specifications. Design revisions and modifications drawings. Time schedule showing information on: design and engineering work, order dates and time of delivery of major Plant equipment and systems, Site surveys, Site preparation, factory tests for major Plant equipment, civil/structural works, erection and installation, commissioning; and Site tests. Project procedures. Equipment lists. Piping and valve standards and codes. Electrical and instrument schedules. Detailed specifications for equipment and bulk materials including equipment sizing calculations and protection studies. Manufacturers recommended spare parts inventory for: Testing and commissioning, performance and reliability testing, two years commercial operation of the Works. Enquiry packages for plant, equipment and bulk materials. Subcontract packages. Certification of all pressure systems, cranes and lifting equipment, where applicable in accordance with specified standards and regulations.
d) e) f) g) h) i) j) k) l)
m) Expediting and inspection reports. n) o) p) q) r) s) t) Material audits. Project photographs. Quality assurance plans. Procedures and audits. Quality reports. Reporting. Operation and maintenance manual.
PAGE 249
u) v)
w) Acceptance test procedures. x) y) z) Acceptance test records. Equipment commissioning records. Equipment system safety test results and records.
2.
General
Control
For all work to be performed under the Contract, the EPC Contractor shall establish and maintain a comprehensive computer based document control system ensuring that the identification, revision, status and location, at all phases of the Work, can be determined. The EPC Contractors system shall include all subcontractors and vendors documents.
Organization of documentation
All documentation shall be organized in a logical manner and all contents shall be properly indexed. A revision status record sheet at the front of each document shall facilitate recording of amendments in a logical manner. Revision indication and issue dates shall also appear on each amended sheet. The cover shall identify the contents.
3.
During contract
PAGE 250
The compilation and storage of records during the Contract shall be controlled to ensure adequate security, verification and traceability prior to Takeover. The storage conditions shall provide resistance to damage and deterioration. The EPC Contractor shall submit a monthly Drawing and Documentation Schedule for review by the Owner and shall maintain the schedule throughout the Contract to show the status and revision of each document. The transfer of this information should be achieved by electronic transfer (disk) from the EPC Contractors computer system(s).
Method statement
The EPC Contractor shall prepare and submit comprehensive method statements for all major construction and erection activities.
Commissioning document
Within five months of the Contract Effective Date, the EPC Contractor shall submit for review a site commissioning record system that provides for all commissioning procedures and activities that shall be performed during the works to be identified and readily traceable. Each commissioning procedure shall include the following information as a minimum: a) a) b) c) d) e) Objective and procedure Scope of procedure Reference documents, P&IDs and drawings Prerequisites to the commissioning List of relevant check sheets with date completed and signing off procedure Check sheets with sections for signing off by construction, commissioning and Owner personnel.
Where check sheets include items such as checking of alignment, vibration etc then the reference documents shall clearly indicate the criteria against which these parameters can be accepted. Vendors documentation is acceptable for this purpose but must be adequately referenced on the check sheet and available. A specific check sheet shall be provided for each component to be commissioned. Packages of documentation shall be issued for each system of the work as they become mechanically complete.
PAGE 251
The records shall be sufficiently detailed to show all checks performed on systems, items of plant, instrumentation and controls, and protection. It is envisaged they will cover all check carried out prior to equipment and systems being put into service and all functionality test thereafter. The EPC Contractor shall prepare maintain and update a Punch list of all items which are incomplete or defective and which require remedial action. The EPC Contractor shall prepare a detailed, test and commissioning programme for issue to appropriate parties on a regular basis to illustrate commissioning progress against planned completion dates. The EPC Contractor shall establish a safety and permit-to-work system for the Site to ensure that the plant is placed in to and taken out of service in a safe and controlled manner so that the integrity of adjacent construction work can be undertaken in a safe manner.
4.
5.
Document schedule
The following list is intended to summarize the key dates when documents are to be submitted under the Contract. The list is not exhaustive and does not prevent the Owner from requesting additional documents as and when required. Document Progress Overall Contract Programme Within 28 days of after letter of acceptance Thereafter monthly no later than 7 days from effective date Construction programme within 42 days of approval of the contract programme. Commissioning programme 6 months prior to start of any commissioning activities Monthly Submission period
Progress Reports Quality Assurance Project Quality Plan Site Quality Plan
PAGE 252
Works inspection and Test Records Site inspection and Test Records Commissioning Documentation Method Statements for Construction Developed Health & Safety Plan Formal Performance Test Procedure and Records Design Information Document Schedule Design Calculations
As required by the Quality Plan As required by the Quality Plan 6 months before commencing commissioning 14 days before commencement of relevant task Prior to commencing work on site 8 months after Contract Award
Within 30 days of Contract Award As and when required to substantiate drawing information within two (2) months of the Effective Date
Studies and calculations to demonstrate that the Specified fuel changeover is achievable Drawings for review
In accordance with Document Schedule and Project Programme within two (2) months of the Effective Date
Arrangement and layout drawings of offsite facilities As Built Drawings Operation and Maintenance Draft Operation and Maintenance Manuals Final Operation and Maintenance Manuals
2 months prior to take over date 2 months after take over date
6.
The Owner shall have review of all major design calculations and construction drawings associated with the following. 1) 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) Engine and generator foundations, including analysis for dynamic effects. Arrangement and detailed drawings of engine and generator sets and auxiliary equipment. Building layouts, structures and foundations. Arrangement and details of pumps, pipework, valves, and auxiliary systems. General arrangement and sections of cooling systems. Equipment and pipe rack foundations.
PAGE 253
6) 7) 8) 9)
Roads, architectural details of buildings and fencing. Drainage systems and outfalls. Underground piping, ducts and cable arrangement drawings (mechanical, electrical and civil General arrangements and sections of compressed air system.
10) General arrangement and sections of generators. 11) Generator excitation control diagrams, general arrangement of equipment and interfaces with site monitoring and control equipment. 12) Fire fighting equipment specification. (To be submitted for review during the course of the contract). 13) Characteristic curves for generator. 14) Capability curve for generator. 15) Schematic diagram of generator excitation system. 16) General arrangement of unit transformers. 17) General arrangement of auxiliary transformers. 18) General arrangement of earthing transformer. 19) General arrangement of MV switchboards. 20) General arrangement of LV switchboards. 21) Descriptive technical information on protective relays. 22) Single line diagrams for all ac and dc systems. 23) Protection single line diagrams for all main circuits. 24) Schematic diagram of synchronising scheme. 25) Conceptual design of cabling system. 26) Cable calculations. 27) Conceptual design of earthing and lightning protection systems. 28) Earthing system design calculations. 29) System studies to demonstrate that the Plant performs according to the specified requirements in the RAEC Code 30) Short circuit and voltage drop calculations. 31) Phasing diagram including transformer vector groups. 32) Control and interlocking logic for MV and LV switchgear. 33) Protective relaying co-ordination reports. 34) Conceptual design of lighting and small power installations. 35) Test and inspection procedures. 36) Site testing proposals and test schedules.
PAGE 254
37) Main plant electrical auxiliaries, motors, actuators, etc, specifications, operating and maintenance instructions. 38) Recommended spares lists. 39) Details of security fencing and guardhouse. 40) Operation and control philosophy for the plant. 41) Functional System Description for the DCS. 42) Instrument and alarm schedules. 43) Loop diagrams. 44) Logic and tripping diagrams. 45) Description of all sequences in a structured step-by-step format. 46) Brief description of any hardware back-up features. 47) Process parameter values under normal operating regimes. 48) Instructions for changeover from remote to local control and vice versa. 49) Description of links or interface hardware between vendor control packages and the DCS. 50) Communications network management software. 51) Hardware list and systems diagrams. 52) Commissioning programmes and test procedures 53) Test reports
7.
The Tenderer shall submit, with its offer, sufficient narrative, arrangement drawings and piping and instrumentation diagrams to fully describe its proposals for the design and construction of the Works and enable the proposal to be evaluated by the Owner. The information to be submitted shall include but shall not be limited to the following:General 1) 2) A description of main features of the proposed Plant such including: A general description of the Plant and use of the Site and temporary Areas; A detailed time schedule; A narrative describing the construction approach, sequence of construction, commissioning and operation of Power Units, Power Unit Blocks and the Plant; A narrative describing operational philosophy of Power Units (start-up, shutdown, on load operation and plant reliability);
PAGE 255
Details of black start and emergency power capability; Details of assumed maintenance philosophy and maintenance schedule activities including major Plant overhauls; Details of proposed operation and maintenance training and safety management systems
3)
Standards, codes and regulations: listing of major standards, codes and regulations which will be applied for the design and construction of Plant equipment and facilities, for civil works and for testing of Plant equipment. Descriptions of major equipment and systems including their auxiliaries for: The main mechanical equipment and systems; Electrical equipment and systems, such as: generators, generator protection, electrical power system philosophy, main electrical equipment including auxiliary systems, etc; 132 kV grid substation connection (switchgear, protection, metering and control interface); I&C systems, such as: general control system philosophy, description of central room, local control rooms, Plant control system and control of common plant and auxiliary systems, etc; Emission control measures; and
4)
5)
Civil works, including site development, buildings, etc. Project drawings and diagrams, to include: Plant location map; Site layout drawing showing the location of all major buildings, drainage and items of plant. General plant arrangement drawings including arrangement drawings for on- and offsite facilities and indication of fenced areas; General arrangement of gas turbine, generator and exciters with dimensions, weights. Method for removing and inserting generator rotor with illustrations and space required. Equipment configuration drawings in the area of the Plant, central control room, water treatment plant, etc; P&I diagrams for main systems;
PAGE 256
Performance correction curves for Natural Gas and Fuel Oil for full and part loads; Performance correction curves of dual fuel engine output and efficiency for gas composition range provided in Appendix A. Start-up and loading diagrams (from cold, warm, hot condition) of Power Units and total Plant; description fuel changeover from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil and vice versa, buffer storage of Natural Gas provided to allow changeover from Natural Gas to Fuel Oil on Natural Gas supply system trip on low Natural Gas pressure with all engines in Plant in operation.
Electrical equipment
The following information shall be provided to describe the electrical system. 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) 9) General arrangement drawing of generator and exciter. Characteristic curves for generator. Capability curve for generator. Arrangement of generator internal cooling system. Generator rotor withdrawal and insertion procedures. Detailed descriptions of generator stator and rotor insulation systems. Schematic diagram of generator excitation system Descriptive technical information on generator switchgear including information to demonstrate suitability for application. Descriptive technical information on unit, auxiliary and earthing transformers.
10) Schedule of protective relaying proposed for generator, auxiliary, unit transformers and other main items of plant and equipment. 11) Descriptive technical information on motors. 12) Schedule of cables proposed for power and other interconnections including voltage grade and type. 13) Main single line diagrams for ac and dc systems. 14) Protection single line diagrams for generator and other main circuits. 15) Descriptive technical information on synchronising equipment and synchronising schemes.
2)
PAGE 257
Buildings
1) 2) 3) General arrangement of all buildings. Architectural presentation of buildings. Building internal arrangements.
Performance
1) 2) 3) 4) Dual fuel engine power output and efficiency curve vs. ambient temperature. Dual fuel engine power output and efficiency degradation curve vs. operating hours. Dual fuel engine output and efficiency correction curves. Dual fuel engine output and efficiency correction curves vs gas composition range as provided in Appendix A.
8.
Additional to the submission of the documentation as mentioned above, the following documentation (including electronic files) shall be retained on the Site:
PAGE 258
operation and maintenance manuals; Copies of all test results for tests performed according to the EPC Contract, to the extent as normally retained in accordance with Good Practice; as-built drawings for the Plant, including the civil and architectural works; and all further technical documentation normally retained on site in accordance with Good Practice.
PAGE 259
INTRODUCTION
This specification describes the requirements for the design, manufacture, assembly, inspection, testing, training, certification, delivery and commissioning of Flow Metering Systems for fiscal flow measurement. Metering system uncertainty shall be less than 0.5% for Natural Gas flow and 1% for energy flow rate measurement.
2 2.1
This specification supplements the applicable standards, codes and the relevant requirements. In cases where more than one code, regulation or standard applies to the same condition, the most stringent shall be followed. All conflicts between the requirements of this specification, related specifications, or other documents shall be referred to Company for clarification in writing before proceeding with the manufacture of the affected parts. A list of specifications and standards referred to in this document is included below. The applicable editions shall be the revisions in force at the date of the enquiry requisition. All works specified shall be in accordance with all applicable sections of the latest edition of international codes and standards listed in each project specification. In addition, the fiscal flow metering system for natural gas shall comply with the requirements of the Oman local regulations for the engineering, manufacturing, delivery, certification and installation. References The following SP/PDO documents shall be used for reference: SP-1085 SP-1090 SP-1171 SP-1246 Instruments for Measurement and Control Instrument Signal Lines Quality Assurance Specifications for Eng. Works Painting & Finish requirements
PAGE 260
SP-2047
International Standards
AGA 9
Measurement of Gas by Multipath Ultrasonic Meters Chemical Plants & Petroleum Refining Piping Natural Gas Fluids Measurement Piping Flanges & Fittings Classification of Degrees of Protection Provided by Enclosures Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) Industrial Platinum Resistance Thermometers and Platinum Temperature Sensors Natural Gas Calculation of Calorific Value, Density, Relative Density and Wobbe Index from Composition Measurement of Fluid Flow, Estimation of Uncertainties of a Flow Rate Measurement Petroleum and Natural Gas Industries Material for Use in H2S-containing Environments in Oil and Gas Production Petroleum Liquids and Gases Fidelity and Security of Dynamic Measurement Cabled Transmission of Electric and/or Electronic Pulsed Data Sulphide Stress Cracking Resistant Metallic Material for Oil Field Equipment
ISO 6976
ISO 5168
ISO 15156
ISO 6551
NACE MR 01-75
2.2
Deviation to Specifications
PAGE 261
The Vendor shall acquaint fully with the requirements of the regulations, codes, procedures, guidelines and standards and shall acknowledge compliance with these specifications. Latest editions of all codes and standards, as of the date of issue of the contract, shall apply. All deviations from this document and the codes and standards shall be subject to prior written approval from the Consortium.
UNITS OF MEASUREMENTS
For details of measurement units for this project, refer to Attachment B to this Appendix D
The equipment shall be designed, selected, engineered and configured so as to provide the highest possible standards of safety, protection of the assets and environment, and ergonomics. For detail environmental conditions and ambient data, refer to Attachment A to this Appendix D. The flow computer, supervisory PC, etc. are to be located in the. Central Control Room (CCR), which is treated as an unclassified area. The flow computer, supervisory PC and equipment supplied under this specification shall be suitable for normal operation in the event of failure of the HVAC system
5 5.1
The Vendor shall be responsible for the design and supply of fiscal flow metering system comprising of primary flow device (multipath ultrasonic flowmeter), on/off valves, pressure transmitters, temperature transmitters, flow computer with calculation and sequence programs, Gas Chromatograph, PC with human interface graphics for control and monitoring of the metering equipment, printer for on-demand report printing, redundant serial communication link for interface with control equipment and any other associated hardware and software required to provide an accurate and reliable fiscal flow metering system to be installed at MIPP. The Bidder is to note that the entire fiscal flow metering system shall be skid mounted, except the flow computers, HMI/supervisory PC and printer. HMI/supervisory PC and printer shall be installed on furniture provided by Bidder in the Control Building. Any work shown on the reference drawings or document and not particularly given in the specification of any items essential for the correct functioning of any part of the specified equipment shall be brought to the attention of the Consortium. Failure to do this shall not absolve the Bidder
PAGE 262
from the supply and commissioning of any equipment, software or services required to achieve the full functioning of the system to the intent of this specification. 5.2. Extent of supply
The flow metering system shall be supplied as a fully assembled skid structure. Skids shall be designed with necessary piping, straight runs for the flowmeter and isolation/piping valves as required, structural steel for base plate supports, platforms/walkways on the skid etc. The Bidder shall provide the skid inlet and outlet connection according to the pipeline requirements. The skids shall be supplied in a fully assembled condition, with all necessary instruments. All instruments shall be wired to skid junction boxes located at the skid battery limit. Proper segregation of signals shall be undertaken and separate junction boxes shall be installed for analogue, digital input, digital output, potential free contacts and etc. The Bidder shall install all cabling and cable trays within the skid up to the junction box and shall install the multi-core cables from junction box to the Control Room. The Vendor to supply two identical fiscal flow metering systems (one duty/one standby, each sized for 100% capacity) on the flow metering skid. The metering skid shall be ready to install inclusive of structural steel, piping/fittings/pipe supports, local access platforms on skid, lifting lugs, earthing boss and stainless steel nameplates. The following items/services shall be included in the quotation: Field instruments:Two (one operating and one standby) multipath ultrasonic flowmeters per stream, for flow measurement. Two pressure transmitters (one per stream). Two temperature transmitters (one per stream). Pneumatic operated on-off valves (Inlet Isolation Valve, Outlet Valve & Changeover Valve) between streams. Manual on-off valves. Two (one operating and one standby) on-line Gas Chromatograph (C9+) analyzers, two sampling probes, two sample handling/conditioning systems and all essential accessories for independent full functionality of GCs. Both sample points shall be located at the common header upstream of streams. All electronic instruments shall be tropicalized and protected with sunshades. In addition, Vendor shall consider the use of sunshade for the complete metering skid in order to meet the specified metering skid accuracy.
PAGE 263
Any other items not specified here but required to make the system capable to meet the functional requirements. Field cable up to the skid mounted junction boxes. All the conventional SMART instruments shall be interfaced via HART multiplexers (TV approved) in the cabinets provided by the Vendor and the necessary diagnostic information shall be extracted and relayed for integration into the control system. Cabinet with fully wired flow computers per stream (in redundant configuration) and associated hardware including hardware for implementing switchover logic. Supply of supervisory computer with 21 LCD display with HMI graphics to monitor and control the metering skid and a printer for on demand report printing. Supply of furniture (one table and one chair as minimum), for installation of the desktop computer and printer. Both furnitures and printer shall be of the same maker, design and model to the one supplied by MIV The flow computers shall have redundant communication link with the supervisory PCs as a minimum. Supply of the hardware and software at the metering control system end, for redundant serial communication with the control system, to transfer all measured and calculated data. Supply of all software required for the full functionality of the complete system shall be provided as part of equipment/system supply. The software is to be provided on CD with all applicable licenses. Licenses shall be valid for 25 years. Ex-proof junction boxes, sealing fitting, cable glands etc. Supply of cabling from field instrument up to the skid junction boxes. Supply of cabling required inside the control building for interface between fiscal metering cabinet, supervisory PCs and printer. Supply of all software/hardware required for collection of Gas Chromatograph (2 numbers) analysis data and utilize for further calculation in flow computers. Factory Acceptance Test (FAT), System Integrated Test (SIT) and Site Acceptance Test (SAT). Wet calibration at approved testing facilities and certification for two (2) numbers of multipath ultrasonic flowmeters.
PAGE 264
Fiscal metering validation procedure including software e.g. Kelton Flocalc software for offline calculation including compressibility factor, ISO 6976 calculation, etc. or Velocity of Sound Calculation software. Both software and validation procedure with check sheets shall be loaded in standalone laptop to be supplied and included in Vendors scope of work. Supply of hardware, software engineering and design for full functionality of the fiscal flow metering system and accessories. Documentation. Spare parts (commissioning, start-up and 2 years operation spare parts) including two sets of sensors, sensor cables. Tools including online retractable tool for the removal of ultrasonic flowmeter sensors Training for Companys personnel. Packing and transportation. Pre-commissioning, commissioning of the complete system and establishing data transfer between the control room and the flow metering system. 20% wired spare for each type of signal shall be provided along with 20% spare space in the cabinets and I/O racks for future requirement. Processor and communication bus shall not be loaded more than 50%. 20% spare cores/pairs shall be provided in the multipair homerun cables. Redundancy shall be maintained in processor, power supply and communication modules. 6 6.1 6.1.1. TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Instruments Ultrasonic Fiscal Flowmeter Multipath (4 paths or more) Ultrasonic Fiscal Flowmeter
Leading edge (transit time) On-line retractable type / AISI 316/316L SS 316 with NACE STD MR-01-75/ISO 15156 (latest) Flanged, RF, Smooth finish
PAGE 265
Integral to meter. M20 ISO Female threads Ex-proof to Zone 1, Gas group IIB, Temperature Class T4 ATEX/CENELEC approved IP 65 as per IEC 60529 0 to 85 C Vendor to specify according to flow computer and accuracy
Ambient temperature limit Output : requirements. Power supply Instrument range Make Model no Notes: i) ii) iii) : : : :
24 VDC from flow computer Suitable for process data As per approved vendor list Vendor to specify
Accuracy required is 0.15% of reading. Meter shall provide a speed of sound estimate. Electromagnetic compatibility of the instrument shall be in accordance with IEC 61000. The Vendor shall confirm that even if one path is removed, the flowmeter shall function with its remaining paths. Vendor shall state the impact of such scenario on the functionality and accuracy of the offered system. Meter fault diagnostic capability shall be available as minimum. The Vendor shall elaborate on the self-diagnostic features available with the flowmeter and provide the required hardware/software. Pressure Transmitter Gauge pressure type 4-20 mA SMART (HART), 2-wire : 24 VDC loop powered (from flow computer) 0.1% of span (Note-1) NPT (F)
iv)
6.1.2.
PAGE 266
Meter range : Overpressure limit Wetted parts material Enclosure material Electrical connection Electrical safety : : : : :
Suitable for process data Maximum 100 bar SS 316 with NACE STD MR-01-75/ISO 15156 (latest) Low copper aluminium M20 ISO Female threads Ex-proof to Zone 1, Gas group IIB, Temperature Class T4 ATEX/CENELEC approved IP 65 as per IEC 60529 0 to 85 C SS 316, NACE STD MR-01-75/ISO 15156 (latest). 2 pipe mounting bracket required Complete configuration shall be possible using remote
Ambient temperature limit: Manifold for isolation/vent: Manifold mounting Configuration configuration Local display : :
Vendor shall check and confirm to meet the overall accuracy of the fiscal flow metering system. Vendor shall clarify HART protocol mode. Temperature Transmitter : Head mounted 4-20 mA SMART (HART), 2-wire (linear with temperature) : 24 VDC from flow computer 0.1 C (Note-1)
ii) 6.1.3.
PAGE 267
Calibration requirement : Instrument range Enclosure material Electrical connection Electrical safety : : : :
As per IEC 60751 Suitable to Process Data Low copper aluminium M20 ISO Female threads Ex-proof to Zone 1, Gas group IIB, Temperature Class T4 ATEX/CENELEC approved IP 65 as per IEC 60529 0 to 85 C RTD (Pt 100)
Configuration
Complete configuration shall be possible using remote configuration Required Required As per approved vendor list
Local display
Vendor shall check and confirm to meet the overall accuracy of the fiscal flow metering system. Vendor shall clarify HART protocol mode.
ii)
6.2.
Flow Computer
Description : The Flow computer shall compute density corrected metric standard volumetric flow, energy values in Joules. Standard conditions are 15C and 1.01325 bar(a). The automatic stream changeover sequence in case of fault in one stream shall be implemented in the flow computer. The automatic stream changeover sequence shall consider the flowmeter fault status, flow computer fault status, on-off valve status as minimum. The automatic stream changeover sequence implemented in the flow computer shall ensure that one valve is always open at any given time in view of 100% availability. Vendor to review the air/signal fail action of stream change over valves in view of 100% availability criteria of the metering skid. The logic shall not cause in any case an interruption of gas supply to the customer. On line proving of one meter
PAGE 268
against other shall be possible on command from supervisory PC. The accumulated flow calculation shall be based on single flowmeter only and a separate report shall be generated after each meter proving cycle. The flow computers shall be in redundant configuration. The algorithm should give an alarm, if indicating gas is off-spec. Power supply Inputs (indicative) a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h) Outputs a) b) : : 240 VAC Redundant (UPS, 30 minute back up)
Flow: Vendor to specify. Temperature (on skid + off-skid): 4 20 mA DC (HART). Pressure (on skid + off-skid): 4 20 mA DC (HART). Composition: Serial data. Calorific values: Serial data Specific gravity: Serial data Valve status: Potential free contact Digital input (from outside skid): Potential free contact : Digital output for stream changeover sequence and outside skid on-off valve. Serial interface to HMI/supervisory PC via the data bus.
Output to the control system (as minimum) on real time basis: a) b) c) d) e) f) g) h) Flow (uncompensated/compensated) Pressure Temperature Specific gravity and density Wobbe index Calorific value (LHV/GHV) Gas composition. Hydrocarbon dew-point
All process data and instrumentation shall be available in the control system for operation, monitoring and alarm. Data transferred to the control system shall have accuracy of two (2) decimal places (e.g. 32 bit floating point).
PAGE 269
: : :
HMI / Supervisory PC
The flow computers of each stream shall be connected to industrial grade PC based monitoring and operating station via the databus. The purpose of this PC is to monitor the metering equipment parameters, to operate in meter proving configuration and to display gas composition obtained from both GCs. A printer with necessary software and drivers will be connected with this PC for on demand printing of hourly/daily/weekly/monthly accumulated report on metering skid parameters. The PC shall be provided with MS operating systems and application software. PC specification shall be in accordance with the Consortiums specifications. Vendor shall be requested to comply with the following PC specification: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) The PC should generate these hourly/daily/weekly/monthly reports automatically. These reports are mandatory requirement of this project. A report shall be provided after proof testing of the ultrasonic flowmeters. The PC should be capable of creating a history file of all reports. The PC shall be capable of storing these reports for a minimum of 3 years. The PC can be used for generating analysis reports. It shall be possible to store the report in a removable media for company internal use. The supervisory PC shall on demand generate report on uncertainty calculations for flow and energy.
The above reports shall include the following as a minimum (in a specific format given by the purchaser): a) Hourly gas delivery report must show the hourly accumulated volumes, Wobbe index peak instantaneous flow rate and min/max heating values. Daily gas delivery reports must show the accumulated volume, Wobbe index peak instantaneous flow rate and min/max heating values. Monthly gas delivery reports shall show the daily-accumulated volume, Wobbe index, peak day volumes /energy and min/max heating values. This could be just one page summary for the entire month. Gas Chromatographic Analyser General
b)
c)
6.4. 6.4.1.
PAGE 270
Two (1 working + 1 standby) on line Gas Chromatographs shall be installed upstream of the flow metering skid for analysis of the gas composition, heating (calorific) values and the calculation of specific gravity. The Gas Chromatograph enclosure shall be explosion proof and shall be certified for use in Zone 1, Gas Group IIB, Temp class T4 area. The electronics of the Chromatograph shall be tropicalized and shall be fit for continuous functioning within the range of ambient atmospheres experienced at site. The analyser chamber will consist of a temperature controlled heat sink oven, working over an ambient range of 0-82C. The oven s hall contain three packed columns, thermal conductivity type of micro detector and sample injection and column switching valves. Carrier gas shall preferably be Helium, which shall push the sample gas from the sample conditioning system into the columns in a pre-determined sequence. The operation shall allow initial purging with carrier gas and then sequential analysis of all components. Total time to complete one cycle of analysis shall be not greater than 360 seconds. The vent connection on the Gas Chromatographs shall preferably be OD and shall preferably be piped into a plant flare system. Venting rate shall not exceed 100 cc/min. at 1.4 bar(g). If no flare system is available, the Bidder shall propose an alternate and safe venting system The Gas Chromatograph shall be able to carry out automatic re-calibration at pre-defined intervals. The Gas Chromatograph is to provide gas composition analyses up to C9+, specific gravity, density and heating (calorific) value input to custody transfer metering system, with an overall uncertainty within 1%. The Bidder shall supply the GC analyzer with the highest accuracy to meet the overall custody transfer metering systems objectives. The GC shall also provide hydrocarbon dew-point analysis and result. Vendor shall supply the mapping details for the configuration of serial interface database to be communicated and displayed on the control system. Gas calibration and carrier gas cylinders shall be supplied by the Contractor for pre-commissioning, commissioning and the initial period of the project. 6.4.2. Sample conditioning system
The fast loop sample conditioning system shall be designed to handle one sample gas stream and one calibration gas stream. The system shall draw sample from the pipeline through a take-off point. Sampling tubes shall be heat traced. The take-off shall be installed approximately 5 meters from the Gas Chromatograph. The conditioning system shall have integral heat traced pressure regulator and relief valve. The conditioning system shall be dedicated to each GC; i.e. two independent sample conditioning system with sample probe shall be provided for two GCs. The Contractor shall design and supply the sample conditioning system according to the process condition. Typically the sample conditioning system shall consist of the following as minimum: Double block and bleed type isolation valve shall be used to isolate the sampling line from the pipeline. The sample conditioning system shall consist of in-line filter, sample flow controller, flow
PAGE 271
indicator, solenoid valves, etc. All components shall be of SS316 body and the tubing interconnection shall be made from SS316 L. The analyser wetted parts material shall conform to the requirements of NACE MR-01-75/ISO 15156 (Latest). The sample conditioning system shall be mounted on a SS316 plate with suitable hood; the plate shall have mounting holes for field stand mounting. All external connections shall be OD connection. 6.4.3. Calibration and carrier gas
The carrier gas shall be high purity helium. The calibration gas shall be specified by the Contractor. The Bidder shall supply the cylinders for both the carrier gas and calibration gas. Since the cylinders need to be replaced, the Contractor shall advise the source of the calibration gas/carrier gas in Oman, to enable the Consortium to replace the cylinder. The Bidder shall provide a sunshade and mounting supports for installation of cylinders. Two sets of regulators for carrier gas cylinders and two sets of regulators for the calibration gas cylinder with a common connection between them shall be supplied. The cylinders shall be installed and connected with OD tube for connecting to the Gas Chromatograph or Sample Conditioning System. Suitable SS316 adapters (Swagelok make), if required shall be supplied. Cylinder holding bracket for 6 cylinders shall be provided for mounting both carrier and calibration gas cylinders. Two helium cylinders shall be connected in such a way that one cylinder can be replaced without interrupting the operation of the Gas Chromatograph. Low pressure alarm shall be generated and displayed on the control system from carrier gas as well as calibration gas mixture cylinders. 6.4.4. Chromatograph controller
The Chromatograph controller shall be mounted in explosion proof enclosure in the field. It shall be located in Gas Chromatograph unit cabinet suitable to mount in hazardous area in ambient atmosphere. The cabinet shall have lifting lugs at the top. All cable entries shall be at the bottom of cabinet. Supply voltage of 240VAC UPS will be provided to cabinet for Chromatograph controller. The cabinet shall accommodate the following; One microprocessor based analyser controller controlling the analyser operation, data from the Chromatograph, producing Chromatograms and reports and for transmitting data to the flow computers and supervisory computer. Power supply units, terminals, power distribution system, cable trunking, etc. Terminal blocks for marshalling and other interfacing signals. Cabinet wiring shall be carried out strictly in accordance with the relevant standards. Cabinet shall have the following grounding buses;
PAGE 272
Dirty Earth Clean Earth All the equipment in the cabinet shall have RFI immunity as per IEC 61000 and transient protection as per IEEE 473. The microprocessor based Chromatograph controller shall feature; Memory with 45 days battery backup to protect the programme in case of power outage. Programming through front of panel keypad for configuration and calibration. Front of panel display for operator prompting. Remote programming option via serial link/fibre optic cable link. Gas composition outputs to the control system via redundant serial links. Volt free contact output for analyser fault and controller fault. Changeover to the standby GC in case of fault in duty GC. Energy value computational repeatability of 1/2 Joules per 1000 over 0-50C. 6.4.5. Chromatograms and Reports
The analyser controller shall have the option of generating any or all of the following reports/diagnosis through serial link, Analysis report providing complete compositional analysis plus MW and heating values at an interval of one hour. 24 hour average report providing up to 15 separate data average over 24 hours. Calibration report providing the report of calibrating the analyser with certified calibration gas. In addition, following fault/alarm messages shall be provided; Maximum of 15 HI/LO alarms on the measured variables Analyser common fault Controller common fault Chromatogram of the gas analysis shall be available in Gas Chromatograph controller as well as in control system with supporting software supplied by the GC Vendor. The chromatogram shall be produced with clear identification of each component. Each peak shall represent one component. The area under the peak shall represent components concentration. 6.4.6. Interface with other System
GCs are interfaced with the supervisory control system to hand-off analysis data and calculated data on the control system. 6.4.7. Sample probe
PAGE 273
The sampling system shall be defined by the Vendor. Tapping for manual sample probe shall be provided. The sampling probe shall be on line retractable type to facilitate on line maintenance activities without stopping the process. Individual sample probe for each GC shall be provided. 6.5. 6.5.1 6.5.1.1. POWER SUPPLY Power Supply Facilities Each cabinet shall receive 240 VAC 5%, 50 Hz 2% from 2 UPS feeders, with 30 minute back up via redundant feeder cables from UPS distribution board and/or 24 VDC power supplies shall be used for the instrumentation systems. Instruments (other than FF, 2 wire devices) requiring external power supply shall be considered for 24V DC power supply only. The normal operation of AC powered instruments shall not be adversely affected by power dips caused by load transfer operation of UPS system. The Vendor shall supply the AC/DC power supply units/converters and provide 100% fault tolerance (redundancy). Internal power supplies for CPUs and I/O shall be separated. Each power supply in a redundant set of power supplies shall be rated such that all loads can be simultaneously energized. Diagnostics and signalling facilities shall be provided to service/replace a faulty power supply unit. The power supply to the input and output circuits shall be floating (non-earthed). Hardware shall be provided to automatically check and alarm in case the supply is not floating. The related alarm shall be part of individual cabinet utility alarms. It shall be possible to isolate, disconnect, remove and replace faulty power supplies without loss of operation. Main power interruptions of up to 10msec shall not affect operation.
6.5.1.2.
6.5.1.3.
6.5.1.4.
6.5.1.5.
6.5.1.6.
6.5.1.7.
6.5.1.8.
6.5.1.9.
6.5.2. 6.5.2.1.
Power Distribution The Vendor shall provide all the necessary power, voltages, frequencies, etc. that individual components and modules require with full fault tolerance (redundancy).
PAGE 274
6.5.2.2.
Isolation of power on per process unit basis by means of circuit breakers and fusing shall be provided in the metering cabinets. Exceptions to this, if any, shall be given in the specification. It shall be possible to easily replace fuses. METERING PANEL REQUIREMENT Cabinets System/marshalling cabinets shall preferably be Rittal TS 8000 Series, 800 mm wide, 800 mm deep and 2000 mm high (2100 mm with plinth), with RAL 7035. More than two cabinets shall not be bolted together. Alternatively, Vendor standard cabinet of similar quality may be offered in the tender for consideration by the Company. In this event, individual differences from the Rittal standard specification shall be clearly indicated in the tender. The cabinets shall be of the free standing type, with doors. Cabinets shall be provided with a heat extraction fan, louvers and dust filters. Each cabinet shall have a temperature switch to alarm in case of high inside temperature. This alarm shall be available in the plant control system. A failure of a single heat extraction fan, if installed, shall not lead to such a high temperature that the power has to be cut off. The Vendor shall supply in such cases fault tolerant fans. Fan failure shall be included in the cabinet common utility alarm. The cabinets shall have a facility to be connected together. The Vendor shall advise on the use of side plates with regard to ventilation, heat dissipation and interconnection of cabinets. Cabinet layouts shall be of a standard design for the type of cabinet. The cabinet shall have front access however if the Vendors hardware design requires front and rear access for the cabinet, the Vendor shall specify the same for Company approval. All doors shall be hinged opening, preferably 180 degrees, detachable. Cabinets shall be lockable and the keys shall be identical for all cabinets under the Vendors scope of supply. Eye bolts shall be fitted on top of the cabinets for lifting purposes. Anchor bolt holes shall be provided. Unused card location shall be fitted with cover plates. Cabinet fans & lights shall use non-UPS power supply.
7.1.2. 7.1.3.
7.1.4.
7.1.5.
7.1.6. 7.1.7.
PAGE 275
Cabinet shall be provided with 240V AC, 50Hz utility socket. Cabling / Wireways All cabling shall be as per approved specifications for Instrument Cabling. All cable entries shall be through bottom. Bottom plates shall have removable sealing clamp plates for cable entries. Sufficient free space shall be made available for proper accommodation and termination of the cables. Cable clamps and support shall be provided for all incoming cables. Adequate cable connection stress relief shall be provided. If termipoint or wire wrap is applied, adequate terminating pins at the Elco boards shall be connected. The Vendor shall specify how this is included in the proposed design. All internal wiring shall be laid in close-slotted trunking with a covering lid. Ducting shall have 40% spare capacity. Wiring carrying signal susceptible to electrical interference shall be adequately screened. All inter-section wiring shall pass through the normal cabinet entries. Colour code and marking of wires shall be as per the standards indicated in the specification. All power wiring shall be clearly marked with reference codes and/or tag numbers. Terminals shall be Weidmuller or Vendor recommended equivalent. If fused terminals are required, they shall be equipped with blown indicators. Terminal arrangements shall be such that all single cores, including spares, of the multi-core cables can be connected in the same sequential order as the pattern and layout of the cores in the cable. Lightning protection devices shall be installed at the initial termination point in the cabinet of all field devices. Power cables and instrument cables shall be segregated. Earthing Two earths, instrument screen earth and plant safety earth shall be made available. Electric ground and instrument ground shall be discontinuous.
7.2.3.
7.2.4.
7.2.5.
7.2.6.
7.2.7. 7.2.8.
7.2.9.
7.2.10.
7.2.11.
PAGE 276
7.3.2.
All metallic equipment of and within the cabinets shall be connected to single common cabinet plant safety earth point. Each cabinet shall be provided with an M10 earth bolt for connection to the plant safety earthing system. Screens for cable interconnecting cabinets shall be earthed at one end only to the instrument screen earth. For this purposes the Vendor shall provide an insulated instrument screen earth bar. Screen earth for serial communication lines between the metering system and the control system shall be connected at the control system side only. The Vendor shall state in the quotation earthing requirements for the quoted system. The Vendor shall provide on earth leakage monitor per cabinet unless otherwise stated on the requisition. The related alarm shall be taken-up in the common cabinet utility alarm. Labelling Terminals carrying voltages higher than 24 volts shall be protected against accidental contact by having removable cover plates, and shall be labelled to indicate high voltage. Sockets, terminals and main wiring shall be clearly identified in strict accordance with the system documentation. Earthing for screens, AC and DC systems shall be segregated and identified. Each cabinet and all major system components, card files and individual card locations shall be clearly labelled and identified with a tag number. Nameplates shall be in the English language. In addition all equipment shall be durably identified with the Vendor type and serial number and with Vendor order number to facilitate future reference. Cabinets shall be identified with tag number. The Vendors number shall be complete and sufficient for ordering and identical component without further clarification. Separate cabinets or segregated section is within a cabinet that are provided for intrinsic safety shall be labelled as such. Cables and ducting shall have a blue colour. INSPECTION & TEST Factory Acceptance Test (FAT)
7.3.3.
7.3.4.
7.3.5. 7.3.6.
7.4. 7.4.1.
7.4.2.
7.4.3.
7.4.4.
8. 8.1.
The Factory Acceptance Test (FAT) shall be carried out at the Vendor's workshop. The inspection shall be carried out in accordance with the approved FAT procedure.
PAGE 277
NOTE: The FAT is performed to demonstrate that Vendor has already successfully performed testing. It shall not be used as a substitute for the vendor's own tests. Vendor shall ensure that the system is ready for customer tests and will be fully responsible for delays that result from the system not being completely ready for such testing. The Vendor shall provide adequate personnel, test facilities and test equipment for the FAT. The Vendor shall provide FAT procedures. These shall include; Timing of activities. Vendor's personnel attending the FAT (with responsibilities). Methods, by which deficiencies shall be identified, recorded and rectified. The test procedures shall be made available 8 weeks prior to the FAT for Company approval. The Vendor shall notify the Purchaser 4 weeks in advance of when the system will be ready for FAT. The FAT consists of a full functional test of flow metering system including full functional logic testing of the automatic stream changeover sequence at the Vendor's works. This shall include visual checks on workmanship, field instruments calibration, hydro test, material certificates checking, panel wiring and insulation tests, etc. Final documentation shall be available during this test. After successful FAT and SIT, the system shall be released for shipment. 8.2. System Integrated Test (SIT)
This phase will take place at the control system suppliers works/site (as applicable). The location shall be advised by the Company/Contractor. The fiscal metering vendor is responsible for sending the equipment for SIT to the control system suppliers works/site (as applicable), perform the test (including the redundancy test) and take back the equipment. Expenses for all necessary loading, unloading, transportation and insurance coverage for the full period shall be borne by the fiscal metering vendor. This test includes; Connection of the metering computers to the control system and testing of the serial communication with the control system. This will involve; 100% test of functionality 100% test of all analog and digital signals Punch list items from FAT shall be tested during SIT.
PAGE 278
8.3.
The Vendor shall complete a Site Acceptance Test (SAT) at site. Punch list items from FAT and SIT shall be tested during SAT. In addition to above tests, Vendor shall perform tests to prove that in case of parallel flow through both duty and standby stream the total flow for billing the consumer shall be addition of flow through both the flowmeters (duty and standby) and similarly during meter proving (series flow with crossover valve open) the flow through duty flowmeter only is used for billing the consumer. 9 9.1. PAINTING AND COATING, PROTECTION AND SHIPPING Painting and Coating
Painting and surface protection shall generally conform to accepted specifications for Painting & Protective Coating and shall be suitable for the climatic conditions as detailed in Attachment-A of this Appendix D. The manufacturers painting standard can be considered as an alternative offer provided it meets or exceeds the proceeding requirements. 9.2. Protection and Shipping
The system shall be delivered to the required location according to Purchasers purchase order instructions. Packing shall be in accordance with accepted Packing Procedures and transportation shall be in accordance with accepted Transportation and Logistics Procedures. The skid shall be designed rigid enough to withstand any forces and bending moments during sea and road transportation. Any damage resulting from poor packing shall be on account of supplier and shall be replaced within the agreed period The Vendor shall be fully responsible for supplying all necessary documentation to enable customs clearance of the equipment. 10. 10.1. DOCUMENTATION AND DRAWINGS General
The Vendor shall complete and submit with the tender the entire information essential to enable a technical assessment of the bid to be made. Failure to supply the data may cause rejection of the bid. The information required as a minimum shall include:
PAGE 279
Sizing calculations. Vendor's standard guarantee/warranty of the complete unit. Product catalogues 10.2. Documentation with Order
The engineering documentation required in the event of an order is specified in the Material Requisition for Flow Metering System. Documentation shall be submitted for comment and approval. Following standard documents shall be provided. Full technical specifications of Vendors hardware and software quoted. Full details of guarantee offered both on the overall system and on (commissioning) spares. Project specific documentation. System block diagrams, e.g. a detailed system overview. Functional system description. Initial planning network. Progress report showing progress made not less than every month. All necessary drawings carrying title block with Vendors drawing number. Instruction manuals of all equipment supplied: a) Hardware maintenance manuals b) Software reference manuals c) Hardware reference manuals d) System operating manuals e) Engineering manuals f) System installation manuals Study report and recommendation for eliminating the ultrasonic noise if any. Software point configuration data. Installation manuals for all individual items of fiscal metering system. All testing and commissioning procedures before the testing and commissioning activities. 10.3. Approval of drawings
a) All drawings and engineering documents shall be subject to comments and approval by the Purchaser/detail engineering consultant. b) Approval is for the purpose of ascertaining conformance to the specifications and standards and does not relieve the Vendor of the responsibility to provide a fully operational system. A period of two weeks shall be allowed for the Purchaser/detail engineering consultant to give comments. The vendor shall not commence fabrication before approval of the relevant drawings has been received. 11 TRAINING
PAGE 280
The Vendor shall provide detailed information on the various training facilities that can be provided, either at the works or on the site for instrument maintenance/design engineers, maintenance technicians and operators. For each training program, the following shall be provided: Types of courses Duration and periods of courses Costs per course (at the Supplier's works or at site) Training documentation provided Prerequisite knowledge of participants 12. 12.1. SPARE PARTS General
The Vendor shall include with the quotation a price list of spare parts for start-up / commissioning and two year of operation and maintenance / capital spares, together with the relevant cross sectional drawings and spare parts list. SPIR forms shall be completed by the Vendor in accordance with the instructions for use of SPIR forms and submitted to the Purchaser not later than 8 weeks after the purchase order is placed. 12.2. Commissioning spares
The Vendor shall include spares for commissioning in the quotation. Quantities recommended shall take into consideration of the Vendors experience regarding the failure rate of the components. 12.3. Guarantee period spares
Any spares used during the guarantee period shall be replenished at the Vendors expense. The time and procedure for repair and/or replacement shall be clearly stated in the quotation. 12.4. Maintenance/Operation spares
The Vendor shall recommend for maintenance spares required for two (2) year of continuous operation. 13. QUALITY CONTROL
Vendor shall exercise full and adequate quality control in accordance with the Project Quality Plan and Procedures, which shall include the design verification, inspection and testing during manufacture, construction and assembly. 14. WARRANTY
PAGE 281
The Vendor shall warranty all works and material in his supply against defective materials, workmanship, design, packaging and/or failure in normal use for a period of 24 months after the final acceptance of package.
ENVIRONMENT CONDITION
Environmental / Meteorological Data: Updated data shall be provided by Oman Meteorological department where applicable.
30C 5 C
15C 82C
25C
Ground Temperature:
PAGE 282
Relative Humidity:
Max Min
98% 60%
Barometric Pressure
Average
Rainfall (Note 2)
25mm Nil
Wind: Prevailing wind directions March/ April May/ June Remainder From North West From South West From South East
PAGE 283
42.0 m/s
Winter Summer
25 C 30 C
Notes: 1. The ambient temperature may rise up to 60C for short periods but, as this temperature occurs for short periods only, equipment shall be designed to achieve its rated capacity with a shade temperature of 50C. Instruments shall be suitable for the black bulb temperature of 82C. Rainfall is infrequent, but when rainfall occurs, it is often combined with severe sand storms. All instruments, systems and related components shall comply with the environmental conditions as specified in the Project specification.
2.
3.
Plant-mounted instruments shall be suitable for operation in industrial, humid, saline and corrosive atmospheres and shall be adequately protected according to the electrical area classification. For outdoor locations, the climatic conditions of location class D2 of IEC 60654-1 apply. The minimum degree of protection of plant instruments shall be IP 65 as defined in IEC 60529. For mechanical influence, classification in accordance with IEC 60654-3 shall apply.
PAGE 284
For corrosive influence, classification in accordance with IEC 60654-4 shall apply. The corrosive influence class shall comply with the requirements of Class 1 (Industrial clean air) or Class 2 (moderate contamination), as specified by the Company. For tropical areas, further stringent requirements, such as anti-corrosion coatings or tropicalization of printed circuit boards, may be applicable and advice shall be obtained from the Vendors. Special attention shall be paid to factors relating to insects, animals, etc. Special attention shall be paid to instruments and ancillary equipment which will be used in marine (e.g. jetty) services and/or installed in coastal or offshore environments. In such cases hermetical sealing of the electronic circuitry may be required. Depending on site conditions, the contacts of switches/relays may require protection against traces of H2S and SO2 in the indoor and outdoor atmospheres by gold coating (at least 10m) or by locating them in hermetically sealed housings. General Note: Sandstorms: These are both frequent and severe and can last for days. The atmosphere is heavily laden with dust particles, down to 2 microns.
ATTACHMENT B:
UNITS OF MEASUREMENT
The project shall use the SI units for all calculations, drawings and in all project documentation. All vendor documentation and equipment will also utilize the SI units. In some cases it may be convenient to use oil/gas industry standard units for standard volume flow and pressure. These are shown in parenthesis below: Parameter Area Cathodic Current Density Conductivity Current Density Elevation Unit square metres Amps per square metre Micro Siemens per centimetre Amps kilograms per cubic metre metres Symbol m2 A/m2 S/cm A kg/m3 m
PAGE 285
Energy Flow Velocity Force Frequency Gas Volume Fraction Gas Volumetric Flow
Joules metres per second kilonewtons Hertz mole percent million std cubic metres per day
normal cubic metres per hour (at 0C, 1 atm) Heat Transfer Coefficient Heating Value Watts per square metre per degree C megajoules per cubic metre
MJ/kg M
millimetres Liquid Head Liquid Volume Fraction Liquid Volumetric Flow metres volume percent barrel per day
mm m Vol % bbl/d
Am3/d
Sm3/d Kg
PAGE 286
t ppm wt
mass percent Mass Enthalpy Mass Flow kilojoules per kilogram kilograms per hour
wt % kJ/kg kg/h
tonnes per day Molar Flow Moment Potential Power Pressure kilogram moles per hour kilonewton metres Volts kilowatts bar absolute
bar gauge
Barg
milibar gauge (for tanks) Resistance Seawater resistivity Sound Pressure Specific Heat Stress Ohm Ohm metres decibels kilojoules per kilogram per degree C Newtons per square metre
PAGE 287
Pascals Temperature Thermal Conductivity Viscosity degrees Celsius Watts per metre per deg. C centipoises (dynamic) centistokes (kinematic)
Pa C W/(m C) cP
cSt Volume Wind Velocity Cubic metres metres per second m3 m/s
PAGE 288
PAGE 289